HP-LaserJet E825xx, Service Enww PDF
HP-LaserJet E825xx, Service Enww PDF
HP-LaserJet E825xx, Service Enww PDF
Service Manual
Copyright and License Trademark Credits
The information contained herein is subject to ENERGY STAR and the ENERGY STAR mark are
change without notice. registered U.S. marks.
Edition 1, 04/2017
Conventions used in this guide
TIP: Tips provide helpful hints or shortcuts.
CAUTION: Cautions indicate procedures that you should follow to avoid losing data or damaging the product.
WARNING! Warnings alert you to specific procedures that you should follow to avoid personal injury,
catastrophic loss of data, or extensive damage to the product.
ENWW iii
iv Conventions used in this guide ENWW
Table of contents
1 Precautions ................................................................................................................................................................................................ 1
Safety warning .......................................................................................................................................................................... 2
Caution for safety ..................................................................................................................................................................... 3
Toxic material ....................................................................................................................................................... 3
Electric shock and fire safety precautions ....................................................................................................... 3
Handling precautions .......................................................................................................................................... 5
Removal and Replacement precautions .......................................................................................................... 5
Disregarding this warning may cause bodily injury ........................................................................................ 5
ESD precautions ........................................................................................................................................................................ 7
ENWW v
Feeding system overview ................................................................................................................................ 40
Main components and functions ..................................................................................................................... 41
Rollers ............................................................................................................................................. 41
Sensor, motor, and solenoid ....................................................................................................... 43
Cassette .............................................................................................................................................................. 45
Pickup unit .......................................................................................................................................................... 46
Registration unit ................................................................................................................................................ 46
MP feeder assembly ......................................................................................................................................... 47
Fuser unit ................................................................................................................................................................................. 49
Fuser unit overview ........................................................................................................................................... 49
Fuser unit drive .................................................................................................................................................. 50
Fuser unit temperature control ....................................................................................................................... 50
Loop control ....................................................................................................................................................... 51
Image creation ........................................................................................................................................................................ 53
Printing process overview ................................................................................................................................ 53
Imaging unit ........................................................................................................................................................ 53
Drum unit overview ...................................................................................................................... 53
Drum drive ..................................................................................................................................... 54
Developer unit ............................................................................................................................... 55
Toner cartridge .............................................................................................................................. 56
Paper transfer belt unit ................................................................................................................ 57
Paper transfer belt unit overview .......................................................................... 57
Transfer belt drive .................................................................................................... 58
Cleaning blade .......................................................................................................... 59
Laser scanner assembly ....................................................................................................................................................... 61
Laser scanner assembly overview .................................................................................................................. 61
Laser scanning optical path ............................................................................................................................. 62
Laser synchronizing detectors ........................................................................................................................ 62
Drive system ........................................................................................................................................................................... 64
Pickup and cassette lift drive ........................................................................................................................... 64
Feed drive ........................................................................................................................................................... 65
Registration drive .............................................................................................................................................. 66
Fuser release/output drive ............................................................................................................................... 67
Drive motors ....................................................................................................................................................... 67
Main drive unit motors ...................................................................................................................................... 69
Toner supply drive ............................................................................................................................................. 70
Toner reservoir drive ......................................................................................................................................... 70
Flatbed Scanner System ....................................................................................................................................................... 71
Flatbed scanner system overview .................................................................................................................. 71
Scanning system components ........................................................................................................................ 73
Caution for moving the scanner ...................................................................................................................... 79
vi ENWW
Flow Automatic Document Feeder (Flow ADF) dn/z bundles (GX) ................................................................................. 81
Flow ADF overview ............................................................................................................................................ 81
Sensors ............................................................................................................................................................... 82
Ultra Sonic Multi-feed (USM) ............................................................................................................................ 83
Flow ADF drive system ..................................................................................................................................... 83
Flow ADF document lifting drive system .................................................................................. 84
Flow ADF Scan-In Roller Release Drive System ....................................................................... 84
Flow ADF specification ................................................................................................................. 85
Flow ADF Registration ....................................................................................................................................... 85
Flow ADF Scanning Position ............................................................................................................................. 86
Mixed Size Original (MSO) ................................................................................................................................. 86
Dual sensor cleaning method .......................................................................................................................... 87
Flow ADF z bundles (GX) ................................................................................................................................... 88
Hardware configuration ........................................................................................................................................................ 89
Main controller ................................................................................................................................................... 92
Main controller for previous model ............................................................................................ 92
Main controller ............................................................................................................................... 96
Master system operation key (MSOK) ....................................................................................... 99
Low voltage power supply (LVPS) PCA (Type 5) ......................................................................................... 100
Low voltage power supply (LVPS) PCA (Type 3) ......................................................................................... 102
Low voltage power supply (LVPS) PCA (Type 4) ......................................................................................... 104
Fuser drive assembly ..................................................................................................................................... 105
High voltage power supply (HVPS) board ................................................................................................... 106
Eraser PCA ........................................................................................................................................................ 108
Fuser PCA ......................................................................................................................................................... 109
Waste Sensor PCA ........................................................................................................................................... 109
Paper Size sensor PCA ................................................................................................................................... 110
Flow ADF PCA ................................................................................................................................................... 110
Scan joint PCA .................................................................................................................................................. 111
CCDM PCA ......................................................................................................................................................... 112
WLED IF PCA ..................................................................................................................................................... 113
WLED PCA ......................................................................................................................................................... 113
Dual cassette feeder (DCF) ................................................................................................................................................. 114
High capacity input tray (HCI) ............................................................................................................................................. 118
Side high capacity input tray (sHCI) ................................................................................................................................... 122
ENWW vii
Precautions when handling PCA .............................................................................................. 134
Releasing plastic latches ........................................................................................................... 134
Before performing service ............................................................................................................................. 135
After performing service ................................................................................................................................ 135
Post-service test ............................................................................................................................................. 135
Print-quality test ......................................................................................................................... 135
Copy-quality test ........................................................................................................................ 135
Fax-quality test ........................................................................................................................... 135
Parts removal order ................................................................................................................... 136
Maintenance ......................................................................................................................................................................... 137
Machine cleaning for maintenance .............................................................................................................. 137
Cleaning the paper dust stick ................................................................................................... 137
Cleaning the scan glass ............................................................................................................. 139
Cleaning the flow ADF white bar and CISCleaning the flow document feeder white
bar and CIS ................................................................................................................................... 140
Removal and replacement procedures ............................................................................................................................ 142
Accessories ...................................................................................................................................................... 142
Removal and replacement: Trusted platform module ........................................................ 143
Introduction ............................................................................................................ 143
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover .................................................................. 144
Step 2: Remove the hard-disk drive ................................................................... 144
Step 3: Remove the trusted platform module (TPM) ....................................... 145
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................... 145
Install accessory: HP Foreign interface harness (FIH) solution ........................................... 147
Introduction ............................................................................................................ 147
Step 1: Unpack the FIH accessory ....................................................................... 148
Step 2: Install the FIH accessory .......................................................................... 148
NFC Kit Installation ..................................................................................................................... 149
Introduction ............................................................................................................ 149
Step 1: Unpack the NFC kit ................................................................................... 151
Step 2: Install the NFC kit ...................................................................................... 151
Replacement of maintenance parts ............................................................................................................ 156
Toner collection unit (TCU) ........................................................................................................ 157
Introduction ............................................................................................................ 157
Step 1: Remove the TCU ....................................................................................... 158
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................... 158
Imaging drum unit ...................................................................................................................... 159
Introduction ............................................................................................................ 159
Step 1: Remove the imaging drum unit ............................................................. 160
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................... 160
Developer unit ............................................................................................................................. 162
viii ENWW
Introduction ............................................................................................................ 162
Step 1: Remove the developer unit .................................................................... 163
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................... 165
Fuser unit ..................................................................................................................................... 166
Introduction ............................................................................................................ 166
Step 1: Remove the fuser unit ............................................................................. 167
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................... 167
Paper transfer belt (PTB) ........................................................................................................... 169
Introduction ............................................................................................................ 169
Step 1: Remove the PTB ....................................................................................... 170
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................... 172
Trays 2–x pick, feed, and separation rollers .......................................................................... 174
Introduction ............................................................................................................ 174
Step 1: Remove the Trays 2–x pick, feed, and separation rollers ................. 175
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................... 177
Multipurpose (MP) tray pickup/reverse/feed roller ............................................................... 178
Introduction ............................................................................................................ 178
Step 1: Remove the MP pickup/reverse/feed roller ......................................... 179
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................... 181
Flow ADF pickup roller assembly ............................................................................................. 183
Introduction ............................................................................................................ 183
Step 1: Remove the flow ADF pickup roller assembly ..................................... 184
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................... 187
Flow ADF separation roller assembly ...................................................................................... 188
Introduction ............................................................................................................ 188
Step 1: Remove the flow ADF separation roller assembly .............................. 189
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................... 191
Formatter cover ................................................................................................................................................................... 192
Introduction ...................................................................................................................................................... 192
Before performing service ........................................................................................................ 192
Required tools ............................................................................................................................. 192
After performing service ........................................................................................................... 192
Post service test ......................................................................................................................... 193
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ........................................................................................................... 193
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ................................................................................................ 193
Accelerator board ................................................................................................................................................................ 195
Introduction ...................................................................................................................................................... 195
Before performing service ........................................................................................................ 195
Required tools ............................................................................................................................. 195
After performing service ........................................................................................................... 195
Post service test ......................................................................................................................... 196
ENWW ix
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ........................................................................................................... 196
Step 2: Remove the accelerator board ........................................................................................................ 196
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ................................................................................................ 197
Island of data (IOD) .............................................................................................................................................................. 198
Introduction ...................................................................................................................................................... 198
Before performing service ........................................................................................................ 198
Required tools ............................................................................................................................. 198
After performing service ........................................................................................................... 198
Post service test ......................................................................................................................... 199
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ........................................................................................................... 199
Step 2: Remove the island of data (IOD) ..................................................................................................... 199
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ................................................................................................ 200
Formatter hard disk drive (HDD) ....................................................................................................................................... 201
Introduction ...................................................................................................................................................... 201
Before performing service ........................................................................................................ 201
Required tools ............................................................................................................................. 201
After performing service ........................................................................................................... 201
Post service test ......................................................................................................................... 202
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ........................................................................................................... 202
Step 2: Remove the hard-disk drive (HDD) ................................................................................................. 202
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ................................................................................................ 203
Formatter .............................................................................................................................................................................. 204
Introduction ...................................................................................................................................................... 204
Before performing service ........................................................................................................ 204
Required tools ............................................................................................................................. 204
After performing service ........................................................................................................... 204
Post service test ......................................................................................................................... 205
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ........................................................................................................... 205
Step 2: Remove the accelerator board ........................................................................................................ 205
Step 3: Remove the hard-disk drive ............................................................................................................ 206
Step 4: Remove the formatter PCA .............................................................................................................. 206
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ................................................................................................ 207
Control panel ........................................................................................................................................................................ 208
Introduction ...................................................................................................................................................... 208
Before performing service ........................................................................................................ 208
Required tools ............................................................................................................................. 208
After performing service ........................................................................................................... 208
Post service test ......................................................................................................................... 209
Step 1: Remove the control-panel bezel .................................................................................................... 209
Step 2: Remove the control-panel ............................................................................................................... 209
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ................................................................................................ 210
x ENWW
Keyboard (z bundles) .......................................................................................................................................................... 212
Introduction ...................................................................................................................................................... 212
Before performing service ........................................................................................................ 212
Required tools ............................................................................................................................. 212
After performing service ........................................................................................................... 212
Post service test ......................................................................................................................... 213
Step 1: Remove the control-panel bezel .................................................................................................... 213
Step 2: Remove the control-panel ............................................................................................................... 213
Step 3: Remove the keyboard ....................................................................................................................... 214
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ................................................................................................ 215
Intermediate paper transport unit (IPTU) ........................................................................................................................ 217
Introduction ...................................................................................................................................................... 217
Before performing service ........................................................................................................ 217
Required tools ............................................................................................................................. 217
After performing service ........................................................................................................... 217
Post service test ......................................................................................................................... 218
Step 1: Remove the IPTU ............................................................................................................................... 218
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ................................................................................................ 218
Replacing the main SVC part .............................................................................................................................................. 220
Front top inner cover ...................................................................................................................................... 221
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 221
Before performing service ................................................................................... 221
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 221
After performing service ....................................................................................... 221
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 222
Step 1: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 222
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 222
Front power cover ........................................................................................................................................... 223
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 223
Before performing service ................................................................................... 223
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 223
After performing service ....................................................................................... 223
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 224
Step 1: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 224
Step 2: Remove the front power cover ................................................................................... 224
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 225
Front power switch ......................................................................................................................................... 226
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 226
Before performing service ................................................................................... 226
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 226
After performing service ....................................................................................... 226
ENWW xi
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 227
Step 1: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 227
Step 2: Remove the front power cover ................................................................................... 227
Step 3: Remove the front power switch ................................................................................. 228
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 229
Output bin ......................................................................................................................................................... 231
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 231
Before performing service ................................................................................... 231
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 231
After performing service ....................................................................................... 231
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 232
Step 1: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 232
Step 2: Remove the output bin ................................................................................................ 232
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 232
Top right cover ................................................................................................................................................. 234
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 234
Before performing service ................................................................................... 234
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 234
After performing service ....................................................................................... 234
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 235
Step 1: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 235
Step 2: Remove the front power cover ................................................................................... 235
Step 3: Remove the top right cover ......................................................................................... 236
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 237
Left cover .......................................................................................................................................................... 238
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 238
Before performing service ................................................................................... 238
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 238
After performing service ....................................................................................... 238
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 239
Step 1: Remove the left cover .................................................................................................. 239
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 239
Lower rear cover ............................................................................................................................................. 241
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 241
Before performing service ................................................................................... 241
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 241
After performing service ....................................................................................... 241
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 242
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 242
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 242
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 243
xii ENWW
Upper rear cover .............................................................................................................................................. 244
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 244
Before performing service ................................................................................... 244
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 244
After performing service ....................................................................................... 244
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 245
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 245
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 245
Step 3: Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................... 246
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 246
Left rear corner cover ..................................................................................................................................... 248
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 248
Before performing service ................................................................................... 248
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 248
After performing service ....................................................................................... 248
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 249
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 249
Step 2: Remove the left rear corner cover ............................................................................. 249
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 250
Right rear cover ............................................................................................................................................... 251
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 251
Before performing service ................................................................................... 251
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 251
After performing service ....................................................................................... 251
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 252
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 252
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 252
Right door ......................................................................................................................................................... 254
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 254
Before performing service ................................................................................... 254
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 254
After performing service ....................................................................................... 254
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 255
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 255
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 255
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 257
Paper dust brush ............................................................................................................................................. 259
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 259
Before performing service ................................................................................... 259
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 259
After performing service ....................................................................................... 259
ENWW xiii
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 260
Step 1: Remove the toner collection unit ............................................................................... 260
Step 2: Remove the paper dust brush .................................................................................... 260
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 260
Front cover ....................................................................................................................................................... 262
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 262
Before performing service ................................................................................... 262
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 262
After performing service ....................................................................................... 262
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 262
Step 1: Remove the front cover ............................................................................................... 263
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 263
Inner front cover .............................................................................................................................................. 265
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 265
Before performing service ................................................................................... 265
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 265
After performing service ....................................................................................... 266
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 266
Step 1: Remove the front cover ............................................................................................... 266
Step 2: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 266
Step 3: Remove the front power cover ................................................................................... 267
Step 4: Remove the output bin ................................................................................................ 268
Step 5: Remove the toner collection unit ............................................................................... 268
Step 6: Remove the paper dust brush .................................................................................... 269
Step 7: Remove the inner front cover ..................................................................................... 269
Step 8: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 271
Front cover open sensor ................................................................................................................................ 272
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 272
Before performing service ................................................................................... 272
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 272
After performing service ....................................................................................... 273
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 273
Step 1: Remove the front cover ............................................................................................... 273
Step 2: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 273
Step 3: Remove the front power cover ................................................................................... 274
Step 4: Remove the output bin ................................................................................................ 275
Step 5: Remove the paper dust brush .................................................................................... 275
Step 6: Remove the inner front cover ..................................................................................... 276
Step 7: Remove the front cover open sensor ........................................................................ 278
Step 8: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 278
Low voltage power supply (LVPS) cover ...................................................................................................... 279
xiv ENWW
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 279
Before performing service ................................................................................... 279
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 279
After performing service ....................................................................................... 279
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 280
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 280
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 280
Step 3: Remove the LVPS cover ............................................................................................... 281
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 281
Laser scanner assembly ................................................................................................................................ 283
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 283
Before performing service ................................................................................... 283
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 283
After performing service ....................................................................................... 283
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 284
Step 1: Remove the left cover .................................................................................................. 284
Step 2: Remove the laser scanner assembly ......................................................................... 284
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 285
Developer fan .................................................................................................................................................. 287
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 287
Before performing service ................................................................................... 287
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 287
After performing service ....................................................................................... 288
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 288
Step 1: Remove the toner collection unit ............................................................................... 288
Step 2: Remove the imaging drum .......................................................................................... 288
Step 3: Remove the developer unit ......................................................................................... 289
Step 4: Remove the left cover .................................................................................................. 292
Step 5: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 293
Step 6: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 293
Step 7: Remove the developer fan .......................................................................................... 293
Step 8: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 298
High voltage power supply (HVPS) board ................................................................................................... 299
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 299
Before performing service ................................................................................... 299
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 299
After performing service ....................................................................................... 299
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 300
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 300
Step 2: Remove the left cover .................................................................................................. 300
Step 3: Remove the HVPS ......................................................................................................... 301
ENWW xv
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 302
Main board ........................................................................................................................................................ 303
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 303
Before performing service ................................................................................... 303
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 303
After performing service ....................................................................................... 304
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 304
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 304
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 304
Step 3: Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................... 305
Step 4: Remove the left rear corner cover ............................................................................. 305
Step 5: Remove the formatter and cage ................................................................................ 306
Step 6: Remove the main board .............................................................................................. 307
Step 7: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 310
Toner supply motor ........................................................................................................................................ 311
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 311
Before performing service ................................................................................... 311
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 311
After performing service ....................................................................................... 312
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 312
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 312
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 312
Step 3: Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................... 313
Step 4: Remove the left rear corner cover ............................................................................. 313
Step 5: Remove the formatter and cage ................................................................................ 314
Step 6: Remove the main board and cage ............................................................................. 315
Step 7: Remove the toner supply motor ................................................................................ 317
Step 8: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 318
CRUM connector .............................................................................................................................................. 319
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 319
Before performing service ................................................................................... 319
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 319
After performing service ....................................................................................... 320
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 320
Step 1: Remove the front cover ............................................................................................... 320
Step 2: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 320
Step 3: Remove the front power cover ................................................................................... 321
Step 4: Remove the output bin ................................................................................................ 322
Step 5: Remove the toner collection unit ............................................................................... 322
Step 6: Remove the paper dust brush .................................................................................... 323
Step 7: Remove the inner front cover ..................................................................................... 323
xvi ENWW
Step 8: Remove the left cover .................................................................................................. 325
Step 9: Remove the CRUM connector ..................................................................................... 326
Step 10: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 327
Low voltage power supply (LVPS) fans ........................................................................................................ 328
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 328
Before performing service ................................................................................... 328
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 328
After performing service ....................................................................................... 328
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 329
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 329
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 329
Step 3: Remove the LVPS fans ................................................................................................. 330
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 331
Low voltage power supply (LVPS) board 1 ................................................................................................. 332
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 332
Before performing service ................................................................................... 332
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 332
After performing service ....................................................................................... 332
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 333
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 333
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 333
Step 3: Remove the LVPS cover ............................................................................................... 334
Step 4: Remove the LVPS board 1 ........................................................................................... 334
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 335
Low voltage power supply (LVPS) board 2 ................................................................................................. 336
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 336
Before performing service ................................................................................... 336
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 336
After performing service ....................................................................................... 336
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 337
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 337
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 337
Step 3: Remove the LVPS cover ............................................................................................... 338
Step 4: Remove the LVPS board 2 ........................................................................................... 338
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 339
Low voltage power supply (LVPS) board 3 ................................................................................................. 340
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 340
Before performing service ................................................................................... 340
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 340
After performing service ....................................................................................... 340
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 341
ENWW xvii
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 341
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 341
Step 3: Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................... 342
Step 4: Remove the LVPS board 3 ........................................................................................... 342
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 343
Fuser drive board ............................................................................................................................................ 345
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 345
Before performing service ................................................................................... 345
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 345
After performing service ....................................................................................... 345
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 346
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 346
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 346
Step 3: Remove the LVPS cover ............................................................................................... 347
Step 4: Remove the fuser drive board .................................................................................... 347
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 348
Fuser fan ........................................................................................................................................................... 349
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 349
Before performing service ................................................................................... 349
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 349
After performing service ....................................................................................... 349
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 350
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 350
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 350
Step 3: Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................... 351
Step 4: Remove the LVPS board 3 and cage .......................................................................... 351
Step 5: Remove the fuser fan ................................................................................................... 353
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 354
Main drive unit ................................................................................................................................................. 356
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 356
Before performing service ................................................................................... 356
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 356
After performing service ....................................................................................... 356
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 357
Step 1: Remove the imaging drum .......................................................................................... 357
Step 2: Remove the developer unit ......................................................................................... 358
Step 3: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 360
Step 4: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 361
Step 5: Remove the main drive unit ........................................................................................ 361
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 363
Inductor unit ..................................................................................................................................................... 364
xviii ENWW
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 364
Before performing service ................................................................................... 364
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 364
After performing service ....................................................................................... 364
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 365
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 365
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 365
Step 3: Remove the LVPS cover ............................................................................................... 366
Step 4: Remove the fuser drive and low-voltage power supply (LVPS) boards and
cage .............................................................................................................................................. 366
Step 5: Remove the inductor unit ............................................................................................ 367
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 367
Auto closing unit .............................................................................................................................................. 369
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 369
Before performing service ................................................................................... 369
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 369
After performing service ....................................................................................... 369
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 370
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 370
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 370
Step 3: Remove the LVPS cover ............................................................................................... 371
Step 4: Remove the fuser drive and low-voltage power supply (LVPS) boards and
cage .............................................................................................................................................. 371
Step 5: Remove the auto closing unit ..................................................................................... 372
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 373
Fuser/output drive unit ................................................................................................................................... 374
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 374
Before performing service ................................................................................... 374
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 374
After performing service ....................................................................................... 375
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 375
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 375
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 375
Step 3: Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................... 376
Step 4: Remove the LVPS board 3 and cage .......................................................................... 376
Step 5: Remove the fuser fan ................................................................................................... 378
Step 6: Remove the fuser/output drive unit ........................................................................... 380
Step 7: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 380
Right door open sensor .................................................................................................................................. 382
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 382
Before performing service ................................................................................... 382
ENWW xix
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 382
After performing service ....................................................................................... 383
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 383
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 383
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 383
Step 3: Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................... 384
Step 4: Remove the LVPS board 3 and cage .......................................................................... 384
Step 5: Remove the fuser fan ................................................................................................... 386
Step 6: Remove the fuser/output drive unit ........................................................................... 388
Step 7: Remove the right door open sensor .......................................................................... 388
Step 8: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 389
Right door open switch .................................................................................................................................. 390
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 390
Before performing service ................................................................................... 390
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 390
After performing service ....................................................................................... 390
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 391
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 391
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 391
Step 3: Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................... 392
Step 4: Remove the LVPS board 3 and cage .......................................................................... 392
Step 5: Remove the fuser fan ................................................................................................... 394
Step 6: Remove the fuser/output drive unit ........................................................................... 396
Step 7: Remove the right door open sensor .......................................................................... 396
Step 8: Remove the right door open switch ........................................................................... 397
Step 9: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 397
Pickup drive unit 1 ........................................................................................................................................... 399
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 399
Before performing service ................................................................................... 399
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 399
After performing service ....................................................................................... 399
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 400
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 400
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 400
Step 3: Remove the LVPS cover ............................................................................................... 401
Step 4: Remove the fuser drive and LVPS boards and cage ................................................ 401
Step 5: Remove the pickup drive unit 1 .................................................................................. 402
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 402
Pickup drive unit 2 ........................................................................................................................................... 404
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 404
Before performing service ................................................................................... 404
xx ENWW
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 404
After performing service ....................................................................................... 404
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 405
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 405
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 405
Step 3: Remove the pickup drive unit 2 .................................................................................. 406
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 406
Feed/MP drive unit .......................................................................................................................................... 408
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 408
Before performing service ................................................................................... 408
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 408
After performing service ....................................................................................... 408
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 409
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 409
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 409
Step 3: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 410
Step 4: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 411
Step 5: Remove the feed/MP drive unit .................................................................................. 413
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 415
Registration drive assembly .......................................................................................................................... 416
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 416
Before performing service ................................................................................... 416
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 416
After performing service ....................................................................................... 416
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 417
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 417
Step 2: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 417
Step 3: Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................... 418
Step 4: Remove the registration drive assembly .................................................................. 418
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 419
Toner collection unit (TCU) sensors .............................................................................................................. 420
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 420
Before performing service ................................................................................... 420
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 421
After performing service ....................................................................................... 421
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 421
Step 1: Remove the TCU ............................................................................................................ 421
Step 2: Remove the front cover. ............................................................................................... 421
Step 3: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 422
Step 4: Remove the front power cover ................................................................................... 422
Step 5: Remove the output bin ................................................................................................ 423
ENWW xxi
Step 6: Remove the paper dust brush .................................................................................... 424
Step 7: Remove the inner front cover ..................................................................................... 424
Step 8: Remove the TCU sensors ............................................................................................. 426
Step 9: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 426
Reservoir unit ................................................................................................................................................... 428
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 428
Before performing service ................................................................................... 428
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 428
After performing service ....................................................................................... 429
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 429
Step 1: Remove the developer unit ......................................................................................... 429
Step 2: Remove the left cover .................................................................................................. 431
Step 3: Remove the laser scanner assembly ......................................................................... 432
Step 4: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 433
Step 5: Remove the output bin ................................................................................................ 434
Step 6: Remove the paper dust brush .................................................................................... 434
Step 7: Remove the inner front cover ..................................................................................... 435
Step 8: Remove the reservoir unit ........................................................................................... 436
Step 9: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 438
Auto size sensor .............................................................................................................................................. 440
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 440
Before performing service ................................................................................... 440
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 440
After performing service ....................................................................................... 440
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 440
Step 1: Remove the auto size sensor ..................................................................................... 441
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 441
Fuser out sensor (on the right door) ............................................................................................................ 442
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 442
Before performing service ................................................................................... 442
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 442
After performing service ....................................................................................... 442
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 443
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 443
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 444
Step 3: Remove the fuser out sensor ..................................................................................... 445
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 447
Feed 2 sensor (on the right door) ................................................................................................................. 448
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 448
Before performing service ................................................................................... 448
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 448
xxii ENWW
After performing service ....................................................................................... 448
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 449
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 449
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 450
Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper ....... 451
Step 4: Remove the feed 2 sensor .......................................................................................... 454
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 454
Multi-purpose (MP) unit (on the right door) ................................................................................................ 455
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 455
Before performing service ................................................................................... 455
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 455
After performing service ....................................................................................... 455
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 456
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 456
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 457
Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper ....... 458
Step 4: Remove the MP unit ..................................................................................................... 460
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 464
Multi-purpose (MP) empty sensor ................................................................................................................ 466
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 466
Before performing service ................................................................................... 466
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 466
After performing service ....................................................................................... 466
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 467
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 467
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 468
Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper ....... 470
Step 4: Remove the MP unit ..................................................................................................... 472
Step 5: Remove the MP empty sensor .................................................................................... 476
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 476
Multi-purpose (MP) paper length sensor .................................................................................................... 478
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 478
Before performing service ................................................................................... 478
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 478
After performing service ....................................................................................... 478
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 479
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 479
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 480
Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper ....... 482
Step 4: Remove the MP unit ..................................................................................................... 484
Step 5: Remove the MP paper length sensor ........................................................................ 488
ENWW xxiii
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 489
Multi-purpose (MP) solenoid ......................................................................................................................... 490
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 490
Before performing service ................................................................................... 490
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 490
After performing service ....................................................................................... 490
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 491
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 491
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 492
Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper ....... 494
Step 4: Remove the MP unit ..................................................................................................... 496
Step 5: Remove the MP solenoid ............................................................................................. 500
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 501
Output unit ....................................................................................................................................................... 503
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 503
Before performing service ................................................................................... 503
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 503
After performing service ....................................................................................... 504
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 504
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 504
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 505
Step 3: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 507
Step 4: Remove the front power cover ................................................................................... 507
Step 5: Remove the top right cover ......................................................................................... 508
Step 6: Remove the fuser unit .................................................................................................. 509
Step 7: Remove the output unit ............................................................................................... 510
Step 8: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 511
Return sensor (on the output unit) .............................................................................................................. 512
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 512
Before performing service ................................................................................... 512
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 512
After performing service ....................................................................................... 513
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 513
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 513
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 514
Step 3: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 516
Step 4: Remove the front power cover ................................................................................... 516
Step 5: Remove the top right cover ......................................................................................... 517
Step 6: Remove the fuser unit .................................................................................................. 518
Step 7: Remove the output unit ............................................................................................... 519
Step 8: Remove the return sensor .......................................................................................... 520
xxiv ENWW
Step 9: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 521
Duplex 1 sensor (on the output unit) ........................................................................................................... 522
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 522
Before performing service ................................................................................... 522
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 522
After performing service ....................................................................................... 523
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 523
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 523
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 524
Step 3: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 526
Step 4: Remove the front power cover ................................................................................... 526
Step 5: Remove the top right cover ......................................................................................... 527
Step 6: Remove the fuser unit .................................................................................................. 528
Step 7: Remove the output unit ............................................................................................... 529
Step 8: Remove the duplex 1 sensor ...................................................................................... 530
Step 9: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 531
Output 1 bin full sensor (on the output unit) .............................................................................................. 532
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 532
Before performing service ................................................................................... 532
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 532
After performing service ....................................................................................... 533
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 533
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 533
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 534
Step 3: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 536
Step 4: Remove the front power cover ................................................................................... 536
Step 5: Remove the top right cover ......................................................................................... 537
Step 6: Remove the fuser unit .................................................................................................. 538
Step 7: Remove the output unit ............................................................................................... 539
Step 8: Remove the output 1 bin full sensor ......................................................................... 540
Step 9: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 542
Output gate solenoid (on the output unit) .................................................................................................. 544
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 544
Before performing service ................................................................................... 544
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 544
After performing service ....................................................................................... 545
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 545
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 545
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 546
Step 3: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 548
Step 4: Remove the front power cover ................................................................................... 548
ENWW xxv
Step 5: Remove the top right cover ......................................................................................... 549
Step 6: Remove the fuser unit .................................................................................................. 550
Step 7: Remove the output unit ............................................................................................... 551
Step 8: Remove the output gate solenoid ............................................................................. 552
Step 9: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 553
Pickup unit 2 .................................................................................................................................................... 554
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 554
Before performing service ................................................................................... 554
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 554
After performing service ....................................................................................... 554
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 555
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 555
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 556
Step 3: Remove pickup unit 2 ................................................................................................... 557
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 560
Pickup lifting and empty sensor (pickup unit 2) ......................................................................................... 561
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 561
Before performing service ................................................................................... 561
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 561
After performing service ....................................................................................... 561
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 562
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 562
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 563
Step 3: Remove pickup unit 2 ................................................................................................... 565
Step 4: Remove the pickup lifting and empty sensor ........................................................... 567
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 568
Prefeed sensor 2 (pickup unit 2) .................................................................................................................. 569
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 569
Before performing service ................................................................................... 569
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 569
After performing service ....................................................................................... 569
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 570
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 570
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 571
Step 3: Remove pickup unit 2 ................................................................................................... 572
Step 4: Remove the prefeed sensor 2 .................................................................................... 575
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 575
Pickup unit 1 .................................................................................................................................................... 577
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 577
Before performing service ................................................................................... 577
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 577
xxvi ENWW
After performing service ....................................................................................... 577
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 578
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 578
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 579
Step 3: Remove pickup unit 2 ................................................................................................... 580
Step 4: Remove pickup unit 1 ................................................................................................... 583
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 585
Pickup lifting and empty sensor (pickup unit 1) ......................................................................................... 586
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 586
Before performing service ................................................................................... 586
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 586
After performing service ....................................................................................... 587
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 587
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 587
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 588
Step 3: Remove pickup unit 2 ................................................................................................... 590
Step 4: Remove pickup unit 1 ................................................................................................... 592
Step 5: Remove the pickup lifting and empty sensor ........................................................... 594
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 595
Prefeed sensor 1 (pickup unit 1) .................................................................................................................. 596
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 596
Before performing service ................................................................................... 596
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 596
After performing service ....................................................................................... 596
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 597
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 597
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 598
Step 3: Remove pickup unit 2 ................................................................................................... 600
Step 4: Remove pickup unit 1 ................................................................................................... 602
Step 5: Remove the prefeed sensor 1 .................................................................................... 604
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 605
Internal hard disk drive (HDD) ....................................................................................................................... 607
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 607
Before performing service ................................................................................... 607
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 607
After performing service ....................................................................................... 607
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 608
Step 1: Remove the front top inner cover .............................................................................. 608
Step 2: Remove the output bin ................................................................................................ 608
Step 3: Remove the HDD ........................................................................................................... 609
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 609
ENWW xxvii
Registration assembly .................................................................................................................................... 611
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 611
Before performing service ................................................................................... 611
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 611
After performing service ....................................................................................... 611
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 612
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 612
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 613
Step 3: Remove the paper dust brush .................................................................................... 614
Step 4: Remove the registration assembly ............................................................................ 615
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 619
Registration sensor assembly ...................................................................................................................... 620
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 620
Before performing service ................................................................................... 620
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 620
After performing service ....................................................................................... 620
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 621
Step 1: Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................... 621
Step 2: Remove the right door ................................................................................................. 622
Step 3: Remove the paper dust brush .................................................................................... 624
Step 4: Remove the registration assembly ............................................................................ 624
Step 5: Remove the registration sensor assembly ............................................................... 628
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 629
High voltage terminal ..................................................................................................................................... 631
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 631
Before performing service ................................................................................... 631
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 631
After performing service ....................................................................................... 632
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 632
Step 1: Remove the drum unit ................................................................................................. 632
Step 2: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 633
Step 3: Remove the lower rear cover ...................................................................................... 633
Step 4: Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................... 634
Step 5: Remove the left rear corner cover ............................................................................. 634
Step 6: Remove the formatter and cage ................................................................................ 635
Step 7: Remove the main board and cage ............................................................................. 636
Step 8: Remove the main drive unit ........................................................................................ 638
Step 9: Remove the high voltage terminal ............................................................................. 640
Step 10: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 642
Flow ADF ............................................................................................................................................................................... 643
Flow ADF whole unit ....................................................................................................................................... 643
xxviii ENWW
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 643
Before performing service ................................................................................... 643
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 643
After performing service ....................................................................................... 643
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 643
Step 1: Remove the ADF whole unit ........................................................................................ 644
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 646
Flow ADF jam access cover ............................................................................................................................ 647
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 647
Before performing service ................................................................................... 647
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 648
After performing service ....................................................................................... 648
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 648
Step 1: Remove the document feeder front cover ............................................................... 649
Step 2: Remove the document feeder back cover ................................................................ 649
Step 3: Remove the document feeder jam access cover ..................................................... 650
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 652
Flow ADF input tray ......................................................................................................................................... 653
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 653
Before performing service ................................................................................... 653
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 653
After performing service ....................................................................................... 653
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 654
Step 1: Remove the document feeder front cover ............................................................... 655
Step 2: Remove the document feeder back cover ................................................................ 655
Step 3: Remove the dampening unit ....................................................................................... 656
Step 4: Remove the pickup and feed unit ............................................................................... 657
Step 5: Remove the input tray ................................................................................................. 658
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 658
Flow ADF contact image sensor (CIS) .......................................................................................................... 660
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 660
Before performing service ................................................................................... 660
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 660
After performing service ....................................................................................... 660
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 661
Step 1: Remove the document feeder front cover ............................................................... 662
Step 2: Remove the document feeder back cover ................................................................ 662
Step 3: Remove the document feeder pickup and feed assembly .................................... 663
Step 4: Remove the paper path cover .................................................................................... 664
Step 5: Remove the CIS assembly ........................................................................................... 664
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 665
ENWW xxix
Flow ADF front motor ..................................................................................................................................... 667
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 667
Before performing service ................................................................................... 667
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 667
After performing service ....................................................................................... 667
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 667
Step 1: Remove the document feeder back cover ................................................................ 668
Step 2: Remove the front motor .............................................................................................. 668
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 669
Flow ADF rear motors ..................................................................................................................................... 671
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 671
Before performing service ................................................................................... 671
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 671
After performing service ....................................................................................... 672
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 672
Step 1: Identify the document feeder motors ....................................................................... 673
Step 2: Remove the document feeder back cover ................................................................ 674
Step 3: Remove motors 1 and 2 .............................................................................................. 675
Step 4: Remove the pickup and pre-REGI motors ................................................................. 676
Step 5: Remove the exit motor ................................................................................................ 678
Step 6: Remove the feed motor ............................................................................................... 679
Step 7: Remove the REGI motor .............................................................................................. 680
Step 8: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 680
Flow ADF PCA fan ............................................................................................................................................ 681
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 681
Before performing service ................................................................................... 681
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 681
After performing service ....................................................................................... 681
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 681
Step 1: Remove the document feeder back cover ................................................................ 682
Step 2: Remove the document feeder PCA fan ..................................................................... 682
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 683
Flow ADF contact image sensor (CIS) fan .................................................................................................... 684
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 684
Before performing service ................................................................................... 684
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 684
After performing service ....................................................................................... 684
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 684
Step 1: Remove the document feeder back cover ................................................................ 685
Step 2: Remove the document feeder CIS fan ....................................................................... 685
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 686
xxx ENWW
Flow ADF ultrasonic sensor with PCA .......................................................................................................... 687
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 687
Before performing service ................................................................................... 687
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 687
After performing service ....................................................................................... 687
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 688
Step 1: Remove the document feeder front cover ............................................................... 689
Step 2: Remove the document feeder back cover ................................................................ 689
Step 3: Remove the document feeder pickup and feed assembly .................................... 690
Step 4: Remove the paper path cover .................................................................................... 691
Step 5: Remove the ultrasonic sensor with PCA ................................................................... 691
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 693
White backing .................................................................................................................................................. 693
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 694
Before performing service ................................................................................... 694
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 694
After performing service ....................................................................................... 694
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 694
Step 1: Remove the white backing .......................................................................................... 694
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 695
Scanner unit (image scanner unit) .................................................................................................................................... 696
Scanner whole unit ......................................................................................................................................... 696
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 696
Before performing service ................................................................................... 696
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 696
After performing service ....................................................................................... 696
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 697
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 697
Step 2: Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................... 697
Step 3: Remove the flow ADF whole unit ............................................................................... 698
Step 4: Remove the control panel bezel ................................................................................ 701
Step 5: Remove the control panel ........................................................................................... 701
Step 6: Remove the keyboard (z bundles) ............................................................................. 702
Step 7: Remove the scanner whole unit ................................................................................. 703
Step 8: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 707
Scan glass ......................................................................................................................................................... 708
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 708
Before performing service ................................................................................... 708
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 708
After performing service ....................................................................................... 708
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 708
ENWW xxxi
Step 1: Remove the scan glass ................................................................................................ 708
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 709
LED lamp module ............................................................................................................................................ 710
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 710
Before performing service ................................................................................... 710
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 710
After performing service ....................................................................................... 710
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 711
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 711
Step 2: Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................... 711
Step 3: Remove the flow ADF whole unit ............................................................................... 712
Step 4: Remove the scanner glass .......................................................................................... 714
Step 5: Remove the LED lamp module ................................................................................... 716
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 717
Scanner imaging unit ...................................................................................................................................... 718
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 718
Before performing service ................................................................................... 718
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 718
After performing service ....................................................................................... 718
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 718
Step 1: Remove the scanner glass .......................................................................................... 719
Step 2: Remove the scanner imaging unit ............................................................................. 719
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 720
Scan joint board ............................................................................................................................................... 722
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 722
Before performing service ................................................................................... 722
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 722
After performing service ....................................................................................... 722
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 722
Step 1: Remove the formatter cover ....................................................................................... 723
Step 2: Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................... 723
Step 3: Remove the document feeder whole unit ................................................................ 723
Step 4: Remove the scan joint board ...................................................................................... 726
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 729
APS sensor ....................................................................................................................................................... 730
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 730
Before performing service ................................................................................... 730
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 730
After performing service ....................................................................................... 730
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 730
Step 1: Remove the document feeder whole unit ................................................................ 731
xxxii ENWW
Step 2: Remove the scanner glass .......................................................................................... 733
Step 3: Remove the APS sensor .............................................................................................. 734
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 735
Dual cassette feeder (DCF) ................................................................................................................................................. 737
Dual cassette feeder (DCF) right door ......................................................................................................... 738
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 738
Before performing service ................................................................................... 738
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 738
After performing service ....................................................................................... 738
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 738
Step 1: Remove the printer right rear cover .......................................................................... 738
Step 2: Remove the printer right door .................................................................................... 739
Step 3: Remove the dual cassette feeder (DCF) right door ................................................. 741
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 743
Dual cassette feeder (DCF) motor ................................................................................................................ 744
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 744
Before performing service ................................................................................... 744
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 744
After performing service ....................................................................................... 744
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 744
Step 1: Remove the DCF rear cover ......................................................................................... 744
Step 2: Remove the dual cassette feeder (DCF) motor ........................................................ 745
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 746
Dual cassette feeder (DCF) pickup motor ................................................................................................... 748
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 748
Before performing service ................................................................................... 748
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 748
After performing service ....................................................................................... 748
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 748
Step 1: Remove the DCF rear cover ......................................................................................... 748
Step 2: Remove the dual cassette feeder (DCF) pickup motor ........................................... 749
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 749
Dual cassette feeder (DCF) PCA .................................................................................................................... 750
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 750
Before performing service ................................................................................... 750
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 750
After performing service ....................................................................................... 750
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 750
Step 1: Remove the DCF rear cover ......................................................................................... 750
Step 2: Remove the dual cassette feeder (DCF) PCA ............................................................ 751
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 751
ENWW xxxiii
Dual cassette feeder (DCF) pickup units ...................................................................................................... 753
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 753
Before performing service ................................................................................... 753
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 753
After performing service ....................................................................................... 753
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 753
Step 1: Remove the printer right rear cover .......................................................................... 754
Step 2: Remove the printer right door .................................................................................... 754
Step 3: Remove the dual cassette feeder (DCF) right door ................................................. 756
Step 4: Remove the dual cassette feeder (DCF) pickup units ............................................. 758
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 760
Bottom high-capacity input (HCI) tray .............................................................................................................................. 761
Bottom HCI tray feed motor .......................................................................................................................... 762
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 762
Before performing service ................................................................................... 762
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 762
After performing service ....................................................................................... 762
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 762
Step 1: Remove the bottom HCI rear cover ............................................................................ 762
Step 2: Remove the bottom HCI tray feed motor .................................................................. 763
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 764
Bottom HCI tray pickup motor ...................................................................................................................... 765
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 765
Before performing service ................................................................................... 765
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 765
After performing service ....................................................................................... 765
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 765
Step 1: Remove the bottom HCI rear cover ............................................................................ 765
Step 2: Remove the bottom HCI tray pickup motor .............................................................. 766
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 766
Bottom HCI tray PCA ....................................................................................................................................... 768
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 768
Before performing service ................................................................................... 768
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 768
After performing service ....................................................................................... 768
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 768
Step 1: Remove the bottom HCI rear cover ............................................................................ 768
Step 2: Remove the bottom HCI tray PCA .............................................................................. 769
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 769
Bottom HCI tray lift-up motor ....................................................................................................................... 771
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 771
xxxiv ENWW
Before performing service ................................................................................... 771
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 771
After performing service ....................................................................................... 771
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 771
Step 1: Remove the bottom HCI rear cover ............................................................................ 771
Step 2: Remove the bottom HCI tray lift-up motor ............................................................... 772
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 772
Bottom HCI tray shaft motor ......................................................................................................................... 773
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 773
Before performing service ................................................................................... 773
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 773
After performing service ....................................................................................... 773
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 773
Step 1: Remove the bottom HCI rear cover ............................................................................ 773
Step 2: Remove the bottom HCI tray shaft motor ................................................................ 774
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 774
Side high capacity input (sHCI) ........................................................................................................................................... 775
Side HCI rear cover .......................................................................................................................................... 776
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 776
Before performing service ................................................................................... 776
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 776
After performing service ....................................................................................... 776
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 776
Step 1: Remove the side HCI rear cover .................................................................................. 776
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 777
Side HCI feed motor ........................................................................................................................................ 778
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 778
Before performing service ................................................................................... 778
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 778
After performing service ....................................................................................... 778
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 778
Step 1: Remove the side HCI right cover ................................................................................. 779
Step 2: Remove the side HCI cable cover ............................................................................... 779
Step 3: Remove the side HCI rear cover .................................................................................. 779
Step 4: Remove the side HCI feed motor ................................................................................ 780
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 780
Side HCI pickup motor .................................................................................................................................... 782
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 782
Before performing service ................................................................................... 782
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 782
After performing service ....................................................................................... 782
ENWW xxxv
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 782
Step 1: Remove the side HCI right cover ................................................................................. 783
Step 2: Remove the side HCI cable cover ............................................................................... 783
Step 3: Remove the side HCI rear cover .................................................................................. 783
Step 4: Remove the side HCI pickup motor ............................................................................ 784
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 784
Side HCI PCA ..................................................................................................................................................... 785
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 785
Before performing service ................................................................................... 785
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 785
After performing service ....................................................................................... 785
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 785
Step 1: Remove the side HCI right cover ................................................................................. 786
Step 2: Remove the side HCI cable cover ............................................................................... 786
Step 3: Remove the side HCI rear cover .................................................................................. 786
Step 4: Remove the side HCI PCA ............................................................................................. 787
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 787
Side HCI lift-up motor ..................................................................................................................................... 788
Introduction ................................................................................................................................. 788
Before performing service ................................................................................... 788
Required tools ........................................................................................................ 788
After performing service ....................................................................................... 788
Post service test ..................................................................................................... 788
Step 1: Remove the side HCI right cover ................................................................................. 789
Step 2: Remove the side HCI cable cover ............................................................................... 789
Step 3: Remove the side HCI rear cover .................................................................................. 789
Step 4: Remove the side HCI lift-up motor ............................................................................. 790
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ........................................................................... 790
xxxvi ENWW
Second cassette .............................................................................................................................................. 802
Main frame assembly ..................................................................................................................................... 804
Main frame registration .................................................................................................................................. 806
Drive system .................................................................................................................................................... 808
Main frame pickup 1 and 2 ............................................................................................................................ 810
Main frame pickup ........................................................................................................................................... 812
Cover ................................................................................................................................................................. 814
Right door ......................................................................................................................................................... 816
MP tray .............................................................................................................................................................. 818
Right door guide .............................................................................................................................................. 820
Right door output and takeaway .................................................................................................................. 822
PTB transfer ..................................................................................................................................................... 824
Flow ADF ........................................................................................................................................................... 826
Flow ADF open cover ...................................................................................................................................... 828
Flow ADF pickup roller assembly .................................................................................................................. 830
Flow ADF stacker ............................................................................................................................................. 832
Flow ADF main ................................................................................................................................................. 834
Flow ADF image scanner ................................................................................................................................ 836
Flow ADF image scanner, lower .................................................................................................................... 838
Reservoir .......................................................................................................................................................... 840
Dual cassette feeder (DCF) ................................................................................................................................................. 842
DCF main .......................................................................................................................................................... 842
DCF frame ......................................................................................................................................................... 844
DCF rear frame ................................................................................................................................................ 846
Opt feed drive .................................................................................................................................................. 848
DCF second pickup .......................................................................................................................................... 850
High capacity input tray (HCI) ............................................................................................................................................. 852
HCI main ............................................................................................................................................................ 852
HCI drive ............................................................................................................................................................ 854
HCI cassette ..................................................................................................................................................... 856
HCI frame .......................................................................................................................................................... 858
HCI main pickup ............................................................................................................................................... 860
High capacity input tray side unit (sHCI) ........................................................................................................................... 862
sHCI main 1 ...................................................................................................................................................... 862
sHCI main 3 ...................................................................................................................................................... 864
sHCI main 5 ...................................................................................................................................................... 866
sHCI main 6 ...................................................................................................................................................... 868
Pickup cover unit ............................................................................................................................................. 870
sHCI frame ........................................................................................................................................................ 872
Finishers ................................................................................................................................................................................ 874
Booklet finisher ............................................................................................................................................... 874
ENWW xxxvii
Mainline finisher 1 ........................................................................................................................................... 876
Mainline finisher 2 ........................................................................................................................................... 878
Mainline finisher 3 ........................................................................................................................................... 880
Mainline finisher 4 ........................................................................................................................................... 882
Mainline finisher 5 ........................................................................................................................................... 884
Mainline finisher 6 ........................................................................................................................................... 886
Three fold motor, curl pawl motor, curl pawl, and three fold output .................................................... 888
Low output, hb motor, and top guide .......................................................................................................... 890
SCU motor, STK motor, and entrance guide ............................................................................................... 892
Entrance motor, low paddle, alignment, and paddle motor .................................................................... 894
Drive buffer, top lower, and top jam ............................................................................................................ 896
FD stopper unit, jam clear, and BKT main blade ........................................................................................ 898
Fold roller, main blade, and top frame ........................................................................................................ 900
Three fold blade .............................................................................................................................................. 902
Door, top door, top cover, and registration guide ...................................................................................... 904
Entrance guide, mid jam, and main output ................................................................................................. 906
Transfer buffer, right jam, div cam, hb motor, and paddle motor .......................................................... 908
Front alignment (tamper) .............................................................................................................................. 910
Rear alignment (tamper) ............................................................................................................................... 912
Shield ................................................................................................................................................................ 914
PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and paddle .................................................................................................. 916
Finisher sub booklet ....................................................................................................................................... 918
IPTU (bridge) .................................................................................................................................................... 920
Inner finisher ......................................................................................................................................................................... 922
Sub-inner finisher ............................................................................................................................................ 922
Finisher sub 1 ................................................................................................................................................... 924
Finisher sub 7 ................................................................................................................................................... 926
Finisher sub 8 ................................................................................................................................................... 928
Alphabetical parts list ......................................................................................................................................................... 930
Numerical parts list ............................................................................................................................................................. 951
xxxviii ENWW
Tools for troubleshooting ..................................................................................... 987
Tools for troubleshooting ................................................................................................................................................... 988
Problem-solving checklist ............................................................................................................................. 988
Step 1: Check that the printer power is on ............................................................................. 988
Step 2: Check the control panel for error messages ............................................................ 988
Step 3: Test print functionality ................................................................................................. 988
Step 4: Test copy functionality ................................................................................................. 989
Step 5: Test the fax sending functionality .............................................................................. 989
Step 6: Test the fax receiving functionality ............................................................................ 989
Step 7: Try sending a print job from a computer .................................................................. 989
Step 8: Test the Plug and Print USB Drive printing functionality ........................................ 989
Factors that affect printer performance ................................................................................. 989
Print menu map ............................................................................................................................................... 991
Print current settings pages .......................................................................................................................... 991
Print event log ................................................................................................................................................. 991
Pre-boot menu options .................................................................................................................................. 993
Remote Admin .......................................................................................................................... 1002
Required software and network connection ................................................... 1002
Connect a remote connection ........................................................................... 1004
Disconnect a remote connection ...................................................................... 1008
Control panel menus .................................................................................................................................... 1010
Reports menu ........................................................................................................................... 1010
Settings menu .......................................................................................................................... 1013
Copy menu (MFP only) ............................................................................................................ 1057
Scan menu (MFP only) ............................................................................................................. 1062
Fax menu (fax models only) ................................................................................................... 1071
Print menu ................................................................................................................................. 1075
Supplies menu .......................................................................................................................... 1076
Trays menu ............................................................................................................................... 1077
Troubleshooting menu ............................................................................................................ 1078
Maintenance menu .................................................................................................................. 1080
Backup/Restore menu ........................................................................................ 1080
Calibration/Cleaning menu ................................................................................ 1080
USB Firmware Upgrade menu ........................................................................... 1082
Clear paper jams ................................................................................................................................................................ 1083
Clearing original document jams ............................................................................................................... 1083
Clearing paper jams ...................................................................................................................................... 1087
Service mode (tech mode) ............................................................................................................................................... 1096
Entering service mode ................................................................................................................................. 1096
Service mode menu tree ............................................................................................................................. 1097
Information .................................................................................................................................................... 1101
ENWW xxxix
General ....................................................................................................................................... 1101
Supply status ............................................................................................................................ 1101
Software version ...................................................................................................................... 1101
Print reports .............................................................................................................................. 1102
Maintenance counts ..................................................................................................................................... 1102
Part replacement count .......................................................................................................... 1102
Diagnostics .................................................................................................................................................... 1103
Engine diagnostics ................................................................................................................... 1103
Fax diagnostics ......................................................................................................................... 1113
Scanner diagnostics ................................................................................................................. 1118
Adjustment ................................................................................................................................ 1122
Image management ................................................................................................................ 1128
Print test patterns .................................................................................................................... 1128
Service functions .......................................................................................................................................... 1129
Main memory clear .................................................................................................................. 1129
Debug log .................................................................................................................................. 1129
Capture log ................................................................................................................................ 1129
Transfer assembly control mode .......................................................................................... 1130
Envelope rotate ........................................................................................................................ 1130
Print quality troubleshooting guide ................................................................................................................................ 1132
Image quality problems and solutions ...................................................................................................... 1132
Vertical black lines ................................................................................................................... 1135
Vertical light or white lines ..................................................................................................... 1136
Horizontal periodic black lines, dots ..................................................................................... 1137
Horizontal periodic light/dark lines, dots ............................................................................. 1138
Blurred image ........................................................................................................................... 1139
Foggy image ............................................................................................................................. 1140
Light image ............................................................................................................................... 1141
Uneven pitch and jitter image ................................................................................................ 1141
Skewed image .......................................................................................................................... 1143
Poor fusing performance ........................................................................................................ 1143
Stain on the paper back side .................................................................................................. 1144
Setting standard tone ............................................................................................................. 1145
Other errors ................................................................................................................................................... 1148
Image system problem ........................................................................................................... 1148
Fuser problem .......................................................................................................................... 1151
Scanner and Flow ADF problems ........................................................................................... 1153
Drive unit problem ................................................................................................................... 1156
Feeding system problem ........................................................................................................ 1156
Laser scanner assembly problem ......................................................................................... 1158
Electrical circuit problem ........................................................................................................ 1158
xl ENWW
Adjusting the Flow ADF skew .......................................................................................................................................... 1164
ENWW xli
Post-service test ........................................................................................................................................... 1197
Print-quality test ...................................................................................................................... 1197
Order parts, accessories, and supplies ..................................................................................................... 1197
Ordering ..................................................................................................................................... 1197
Orderable parts ........................................................................................................................ 1197
Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) ..................................................... 1198
Top output bin ............................................................................................................................................... 1200
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1200
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1200
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1200
After performing service .................................................................................... 1200
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1201
Step 1: Remove the top output bin ....................................................................................... 1201
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1201
Right top cover .............................................................................................................................................. 1202
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1202
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1202
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1202
After performing service .................................................................................... 1202
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1203
Step 1: Remove the right top cover ...................................................................................... 1203
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1203
Top cover ........................................................................................................................................................ 1205
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1205
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1205
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1205
After performing service .................................................................................... 1205
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1206
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1206
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1206
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1208
Front door ...................................................................................................................................................... 1209
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1209
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1209
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1209
After performing service .................................................................................... 1209
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1210
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1210
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1210
Step 3: Remove the front door (finisher) ............................................................................. 1212
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1214
xlii ENWW
Rear cover ...................................................................................................................................................... 1216
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1216
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1216
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1216
After performing service .................................................................................... 1216
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1217
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1217
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1217
Step 3: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1219
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1220
Front cover ..................................................................................................................................................... 1221
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1221
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1221
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1221
After performing service .................................................................................... 1221
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1222
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1222
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1222
Step 3: Remove the front door (finisher) ............................................................................. 1224
Step 4: Remove the front cover (finisher) ............................................................................ 1226
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1228
Front lower cover .......................................................................................................................................... 1229
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1229
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1229
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1229
After performing service .................................................................................... 1230
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1230
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1230
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1230
Step 3: Remove the front door (finisher) ............................................................................. 1232
Step 4: Remove the front cover (finisher) ............................................................................ 1234
Step 5: Remove the front lower cover (finisher) ................................................................. 1236
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1236
Booklet tray ................................................................................................................................................... 1238
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1238
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1238
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1238
After performing service .................................................................................... 1238
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1239
Step 1: Remove the booklet tray ........................................................................................... 1239
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1240
ENWW xliii
Caster cover ................................................................................................................................................... 1241
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1241
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1241
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1241
After performing service .................................................................................... 1241
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1242
Step 1: Remove the booklet tray (booklet finishers only) ................................................. 1242
Step 2: Remove the caster cover ........................................................................................... 1243
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1244
Lower shield assembly ................................................................................................................................ 1245
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1245
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1245
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1246
After performing service .................................................................................... 1246
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1246
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1246
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1246
Step 3: Remove the front door (finisher) ............................................................................. 1248
Step 4: Remove the front cover (finisher) ............................................................................ 1250
Step 5: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1252
Step 6: Remove the booklet tray ........................................................................................... 1253
Step 7: Remove the caster cover ........................................................................................... 1254
Step 8: Remove the lower shield assembly (finisher) ........................................................ 1255
Step 9: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1257
Upper shield assembly ................................................................................................................................ 1258
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1258
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1258
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1259
After performing service .................................................................................... 1259
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1259
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1259
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1259
Step 3: Remove the front door (finisher) ............................................................................. 1261
Step 4: Remove the front cover (finisher) ............................................................................ 1263
Step 5: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1265
Step 6: Remove the booklet tray ........................................................................................... 1266
Step 7: Remove the caster cover ........................................................................................... 1267
Step 8: Remove the lower shield assembly (finisher) ........................................................ 1268
Step 9: Remove the upper shield assembly (finisher) ....................................................... 1270
Step 10: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................................... 1272
Controller PCA ............................................................................................................................................... 1274
xliv ENWW
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1274
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1274
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1274
After performing service .................................................................................... 1274
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1275
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1275
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1275
Step 3: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1277
Step 4: Remove the controller PCA ....................................................................................... 1278
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1279
Stapler unit .................................................................................................................................................... 1280
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1280
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1280
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1280
After performing service .................................................................................... 1281
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1281
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1281
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1281
Step 3: Remove the front door (finisher) ............................................................................. 1283
Step 4: Remove the front cover (finisher) ............................................................................ 1285
Step 5: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1287
Step 6: Remove the staple unit ............................................................................................. 1288
Step 7: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1290
Dummy feed guide ....................................................................................................................................... 1292
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1292
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1292
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1292
After performing service .................................................................................... 1292
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1293
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1293
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1293
Step 3: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1295
Step 4: Remove the dummy feed guide (finisher) .............................................................. 1296
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1297
Top jam access cover ................................................................................................................................... 1298
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1298
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1298
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1298
After performing service .................................................................................... 1299
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1299
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1299
ENWW xlv
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1299
Step 3: Remove the front door (finisher) ............................................................................. 1301
Step 4: Remove the front cover (finisher) ............................................................................ 1303
Step 5: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1305
Step 6: Remove the feed exit motor ..................................................................................... 1306
Step 7: Remove the top jam access cover ........................................................................... 1307
Step 8: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1307
Top lower feed assembly ............................................................................................................................ 1309
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1309
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1309
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1309
After performing service .................................................................................... 1310
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1310
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1310
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1310
Step 3: Remove the front door (finisher) ............................................................................. 1312
Step 4: Remove the front cover (finisher) ............................................................................ 1314
Step 5: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1316
Step 6: Remove the feed exit motor (finisher) .................................................................... 1317
Step 7: Remove the top jam access cover ........................................................................... 1318
Step 8: Remove the top lower feed assembly (finisher) .................................................... 1318
Step 9: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1321
Ejector unit ..................................................................................................................................................... 1322
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1322
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1322
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1323
After performing service .................................................................................... 1323
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1323
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1323
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1323
Step 3: Remove the front door (finisher) ............................................................................. 1325
Step 4: Remove the front cover (finisher) ............................................................................ 1327
Step 5: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1329
Step 6: Remove the booklet tray (finisher) .......................................................................... 1330
Step 7: Remove the caster cover (finisher) .......................................................................... 1331
Step 8: Remove the lower shield assembly (finisher) ........................................................ 1332
Step 9: Remove the upper shield assembly (finisher) ....................................................... 1334
Step 10: Remove the ejector unit (finisher) ......................................................................... 1336
Step 11: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................................... 1345
Front tamper unit ......................................................................................................................................... 1347
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1347
xlvi ENWW
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1347
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1348
After performing service .................................................................................... 1348
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1348
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1348
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1348
Step 3: Remove the front door (finisher) ............................................................................. 1350
Step 4: Remove the front cover (finisher) ............................................................................ 1352
Step 5: Remove the rear cover .............................................................................................. 1354
Step 6: Remove the booklet tray (finisher) .......................................................................... 1355
Step 7: Remove the caster cover (finisher) .......................................................................... 1356
Step 8: Remove the lower shield assembly (finisher) ........................................................ 1357
Step 9: Remove the upper shield assembly (finisher) ....................................................... 1359
Step 10: Remove the ejector unit (finisher) ......................................................................... 1361
Step 11: Remove the front tamper unit ............................................................................... 1370
Step 12: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................................... 1371
Rear tamper unit ........................................................................................................................................... 1372
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1372
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1372
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1373
After performing service .................................................................................... 1373
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1373
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1373
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1373
Step 3: Remove the front door (finisher) ............................................................................. 1375
Step 4: Remove the front cover (finisher) ............................................................................ 1377
Step 5: Remove the rear cover .............................................................................................. 1379
Step 6: Remove the booklet tray (finisher) .......................................................................... 1380
Step 7: Remove the caster cover (finisher) .......................................................................... 1381
Step 8: Remove the lower shield assembly (finisher) ........................................................ 1382
Step 9: Remove the upper shield assembly (finisher) ....................................................... 1384
Step 10: Remove the ejector unit (finisher) ......................................................................... 1386
Step 11: Remove the rear tamper unit ................................................................................. 1395
Step 12: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................................... 1396
Feed entrance motor (M1) .......................................................................................................................... 1397
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1397
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1397
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1397
After performing service .................................................................................... 1397
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1398
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1398
ENWW xlvii
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1398
Step 3: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1400
Step 4: Remove the feed entrance motor (M1) .................................................................. 1401
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1402
Feed exit motor (M2) .................................................................................................................................... 1403
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1403
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1403
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1403
After performing service .................................................................................... 1403
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1404
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1404
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1404
Step 3: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1406
Step 4: Remove the feed exit motor (M2) ............................................................................ 1407
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1408
Buffer motor, gear, and sensor (M3) ......................................................................................................... 1409
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1409
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1409
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1409
After performing service .................................................................................... 1409
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1410
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1410
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1410
Step 3: Remove the front cover (finisher) ............................................................................ 1412
Step 4: Remove the buffer motor, gear, and sensor .......................................................... 1413
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1416
Front tamper motor (M6) ............................................................................................................................ 1417
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1417
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1417
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1418
After performing service .................................................................................... 1418
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1418
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1418
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1419
Step 3: Remove the front door (finisher) ............................................................................. 1420
Step 4: Remove the front cover (finisher) ............................................................................ 1422
Step 5: Remove the rear cover .............................................................................................. 1424
Step 6: Remove the booklet tray (finisher) .......................................................................... 1425
Step 7: Remove the caster cover (finisher) .......................................................................... 1426
Step 8: Remove the lower shield assembly (finisher) ........................................................ 1427
Step 9: Remove the upper shield assembly (finisher) ....................................................... 1429
xlviii ENWW
Step 10: Remove the ejector unit (finisher) ......................................................................... 1431
Step 11: Remove the front tamper (finisher) ...................................................................... 1440
Step 12: Remove the front tamper motor (M7) .................................................................. 1441
Step 13: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................................... 1442
Rear tamper motor (M7) .............................................................................................................................. 1443
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1443
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1443
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1444
After performing service .................................................................................... 1444
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1444
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1444
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1445
Step 3: Remove the front door (finisher) ............................................................................. 1446
Step 4: Remove the front cover (finisher) ............................................................................ 1448
Step 5: Remove the rear cover .............................................................................................. 1450
Step 6: Remove the booklet tray (finisher) .......................................................................... 1451
Step 7: Remove the caster cover (finisher) .......................................................................... 1452
Step 8: Remove the lower shield assembly (finisher) ........................................................ 1453
Step 9: Remove the upper shield assembly (finisher) ....................................................... 1455
Step 10: Remove the ejector unit (finisher) ......................................................................... 1457
Step 11: Remove the rear tamper (finisher) ........................................................................ 1466
Step 12: Remove the rear tamper motor (M7) .................................................................... 1467
Step 13: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................................... 1468
SCU motor (M10) ........................................................................................................................................... 1469
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1469
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1469
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1470
After performing service .................................................................................... 1470
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1470
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1470
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1470
Step 3: Remove the front door (finisher) ............................................................................. 1472
Step 4: Remove the front cover (finisher) ............................................................................ 1474
Step 5: Remove the rear cover .............................................................................................. 1476
Step 6: Remove the booklet tray (finisher) .......................................................................... 1477
Step 7: Remove the caster cover (finisher) .......................................................................... 1478
Step 8: Remove the lower shield assembly (finisher) ........................................................ 1479
Step 9: Remove the upper shield assembly (finisher) ....................................................... 1481
Step 10: Remove the SCU motor (M10) ............................................................................... 1483
Step 11: Unpack the replacement assembly ....................................................................... 1485
Main tray moving motor (M11) ................................................................................................................... 1487
ENWW xlix
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1487
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1487
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1487
After performing service .................................................................................... 1487
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1488
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1488
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1488
Step 3: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1490
Step 4: Remove the main tray moving motor (M11) .......................................................... 1491
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1495
Booklet finisher front cover ......................................................................................................................... 1497
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1497
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1497
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1497
After performing service .................................................................................... 1497
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1498
Step 1: Remove the booklet finisher front cover ................................................................ 1498
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1498
Booklet finisher ............................................................................................................................................. 1500
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1500
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1500
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1500
After performing service .................................................................................... 1500
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1501
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1501
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1501
Step 3: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1503
Step 4: Remove the booklet finisher ..................................................................................... 1504
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1509
Booklet finisher PCA ..................................................................................................................................... 1511
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1511
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1511
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1511
After performing service .................................................................................... 1511
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1512
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1512
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1512
Step 3: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1514
Step 4: Remove the booklet finisher ..................................................................................... 1515
Step 5: Remove the booklet finisher PCA ............................................................................ 1520
Step 6: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1522
l ENWW
Booklet finisher fold stopper unit .............................................................................................................. 1523
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1523
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1523
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1523
After performing service .................................................................................... 1524
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1524
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1524
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1524
Step 3: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1526
Step 4: Remove the booklet finisher front cover ................................................................ 1527
Step 5: Remove the booklet finisher lower right shield ..................................................... 1528
Step 6: Remove the fold stopper unit ................................................................................... 1529
Step 7: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1534
Booklet feed entrance motor (M13) .......................................................................................................... 1535
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1535
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1535
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1535
After performing service .................................................................................... 1535
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1536
Step 1: Remove the booklet finisher front cover ................................................................ 1536
Step 2: Remove the booklet feed entrance motor (M13) .................................................. 1536
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1537
TE presser motor (M14) ............................................................................................................................... 1538
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1538
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1538
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1538
After performing service .................................................................................... 1538
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1539
Step 1: Remove the booklet finisher front cover ................................................................ 1539
Step 2: Remove the TE presser motor (M14) ...................................................................... 1539
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1540
Stopper moving motor (M16) ..................................................................................................................... 1541
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1541
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1541
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1541
After performing service .................................................................................... 1541
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1542
Step 1: Remove the booklet finisher front cover ................................................................ 1542
Step 2: Remove the booklet finisher lower right shield ..................................................... 1542
Step 3: Remove the stopper moving motor (M16) ............................................................. 1544
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1544
ENWW li
Separate pawl motor (M17) ........................................................................................................................ 1546
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1546
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1546
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1546
After performing service .................................................................................... 1546
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1547
Step 1: Remove the booklet finisher front cover ................................................................ 1547
Step 2: Remove the separate pawl motor (M17) ................................................................ 1547
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1548
Folding roller motor (M18) .......................................................................................................................... 1549
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1549
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1549
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1549
After performing service .................................................................................... 1549
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1550
Step 1: Remove the right top cover (finisher) ...................................................................... 1550
Step 2: Remove the top cover (finisher) ............................................................................... 1550
Step 3: Remove the rear cover (finisher) .............................................................................. 1552
Step 4: Remove the folding roller motor (M18) .................................................................. 1553
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1554
Blade motor (M19) ........................................................................................................................................ 1555
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1555
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1555
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1555
After performing service .................................................................................... 1555
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1556
Step 1: Remove the booklet finisher front cover ................................................................ 1556
Step 2: Remove the booklet finisher lower right shield ..................................................... 1556
Step 3: Remove the blade motor (M19) ............................................................................... 1558
Step 4: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1558
C fold motor (M20) ....................................................................................................................................... 1560
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1560
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1560
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1560
After performing service .................................................................................... 1560
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1561
Step 1: Remove the booklet finisher front cover ................................................................ 1561
Step 2: Remove the C fold motor .......................................................................................... 1561
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly ......................................................................... 1566
Problem solving ................................................................................................................................................................. 1567
Control panel message document (CPMD) ............................................................................................... 1568
lii ENWW
Control-panel messages and event log entries .................................................................. 1568
Finisher system diagram .................................................................................................................................................. 1569
ENWW liii
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1594
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1594
After performing service .................................................................................... 1594
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1594
Step 1: Remove the entrance motor covers ........................................................................ 1595
Step 2: Remove the entrance motor .................................................................................... 1598
Exit sensor ..................................................................................................................................................... 1600
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1600
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1600
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1600
After performing service .................................................................................... 1600
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1600
Step 1: Remove the entrance motor covers ........................................................................ 1601
Step 2: Remove the exit sensor ............................................................................................. 1604
Exit motor ...................................................................................................................................................... 1605
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1605
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1605
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1605
After performing service .................................................................................... 1605
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1605
Step 1: Remove the exit motor .............................................................................................. 1606
Sub Paddle Shaft Sub assembly ................................................................................................................ 1608
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1608
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1608
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1608
After performing service .................................................................................... 1608
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1608
Step 1: Remove the sub paddle shaft sub assembly ......................................................... 1609
Front Jogger Motor ....................................................................................................................................... 1612
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1612
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1612
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1612
After performing service .................................................................................... 1612
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1612
Step 1: Remove the front jogger motor ............................................................................... 1613
Front Jogger Home Sensor ......................................................................................................................... 1624
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1624
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1624
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1624
After performing service .................................................................................... 1624
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1624
liv ENWW
Step 1: Remove the front jogger home sensor ................................................................... 1625
Rear Jogger Motor ........................................................................................................................................ 1636
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1636
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1636
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1636
After performing service .................................................................................... 1636
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1636
Step 1: Remove the rear jogger motor ................................................................................. 1637
Rear Jogger Home Sensor .......................................................................................................................... 1645
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1645
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1645
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1645
After performing service .................................................................................... 1645
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1645
Step 1: Remove the rear jogger home sensor .................................................................... 1646
Stapler ............................................................................................................................................................ 1651
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1651
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1651
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1651
After performing service .................................................................................... 1651
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1651
Step 1: Remove the stapler .................................................................................................... 1652
Stapler position sensor assembly .............................................................................................................. 1654
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1654
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1654
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1654
After performing service .................................................................................... 1654
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1654
Step 1: Remove the entrance motor covers ........................................................................ 1655
Step 2: Remove the sub paddle shaft sub assembly ......................................................... 1658
Step 3: Remove the staple position sensor assembly ....................................................... 1661
Traverse Motor .............................................................................................................................................. 1665
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1665
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1665
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1665
After performing service .................................................................................... 1665
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1665
Step 1: Remove the entrance motor covers ........................................................................ 1666
Step 2: Remove the traverse motor ..................................................................................... 1669
Stacker Motor ................................................................................................................................................ 1670
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1670
ENWW lv
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1670
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1670
After performing service .................................................................................... 1670
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1670
Step 1: Remove the stacker motor ....................................................................................... 1671
Stacker Encoder Sensor ............................................................................................................................... 1677
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1677
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1677
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1677
After performing service .................................................................................... 1677
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1677
Step 1: Remove the stacker encoder sensor ....................................................................... 1678
Stacker Lower Limit Switch ......................................................................................................................... 1684
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1684
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1684
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1684
After performing service .................................................................................... 1684
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1684
Step 1: Remove the stacker lower limit switch ................................................................... 1685
Stack Beam Sensor ...................................................................................................................................... 1691
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1691
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1691
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1691
After performing service .................................................................................... 1691
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1691
Step 1: Remove the stack beam sensor ............................................................................... 1692
Stack Position Sensor .................................................................................................................................. 1696
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1696
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1696
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1696
After performing service .................................................................................... 1696
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1696
Step 1: Remove the entrance motor covers ........................................................................ 1697
Step 2: Remove the stack position sensor .......................................................................... 1700
Paper Holding Lever Solenoid .................................................................................................................... 1706
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1706
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1706
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1706
After performing service .................................................................................... 1706
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1706
Step 1: Remove the paper holding lever solenoid ............................................................. 1707
lvi ENWW
Paper Support Motor .................................................................................................................................... 1714
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1714
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1714
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1714
After performing service .................................................................................... 1714
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1714
Step 1: Remove the stack position sensor .......................................................................... 1715
Step 2: Remove the paper support motor ........................................................................... 1721
Paper Support Home Sensor ...................................................................................................................... 1723
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1723
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1723
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1723
After performing service .................................................................................... 1723
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1723
Step 1: Remove the entrance motor covers ........................................................................ 1724
Step 2: Remove the stack position sensor .......................................................................... 1727
Step 3: Remove the paper support home sensor .............................................................. 1733
Ejector Motor assembly ............................................................................................................................... 1735
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1735
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1735
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1735
After performing service .................................................................................... 1735
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1735
Step 1: Remove the entrance motor covers ........................................................................ 1736
Step 2: Remove the stack position sensor .......................................................................... 1739
Step 3: Remove the paper ejector motor assembly .......................................................... 1745
Main Paddle Motor ........................................................................................................................................ 1749
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1749
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1749
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1749
After performing service .................................................................................... 1749
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1749
Step 1: Remove the main paddle motor .............................................................................. 1750
Main Paddle Home Sensor .......................................................................................................................... 1751
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1751
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1751
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1751
After performing service .................................................................................... 1751
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1751
Step 1: Remove the main paddle home sensor .................................................................. 1752
Main Paddle ................................................................................................................................................... 1753
ENWW lvii
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1753
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1753
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1753
After performing service .................................................................................... 1753
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1753
Step 1: Remove the main paddle .......................................................................................... 1754
Ejector assembly .......................................................................................................................................... 1755
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1755
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1755
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1755
After performing service .................................................................................... 1755
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1755
Step 1: Remove the stack position sensor .......................................................................... 1756
Step 2: Remove the paper ejector motor assembly .......................................................... 1762
Step 3: Remove the paper ejector assembly ....................................................................... 1766
Punch Dust Full Sensor ................................................................................................................................ 1767
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1767
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1767
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1767
After performing service .................................................................................... 1767
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1767
Step 1: Remove the entrance motor covers ........................................................................ 1768
Step 2: Remove the punch dust full sensor ......................................................................... 1771
Door Switch ................................................................................................................................................... 1772
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1772
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1772
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1772
After performing service .................................................................................... 1772
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1772
Step 1: Remove the door switch ........................................................................................... 1773
Top Door Switch ............................................................................................................................................ 1776
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1776
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1776
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1776
After performing service .................................................................................... 1776
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1776
Step 1: Remove the top door switch ..................................................................................... 1777
End Fence Home Sensor ............................................................................................................................. 1781
Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1781
Before performing service ................................................................................. 1781
Required tools ...................................................................................................... 1781
lviii ENWW
After performing service .................................................................................... 1781
Post service test .................................................................................................. 1781
Step 1: Remove the end fence home position sensor ....................................................... 1782
Problem solving ................................................................................................................................................................. 1783
Control panel message document (CPMD) ............................................................................................... 1568
Control-panel messages and event log entries .................................................................. 1784
Block Diagram .................................................................................................................................................................... 1785
ENWW lix
lx ENWW
List of tables
ENWW lxi
Table 2-33 Connections ......................................................................................................................................................................... 98
Table 2-34 Connection ........................................................................................................................................................................... 99
Table 2-35 Connections ....................................................................................................................................................................... 100
Table 2-36 Connections ....................................................................................................................................................................... 102
Table 2-37 Connections ....................................................................................................................................................................... 104
Table 2-38 Connections ....................................................................................................................................................................... 106
Table 2-39 HVPS PCA Connections .................................................................................................................................................... 107
Table 2-40 Connections ....................................................................................................................................................................... 109
Table 2-41 Connections ....................................................................................................................................................................... 111
Table 2-42 Connections ....................................................................................................................................................................... 112
Table 2-43 Connection ......................................................................................................................................................................... 112
Table 2-44 Connections ....................................................................................................................................................................... 113
Table 2-45 Connections ....................................................................................................................................................................... 113
Table 2-46 DCF paper feeding system .............................................................................................................................................. 114
Table 2-47 DCF electric parts locations, descriptions, and functions .......................................................................................... 116
Table 2-48 DCF PCA connection ......................................................................................................................................................... 117
Table 2-49 HCI paper feeding system ............................................................................................................................................... 118
Table 2-50 HCI electric parts locations, descriptions, and functions ........................................................................................... 120
Table 2-51 HCI PCA connection .......................................................................................................................................................... 121
Table 2-52 sHCI paper feeding system ............................................................................................................................................. 122
Table 2-53 sHCI electric parts locations, descriptions, and functions ......................................................................................... 124
Table 2-54 sHCI PCA connection ........................................................................................................................................................ 125
Table 3-1 Document feeder motors .................................................................................................................................................. 673
Table 4-1 Main assembly ..................................................................................................................................................................... 795
Table 4-2 Main assembly 2 ................................................................................................................................................................. 797
Table 4-3 Output ................................................................................................................................................................................... 799
Table 4-4 First cassette ....................................................................................................................................................................... 801
Table 4-5 Second cassette .................................................................................................................................................................. 803
Table 4-6 Main assembly frame ......................................................................................................................................................... 805
Table 4-7 Main frame registration assembly ................................................................................................................................... 807
Table 4-8 Drive system ........................................................................................................................................................................ 809
Table 4-9 Frame main pickup 1 and 2 ............................................................................................................................................... 811
Table 4-10 Frame main pickup ........................................................................................................................................................... 813
Table 4-11 Cover ................................................................................................................................................................................... 815
Table 4-12 Right door .......................................................................................................................................................................... 817
Table 4-13 MP tray ............................................................................................................................................................................... 819
Table 4-14 Right door guide ............................................................................................................................................................... 821
Table 4-15 Right door output and takeaway ................................................................................................................................... 823
Table 4-16 PTB transfer ...................................................................................................................................................................... 825
Table 4-17 Flow ADF ............................................................................................................................................................................ 827
Table 4-18 Flow ADF open cover ....................................................................................................................................................... 829
lxii ENWW
Table 4-19 Flow ADF pickup roller assembly ................................................................................................................................... 831
Table 4-20 Flow ADF stacker .............................................................................................................................................................. 833
Table 4-21 Flow ADF main .................................................................................................................................................................. 835
Table 4-22 Flow ADF image scanner ................................................................................................................................................. 837
Table 4-23 Flow ADF image scanner, lower ..................................................................................................................................... 839
Table 4-24 Reservoir ............................................................................................................................................................................ 841
Table 4-25 DCF main ............................................................................................................................................................................ 843
Table 4-26 DCF frame .......................................................................................................................................................................... 845
Table 4-27 DCF rear frame .................................................................................................................................................................. 847
Table 4-28 Opt feed drive ................................................................................................................................................................... 849
Table 4-29 DCF second pickup ........................................................................................................................................................... 851
Table 4-30 HCI main ............................................................................................................................................................................. 853
Table 4-31 HCI drive ............................................................................................................................................................................. 855
Table 4-32 HCI cassette ....................................................................................................................................................................... 857
Table 4-33 HCI frame ........................................................................................................................................................................... 859
Table 4-34 HCI main pickup ................................................................................................................................................................ 861
Table 4-35 sHCI main 1 ........................................................................................................................................................................ 863
Table 4-36 sHCI main 3 ........................................................................................................................................................................ 865
Table 4-37 sHCI main 5 ........................................................................................................................................................................ 867
Table 4-38 sHCI main 6 ........................................................................................................................................................................ 869
Table 4-39 Pickup cover unit .............................................................................................................................................................. 871
Table 4-40 sHCI frame ......................................................................................................................................................................... 873
Table 4-41 Booklet finisher ................................................................................................................................................................. 875
Table 4-42 Mainline finisher 1 ............................................................................................................................................................ 877
Table 4-43 Mainline finisher 2 ............................................................................................................................................................ 879
Table 4-44 Mainline finisher 3 ............................................................................................................................................................ 881
Table 4-45 Mainline finisher 4 ............................................................................................................................................................ 883
Table 4-46 Mainline finisher 5 ............................................................................................................................................................ 885
Table 4-47 Mainline finisher 6 ............................................................................................................................................................ 887
Table 4-48 Three fold motor, curl pawl motor, curl pawl, and three fold output ...................................................................... 889
Table 4-49 Low output, hb motor, and top guide ........................................................................................................................... 891
Table 4-50 SCU motor, STK motor, and entrance guide ................................................................................................................ 893
Table 4-51 Entrance motor, low paddle, alignment, and paddle motor ..................................................................................... 895
Table 4-52 Drive buffer, top lower, and top jam .............................................................................................................................. 897
Table 4-53 FD stopper unit, jam clear, and BKT main blade ......................................................................................................... 899
Table 4-54 Fold roller, main blade, and top frame ......................................................................................................................... 901
Table 4-55 Three fold blade ............................................................................................................................................................... 903
Table 4-56 Door, top door, top cover, and registration guide ....................................................................................................... 905
Table 4-57 Entrance guide, mid jam, and main output .................................................................................................................. 907
Table 4-58 Transfer buffer, right jam, div cam, hb motor, and paddle motor ............................................................................ 909
Table 4-59 Front alignment (tamper) ............................................................................................................................................... 911
ENWW lxiii
Table 4-60 Rear alignment (tamper) ................................................................................................................................................. 913
Table 4-61 Shield .................................................................................................................................................................................. 915
Table 4-62 PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and paddle .................................................................................................................... 917
Table 4-63 Finisher sub booklet ......................................................................................................................................................... 919
Table 4-64 IPTU (bridge) ...................................................................................................................................................................... 921
Table 4-65 Sub-inner finisher ............................................................................................................................................................. 923
Table 4-66 Finisher sub 1 .................................................................................................................................................................... 925
Table 4-67 Finisher sub 7 .................................................................................................................................................................... 927
Table 4-68 Finisher sub 8 .................................................................................................................................................................... 929
Table 5-8 Reports menu ................................................................................................................................................................... 1010
Table 5-9 Settings menu ................................................................................................................................................................... 1013
Table 5-10 Copy menu (MFP only) .................................................................................................................................................. 1057
Table 5-11 Scan menu (MFP) ........................................................................................................................................................... 1062
Table 5-12 Fax menu (fax models only) ......................................................................................................................................... 1071
Table 5-13 Print Options menu ........................................................................................................................................................ 1075
Table 5-14 Supplies menu ................................................................................................................................................................ 1076
Table 5-15 Trays menu ..................................................................................................................................................................... 1077
Table 5-16 Troubleshooting ............................................................................................................................................................. 1078
Table 5-17 Backup/Restore menu .................................................................................................................................................. 1080
Table 5-18 Calibrate/Cleaning menu .............................................................................................................................................. 1081
Table 5-19 Information ..................................................................................................................................................................... 1097
Table 5-20 Maintenance counts ....................................................................................................................................................... 1098
Table 5-21 Diagnostics ...................................................................................................................................................................... 1099
Table 5-22 Service functions ............................................................................................................................................................ 1100
Table 5-23 Troubleshooting procedure .......................................................................................................................................... 1135
Table 5-24 Troubleshooting procedure .......................................................................................................................................... 1136
Table 5-25 Troubleshooting procedure .......................................................................................................................................... 1138
Table 5-26 Troubleshooting procedure .......................................................................................................................................... 1139
Table 5-27 Troubleshooting procedure .......................................................................................................................................... 1139
Table 5-28 Troubleshooting procedure .......................................................................................................................................... 1140
Table 5-29 Troubleshooting procedure .......................................................................................................................................... 1141
Table 5-30 Troubleshooting procedure .......................................................................................................................................... 1141
Table 5-31 Troubleshooting procedure .......................................................................................................................................... 1143
Table 5-32 Troubleshooting procedure .......................................................................................................................................... 1144
Table 5-33 Troubleshooting procedure .......................................................................................................................................... 1145
Table 7-1 Sensor locations ............................................................................................................................................................... 1182
Table 7-2 Roller location ................................................................................................................................................................... 1183
Table 7-3 Jam removal guide ........................................................................................................................................................... 1185
Table 7-4 Paper path ......................................................................................................................................................................... 1186
Table 7-5 Electrical parts layout ...................................................................................................................................................... 1188
Table 7-6 IPTU .................................................................................................................................................................................... 1191
lxiv ENWW
Table 7-7 Punch unit .......................................................................................................................................................................... 1191
Table 7-8 .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 1192
Table 7-9 Finisher PCA ....................................................................................................................................................................... 1193
Table 7-10 Switch PCA ...................................................................................................................................................................... 1194
Table 8-1 Paper Size Specification .................................................................................................................................................. 1576
Table 8-2 Media performance .......................................................................................................................................................... 1579
Table 8-3 Finisher system—sectional view ................................................................................................................................... 1581
Table 8-4 Finisher system—paper path ........................................................................................................................................ 1582
Table 8-5 Finisher system—electrical parts layout ..................................................................................................................... 1583
Table 8-6 Finisher system—PBA connection information .......................................................................................................... 1585
ENWW lxv
lxvi ENWW
List of figures
ENWW lxvii
Figure 2-33 Drive motor ........................................................................................................................................................................ 68
Figure 2-34 Main drive unit motors ..................................................................................................................................................... 69
Figure 2-35 Toner supply drive ............................................................................................................................................................. 70
Figure 2-36 Toner reservoir drive ......................................................................................................................................................... 70
Figure 2-37 Scanner system overview ................................................................................................................................................ 71
Figure 2-38 Scan process ...................................................................................................................................................................... 72
Figure 2-39 Image processing .............................................................................................................................................................. 73
Figure 2-40 Scanning system components ........................................................................................................................................ 74
Figure 2-41 FR carriage ......................................................................................................................................................................... 75
Figure 2-42 HR carriage ......................................................................................................................................................................... 76
Figure 2-43 Imaging unit ....................................................................................................................................................................... 76
Figure 2-44 Wire driving ........................................................................................................................................................................ 77
Figure 2-45 Timing belt ......................................................................................................................................................................... 78
Figure 2-46 Shading sheet .................................................................................................................................................................... 79
Figure 2-47 Remove scan locking screw ............................................................................................................................................ 79
Figure 2-48 Tighten scan locking screw .............................................................................................................................................. 80
Figure 2-49 Flow ADF overview ............................................................................................................................................................ 81
Figure 2-50 Flow ADF sensors .............................................................................................................................................................. 82
Figure 2-51 Flow ADF Ultra Sonic Multifeed ....................................................................................................................................... 83
Figure 2-53 Flow ADF document lifting drive system ....................................................................................................................... 84
Figure 2-54 Flow ADF Scan-In Roller Release Drive System ........................................................................................................... 84
Figure 2-55 Flow ADF Registration ...................................................................................................................................................... 85
Figure 2-56 Flow ADF Scanning Position ............................................................................................................................................ 86
Figure 2-57 MSO 1 .................................................................................................................................................................................. 86
Figure 2-58 MSO 2 .................................................................................................................................................................................. 87
Figure 2-59 MSO 3 .................................................................................................................................................................................. 87
Figure 2-60 Dual sensor cleaning method ......................................................................................................................................... 88
Figure 2-61 Dual sensor cleaning method ......................................................................................................................................... 88
Figure 2-64 Block diagram .................................................................................................................................................................... 93
Figure 2-65 Clock diagram .................................................................................................................................................................... 94
Figure 2-66 Connection information ................................................................................................................................................... 95
Figure 2-67 Block diagram .................................................................................................................................................................... 96
Figure 2-68 Clock diagram .................................................................................................................................................................... 97
Figure 2-69 Connection information ................................................................................................................................................... 98
Figure 2-70 MSOK ................................................................................................................................................................................... 99
Figure 2-71 LVPS PCA (Type 5) ........................................................................................................................................................... 100
Figure 2-72 LVPS PCA (Type 3) ........................................................................................................................................................... 102
Figure 2-73 LVPS PCA (Type 4) ........................................................................................................................................................... 104
Figure 2-74 Fuser drive board ............................................................................................................................................................ 106
Figure 2-75 HVPS PCA ......................................................................................................................................................................... 107
Figure 2-76 Eraser PCA ........................................................................................................................................................................ 109
lxviii ENWW
Figure 2-77 Fuser PCA ......................................................................................................................................................................... 109
Figure 2-78 Waste sensor PCA ........................................................................................................................................................... 110
Figure 2-79 Paper size sensor PCA ................................................................................................................................................... 110
Figure 2-80 Flow ADF PCA .................................................................................................................................................................. 111
Figure 2-81 Scan joint PCA .................................................................................................................................................................. 112
Figure 2-82 CCDM PCA ......................................................................................................................................................................... 112
Figure 2-83 WLED IF PCA .................................................................................................................................................................... 113
Figure 2-84 WLED PCA ........................................................................................................................................................................ 113
Figure 2-85 Paper feeding system .................................................................................................................................................... 114
Figure 2-86 Paper path ....................................................................................................................................................................... 115
Figure 2-87 Electric parts locations, descriptions, and functions ................................................................................................. 116
Figure 2-88 PCA connection and DCF ................................................................................................................................................ 117
Figure 2-89 Paper feeding system .................................................................................................................................................... 118
Figure 2-90 HCI paper path ................................................................................................................................................................. 119
Figure 2-91 Electric parts locations, descriptions, and functions ................................................................................................. 120
Figure 2-92 HCI PCA connection ........................................................................................................................................................ 121
Figure 2-93 Paper feeding system .................................................................................................................................................... 122
Figure 2-94 sHCI paper path ............................................................................................................................................................... 123
Figure 2-95 sHCI electric parts locations, descriptions, and functions ........................................................................................ 124
Figure 2-96 sHCI PCA connection ....................................................................................................................................................... 125
Figure 3-1 Open the front door .......................................................................................................................................................... 137
Figure 3-2 Remove the TCU ................................................................................................................................................................ 137
Figure 3-3 Remove paper dust stick ................................................................................................................................................. 138
Figure 3-4 Remove the paper dust .................................................................................................................................................... 138
Figure 3-5 Install the paper dust stick .............................................................................................................................................. 138
Figure 3-6 Install the TCU .................................................................................................................................................................... 139
Figure 3-7 Close the front door .......................................................................................................................................................... 139
Figure 3-8 Clean the scanner glass ................................................................................................................................................... 140
Figure 3-9 Peel back the white backing and release one tab ....................................................................................................... 140
Figure 3-10 Clean flow document feeder white bar ....................................................................................................................... 141
Figure 3-11 Remove the formatter cover ........................................................................................................................................ 144
Figure 3-12 Locate the TPM ............................................................................................................................................................... 145
Figure 3-13 Connect the FIH ............................................................................................................................................................... 148
Figure 3-14 Release the HIP cover .................................................................................................................................................... 151
Figure 3-15 Remove the HIP cover .................................................................................................................................................... 151
Figure 3-16 Identify USB connector .................................................................................................................................................. 152
Figure 3-17 Select USB cable ............................................................................................................................................................. 152
Figure 3-18 Install the USB cable ....................................................................................................................................................... 153
Figure 3-19 Install the white power connector ............................................................................................................................... 153
Figure 3-20 Attach the metal ground connector ............................................................................................................................. 154
Figure 3-21 Position the NFC accessory in the HIP recess ............................................................................................................ 154
ENWW lxix
Figure 3-22 Install the NFC accessory ............................................................................................................................................... 155
Figure 3-23 Remove the TCU ............................................................................................................................................................. 158
Figure 3-24 Loosen one screw ........................................................................................................................................................... 160
Figure 3-25 Remove the drum unit ................................................................................................................................................... 160
Figure 3-26 Remove three screws and disconnect the small, black cable connector .............................................................. 163
Figure 3-27 Remove the developer unit ........................................................................................................................................... 163
Figure 3-28 Open the developer unit ................................................................................................................................................ 164
Figure 3-29 Distribute the developer powder ................................................................................................................................. 164
Figure 3-30 Fuser unit screw locations ............................................................................................................................................. 167
Figure 3-31 Fuser unit removal .......................................................................................................................................................... 167
Figure 3-32 Remove the connector cover ........................................................................................................................................ 170
Figure 3-33 Disconnect one connector ............................................................................................................................................. 170
Figure 3-34 Remove one screw and position the lever ................................................................................................................. 171
Figure 3-35 Remove one screw and position the lever ................................................................................................................. 171
Figure 3-36 Remove the PTB assembly ........................................................................................................................................... 172
Figure 3-37 Remove the two cassettes ............................................................................................................................................ 175
Figure 3-38 Slide the return guide .................................................................................................................................................... 175
Figure 3-39 Remove rollers ................................................................................................................................................................ 176
Figure 3-40 Coupler locations ............................................................................................................................................................ 176
Figure 3-41 Remove cover .................................................................................................................................................................. 179
Figure 3-42 Remove cover .................................................................................................................................................................. 180
Figure 3-43 MP tray flag orientation ................................................................................................................................................. 180
Figure 3-44 Remove the MP pickup/reverse/feed roller ............................................................................................................... 181
Figure 3-45 Remove the pickup roller assembly ............................................................................................................................ 184
Figure 3-46 Remove the pickup roller assembly cover .................................................................................................................. 184
Figure 3-47 Remove the pickup roller components ....................................................................................................................... 185
Figure 3-48 Remove the pickup roller assembly ............................................................................................................................ 186
Figure 3-49 Pickup roller components-disassembled ................................................................................................................... 186
Figure 3-50 Remove the separation roller cover ............................................................................................................................ 189
Figure 3-51 Remove one plastic clip ................................................................................................................................................. 189
Figure 3-52 Remove the separation roller ....................................................................................................................................... 190
Figure 3-53 Remove the separation roller ....................................................................................................................................... 190
Figure 3-54 Remove the formatter cover ........................................................................................................................................ 193
Figure 3-55 Remove the formatter cover ........................................................................................................................................ 196
Figure 3-56 Remove the formatter cover ........................................................................................................................................ 199
Figure 3-57 Remove the formatter cover ........................................................................................................................................ 202
Figure 3-58 Remove the formatter cover ........................................................................................................................................ 205
Figure 3-59 Remove the document feeder bezel ........................................................................................................................... 209
Figure 3-60 Remove the control panel screws and disconnect connectors ............................................................................... 210
Figure 3-61 Remove the USB interconnect cable ........................................................................................................................... 210
Figure 3-62 Remove the document feeder bezel ........................................................................................................................... 213
lxx ENWW
Figure 3-63 Remove the control panel screws and disconnect connectors ............................................................................... 214
Figure 3-64 Remove the USB interconnect cable ........................................................................................................................... 214
Figure 3-65 Disconnect one FFC ........................................................................................................................................................ 215
Figure 3-66 Remove the control-panel keyboard .......................................................................................................................... 215
Figure 3-67 Remove the IPTU ............................................................................................................................................................ 218
Figure 3-68 Remove the front top inner cover ................................................................................................................................ 222
Figure 3-69 Remove the front top inner cover ................................................................................................................................ 224
Figure 3-70 Remove two screws and rotate the cover .................................................................................................................. 224
Figure 3-71 Remove the front power cover ..................................................................................................................................... 225
Figure 3-72 Remove the front top inner cover ................................................................................................................................ 227
Figure 3-73 Remove two screws and rotate the cover .................................................................................................................. 228
Figure 3-74 Remove the front power cover ..................................................................................................................................... 228
Figure 3-75 Remove one screw and the power switch board ...................................................................................................... 229
Figure 3-76 Remove two screws and the power switch button ................................................................................................... 229
Figure 3-77 Remove the front top inner cover ................................................................................................................................ 232
Figure 3-78 Remove the output bin .................................................................................................................................................. 232
Figure 3-79 Remove the front top inner cover ................................................................................................................................ 235
Figure 3-80 Remove two screws and rotate the cover .................................................................................................................. 236
Figure 3-81 Remove the front power cover ..................................................................................................................................... 236
Figure 3-82 Remove the top right cover .......................................................................................................................................... 237
Figure 3-83 Left dummy cover .......................................................................................................................................................... 239
Figure 3-84 Remove the left cover .................................................................................................................................................... 239
Figure 3-85 Remove the formatter cover ........................................................................................................................................ 242
Figure 3-86 Remove the lower rear cover ........................................................................................................................................ 242
Figure 3-87 Remove the formatter cover ........................................................................................................................................ 245
Figure 3-88 Remove the lower rear cover ........................................................................................................................................ 246
Figure 3-89 Remove the upper rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 246
Figure 3-90 Remove the formatter cover ........................................................................................................................................ 249
Figure 3-91 Remove the left rear corner cover ............................................................................................................................... 249
Figure 3-92 Remove four screws ...................................................................................................................................................... 252
Figure 3-93 Remove the right rear cover ......................................................................................................................................... 252
Figure 3-94 Remove four screws ...................................................................................................................................................... 255
Figure 3-95 Remove the right rear cover ......................................................................................................................................... 255
Figure 3-96 Disconnect one connector ............................................................................................................................................. 256
Figure 3-97 Release the right hinge .................................................................................................................................................. 256
Figure 3-98 Release the left dampener ........................................................................................................................................... 257
Figure 3-99 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................... 257
Figure 3-100 Remove the TCU ........................................................................................................................................................... 260
Figure 3-101 Remove the paper dust brush ................................................................................................................................... 260
Figure 3-102 Remove the front cover ............................................................................................................................................... 263
Figure 3-103 Remove the front cover ............................................................................................................................................... 266
ENWW lxxi
Figure 3-104 Remove the front top inner cover ............................................................................................................................. 267
Figure 3-105 Remove two screws and rotate the cover ................................................................................................................ 267
Figure 3-106 Remove the front power cover .................................................................................................................................. 268
Figure 3-107 Remove the output bin ................................................................................................................................................ 268
Figure 3-108 Remove the TCU ........................................................................................................................................................... 269
Figure 3-109 Remove the paper dust brush ................................................................................................................................... 269
Figure 3-110 Screw locations ............................................................................................................................................................. 270
Figure 3-111 Remove two screw caps and two screws ................................................................................................................ 270
Figure 3-112 Remove the inner front cover .................................................................................................................................... 271
Figure 3-113 Remove the front cover ............................................................................................................................................... 273
Figure 3-114 Remove the front top inner cover ............................................................................................................................. 274
Figure 3-115 Remove two screws and rotate the cover ................................................................................................................ 274
Figure 3-116 Remove the front power cover .................................................................................................................................. 275
Figure 3-117 Remove the output bin ................................................................................................................................................ 275
Figure 3-118 Remove the paper dust brush ................................................................................................................................... 276
Figure 3-119 Remove seven screws ................................................................................................................................................. 276
Figure 3-120 Remove the inner cover .............................................................................................................................................. 277
Figure 3-121 Remove one screw and the cover open sensor ...................................................................................................... 278
Figure 3-122 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 280
Figure 3-123 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 281
Figure 3-124 Remove the LVPS cover .............................................................................................................................................. 281
Figure 3-125 Left dummy cover ........................................................................................................................................................ 284
Figure 3-126 Remove the left cover ................................................................................................................................................. 284
Figure 3-127 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 285
Figure 3-128 Remove the laser scanner assembly ........................................................................................................................ 285
Figure 3-129 Remove the TCU ........................................................................................................................................................... 288
Figure 3-130 Loosen one screw ........................................................................................................................................................ 289
Figure 3-131 Remove the drum unit ................................................................................................................................................. 289
Figure 3-132 Remove three screws and disconnect the small, black cable connector ............................................................ 290
Figure 3-133 Remove the developer unit ........................................................................................................................................ 290
Figure 3-134 Open the developer unit .............................................................................................................................................. 291
Figure 3-135 Distribute the developer powder ............................................................................................................................... 291
Figure 3-136 Left dummy cover ........................................................................................................................................................ 292
Figure 3-137 Remove the left cover ................................................................................................................................................. 292
Figure 3-138 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 293
Figure 3-139 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 293
Figure 3-140 Remove the fan duct ................................................................................................................................................... 294
Figure 3-141 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 294
Figure 3-142 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 295
Figure 3-143 Release one tab ............................................................................................................................................................ 295
Figure 3-144 Remove the developer fan shroud ............................................................................................................................ 296
lxxii ENWW
Figure 3-145 Release six tabs ............................................................................................................................................................ 296
Figure 3-146 Remove the developer fan ......................................................................................................................................... 297
Figure 3-147 Install the developer fan ............................................................................................................................................. 297
Figure 3-148 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 300
Figure 3-149 Left dummy cover ........................................................................................................................................................ 301
Figure 3-150 Remove the left cover ................................................................................................................................................. 301
Figure 3-151 Remove the HVPS board ............................................................................................................................................. 302
Figure 3-152 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 304
Figure 3-153 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 305
Figure 3-154 Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 305
Figure 3-155 Remove the left rear corner cover ............................................................................................................................ 306
Figure 3-156 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 306
Figure 3-157 Disconnect formatter connectors and screws ......................................................................................................... 307
Figure 3-158 Identify the formatter cables ..................................................................................................................................... 307
Figure 3-159 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 308
Figure 3-160 Remove the main board .............................................................................................................................................. 308
Figure 3-161 Position of MSOK board ............................................................................................................................................... 309
Figure 3-162 Install the MSOK board ................................................................................................................................................ 309
Figure 3-163 Install the flat cable ...................................................................................................................................................... 310
Figure 3-164 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 312
Figure 3-165 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 313
Figure 3-166 Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 313
Figure 3-167 Remove the left rear corner cover ............................................................................................................................ 314
Figure 3-168 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 314
Figure 3-169 Disconnect formatter connectors and screws ......................................................................................................... 315
Figure 3-170 Identify the formatter cables ..................................................................................................................................... 315
Figure 3-171 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 316
Figure 3-172 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 316
Figure 3-173 Remove five screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 317
Figure 3-174 Install the flat cable ...................................................................................................................................................... 317
Figure 3-175 Remove the toner supply motor ............................................................................................................................... 318
Figure 3-176 Remove the front cover ............................................................................................................................................... 320
Figure 3-177 Remove the front top inner cover ............................................................................................................................. 321
Figure 3-178 Remove two screws and rotate the cover ................................................................................................................ 321
Figure 3-179 Remove the front power cover .................................................................................................................................. 322
Figure 3-180 Remove the output bin ................................................................................................................................................ 322
Figure 3-181 Remove the TCU ........................................................................................................................................................... 323
Figure 3-182 Remove the paper dust brush ................................................................................................................................... 323
Figure 3-183 Screw locations ............................................................................................................................................................. 324
Figure 3-184 Remove two screw caps and two screws ................................................................................................................ 324
Figure 3-185 Remove the inner front cover .................................................................................................................................... 325
ENWW lxxiii
Figure 3-186 Left dummy cover ........................................................................................................................................................ 325
Figure 3-187 Remove the left cover ................................................................................................................................................. 326
Figure 3-188 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 326
Figure 3-189 Remove the crum connector ...................................................................................................................................... 327
Figure 3-190 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 329
Figure 3-191 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 330
Figure 3-192 Remove the LVPS fans ................................................................................................................................................ 330
Figure 3-193 Correct installation of LVPS fans ................................................................................................................................ 331
Figure 3-194 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 333
Figure 3-195 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 334
Figure 3-196 Remove the LVPS cover .............................................................................................................................................. 334
Figure 3-197 Remove LVPS board 1 ................................................................................................................................................. 335
Figure 3-198 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 337
Figure 3-199 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 338
Figure 3-200 Remove the LVPS cover .............................................................................................................................................. 338
Figure 3-201 LVPS board 2 ................................................................................................................................................................. 339
Figure 3-202 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 341
Figure 3-203 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 342
Figure 3-204 Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 342
Figure 3-205 Remove the shield-LVPS sub upper .......................................................................................................................... 343
Figure 3-206 LVPS board 3 ................................................................................................................................................................. 343
Figure 3-207 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 346
Figure 3-208 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 347
Figure 3-209 Remove the LVPS cover .............................................................................................................................................. 347
Figure 3-210 Fuser drive board ......................................................................................................................................................... 348
Figure 3-211 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 350
Figure 3-212 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 351
Figure 3-213 Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 351
Figure 3-214 Disconnect connectors and remove screws ............................................................................................................ 352
Figure 3-215 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 352
Figure 3-216 LVPS connectors installation ...................................................................................................................................... 353
Figure 3-217 Release the harness and remove three screws ...................................................................................................... 353
Figure 3-218 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 353
Figure 3-219 Release five tabs .......................................................................................................................................................... 354
Figure 3-220 Remove the fuser fan .................................................................................................................................................. 354
Figure 3-221 Loosen one screw ........................................................................................................................................................ 357
Figure 3-222 Remove the drum unit ................................................................................................................................................. 358
Figure 3-223 Remove three screws and disconnect the small, black cable connector ............................................................ 358
Figure 3-224 Remove the developer unit ........................................................................................................................................ 359
Figure 3-225 Open the developer unit .............................................................................................................................................. 359
Figure 3-226 Distribute the developer powder ............................................................................................................................... 360
lxxiv ENWW
Figure 3-227 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 361
Figure 3-228 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 361
Figure 3-229 Disconnect one connector and release two retainers ............................................................................................ 362
Figure 3-230 Remove the main drive unit ....................................................................................................................................... 362
Figure 3-231 Rotate the coupler ....................................................................................................................................................... 363
Figure 3-232 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 365
Figure 3-233 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 366
Figure 3-234 Remove the LVPS cover .............................................................................................................................................. 366
Figure 3-235 Remove the fuser drive and LVPS boards and cage ............................................................................................... 367
Figure 3-236 Remove the inductor unit ........................................................................................................................................... 367
Figure 3-237 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 370
Figure 3-238 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 371
Figure 3-239 Remove the LVPS cover .............................................................................................................................................. 371
Figure 3-240 Remove the fuser drive and LVPS boards and cage ............................................................................................... 372
Figure 3-241 Remove the CST rail cover .......................................................................................................................................... 372
Figure 3-242 Remove the auto closing unit ..................................................................................................................................... 373
Figure 3-243 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 375
Figure 3-244 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 376
Figure 3-245 Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 376
Figure 3-246 Disconnect connectors and remove screws ............................................................................................................ 377
Figure 3-247 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 377
Figure 3-248 LVPS connectors installation ...................................................................................................................................... 378
Figure 3-249 Release the cables and remove three screws ......................................................................................................... 378
Figure 3-250 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 379
Figure 3-251 Release five tabs .......................................................................................................................................................... 379
Figure 3-252 Remove the fuser fan .................................................................................................................................................. 380
Figure 3-253 Remove the fuser/output drive unit .......................................................................................................................... 380
Figure 3-254 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 383
Figure 3-255 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 384
Figure 3-256 Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 384
Figure 3-257 Disconnect connectors and remove screws ............................................................................................................ 385
Figure 3-258 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 385
Figure 3-259 LVPS connectors installation ...................................................................................................................................... 386
Figure 3-260 Release the cables and remove three screws ......................................................................................................... 386
Figure 3-261 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 387
Figure 3-262 Release five tabs .......................................................................................................................................................... 387
Figure 3-263 Remove the fuser fan .................................................................................................................................................. 388
Figure 3-264 Remove the fuser/output drive unit .......................................................................................................................... 388
Figure 3-265 Remove the side door open sensor .......................................................................................................................... 389
Figure 3-266 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 391
Figure 3-267 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 392
ENWW lxxv
Figure 3-268 Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 392
Figure 3-269 Disconnect connectors and remove screws ............................................................................................................ 393
Figure 3-270 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 393
Figure 3-271 LVPS connectors installation ...................................................................................................................................... 394
Figure 3-272 Release the cables and remove three screws ......................................................................................................... 394
Figure 3-273 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 395
Figure 3-274 Release five tabs .......................................................................................................................................................... 395
Figure 3-275 Remove the fuser fan .................................................................................................................................................. 396
Figure 3-276 Remove the fuser/output drive unit .......................................................................................................................... 396
Figure 3-277 Remove the side door open sensor .......................................................................................................................... 397
Figure 3-278 Remove micro-switch .................................................................................................................................................. 397
Figure 3-279 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 400
Figure 3-280 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 401
Figure 3-281 Remove the LVPS cover .............................................................................................................................................. 401
Figure 3-282 Remove the fuser drive and LVPS boards and cage ............................................................................................... 402
Figure 3-283 Remove pickup drive unit 1 ........................................................................................................................................ 402
Figure 3-284 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 405
Figure 3-285 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 406
Figure 3-286 Remove pickup drive unit 2 ........................................................................................................................................ 406
Figure 3-287 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 409
Figure 3-288 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 410
Figure 3-289 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 410
Figure 3-290 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 411
Figure 3-291 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 411
Figure 3-292 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 412
Figure 3-293 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 412
Figure 3-294 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 413
Figure 3-295 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 413
Figure 3-296 Remove the cover ........................................................................................................................................................ 414
Figure 3-297 Remove the feed/MP drive unit ................................................................................................................................. 414
Figure 3-298 Align the gears with the couplers .............................................................................................................................. 415
Figure 3-299 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 417
Figure 3-300 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 418
Figure 3-301 Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 418
Figure 3-302 Remove the registration drive assembly ................................................................................................................. 419
Figure 3-303 Remove the TCU ........................................................................................................................................................... 421
Figure 3-304 Remove the front cover ............................................................................................................................................... 422
Figure 3-305 Remove the front top inner cover ............................................................................................................................. 422
Figure 3-306 Remove two screws and rotate the cover ................................................................................................................ 423
Figure 3-307 Remove the front power cover .................................................................................................................................. 423
Figure 3-308 Remove the output bin ................................................................................................................................................ 424
lxxvi ENWW
Figure 3-309 Remove the paper dust brush ................................................................................................................................... 424
Figure 3-310 Screw locations ............................................................................................................................................................. 425
Figure 3-311 Remove two screw caps and two screws ................................................................................................................ 425
Figure 3-312 Remove the inner front cover .................................................................................................................................... 426
Figure 3-313 Remove the sensor ...................................................................................................................................................... 426
Figure 3-314 Remove three screws and disconnect the small, black cable connector ............................................................ 429
Figure 3-315 Remove the developer unit ........................................................................................................................................ 430
Figure 3-316 Open the developer unit .............................................................................................................................................. 430
Figure 3-317 Distribute the developer powder ............................................................................................................................... 431
Figure 3-318 Left dummy cover ........................................................................................................................................................ 432
Figure 3-319 Remove the left cover ................................................................................................................................................. 432
Figure 3-320 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 433
Figure 3-321 Remove the laser scanner assembly ........................................................................................................................ 433
Figure 3-322 Remove the front top inner cover ............................................................................................................................. 434
Figure 3-323 Remove the output bin ................................................................................................................................................ 434
Figure 3-324 Remove the paper dust brush ................................................................................................................................... 435
Figure 3-325 Screw locations ............................................................................................................................................................. 435
Figure 3-326 Remove two screw caps and two screws ................................................................................................................ 436
Figure 3-327 Remove the inner front cover .................................................................................................................................... 436
Figure 3-328 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 437
Figure 3-329 Remove the toner guide ............................................................................................................................................. 437
Figure 3-330 Disconnect one connector and remove one screw ................................................................................................. 438
Figure 3-331 Remove the reservoir assembly ................................................................................................................................ 438
Figure 3-332 Remove screws ............................................................................................................................................................ 441
Figure 3-333 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 443
Figure 3-334 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 443
Figure 3-335 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 444
Figure 3-336 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 444
Figure 3-337 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 445
Figure 3-338 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 445
Figure 3-339 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 446
Figure 3-340 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 446
Figure 3-341 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 446
Figure 3-342 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 447
Figure 3-343 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 449
Figure 3-344 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 449
Figure 3-345 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 450
Figure 3-346 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 450
Figure 3-347 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 451
Figure 3-348 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 451
Figure 3-349 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 452
ENWW lxxvii
Figure 3-350 Remove three screws and the lower cable cover ................................................................................................... 452
Figure 3-351 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 452
Figure 3-352 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 453
Figure 3-353 Remove the feed guide take away lower ................................................................................................................. 453
Figure 3-354 Remove the feed guide take away upper ................................................................................................................ 453
Figure 3-355 Disconnect one connector and remove the feed 2 sensor .................................................................................... 454
Figure 3-356 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 456
Figure 3-357 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 456
Figure 3-358 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 457
Figure 3-359 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 457
Figure 3-360 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 458
Figure 3-361 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 458
Figure 3-362 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 459
Figure 3-363 Remove three screws and the lower cable cover ................................................................................................... 459
Figure 3-364 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 459
Figure 3-365 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 460
Figure 3-366 Remove the feed guide take away lower ................................................................................................................. 460
Figure 3-367 Remove the feed guide take away upper ................................................................................................................ 460
Figure 3-368 Remove one e-ring and bushing ............................................................................................................................... 461
Figure 3-369 Remove one e-ring and bushing ............................................................................................................................... 461
Figure 3-370 Remove the shaft ......................................................................................................................................................... 461
Figure 3-371 Remove three screws .................................................................................................................................................. 462
Figure 3-372 Remove the guide-duplex lower ............................................................................................................................... 462
Figure 3-373 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 462
Figure 3-374 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 463
Figure 3-375 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 463
Figure 3-376 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 463
Figure 3-377 Release the MP Tray linker ......................................................................................................................................... 464
Figure 3-378 Release the MP unit ..................................................................................................................................................... 464
Figure 3-379 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 467
Figure 3-380 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 468
Figure 3-381 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 468
Figure 3-382 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 469
Figure 3-383 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 469
Figure 3-384 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 470
Figure 3-385 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 470
Figure 3-386 Remove three screws and the lower cable cover ................................................................................................... 471
Figure 3-387 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 471
Figure 3-388 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 471
Figure 3-389 Remove the feed guide take away lower ................................................................................................................. 472
Figure 3-390 Remove the feed guide take away upper ................................................................................................................ 472
lxxviii ENWW
Figure 3-391 Remove one e-ring and bushing ............................................................................................................................... 472
Figure 3-392 Remove one e-ring and bushing ............................................................................................................................... 473
Figure 3-393 Remove the shaft ......................................................................................................................................................... 473
Figure 3-394 Remove three screws .................................................................................................................................................. 473
Figure 3-395 Remove the guide-duplex lower ............................................................................................................................... 474
Figure 3-396 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 474
Figure 3-397 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 474
Figure 3-398 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 475
Figure 3-399 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 475
Figure 3-400 Release the MP Tray linker ......................................................................................................................................... 475
Figure 3-401 Release the MP unit ..................................................................................................................................................... 476
Figure 3-402 Remove the MP empty sensor ................................................................................................................................... 476
Figure 3-403 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 479
Figure 3-404 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 480
Figure 3-405 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 480
Figure 3-406 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 481
Figure 3-407 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 481
Figure 3-408 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 482
Figure 3-409 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 482
Figure 3-410 Remove three screws and the lower cable cover ................................................................................................... 483
Figure 3-411 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 483
Figure 3-412 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 483
Figure 3-413 Remove the feed guide take away lower ................................................................................................................. 484
Figure 3-414 Remove the feed guide take away upper ................................................................................................................ 484
Figure 3-415 Remove one e-ring and bushing ............................................................................................................................... 484
Figure 3-416 Remove one e-ring and bushing ............................................................................................................................... 485
Figure 3-417 Remove the shaft ......................................................................................................................................................... 485
Figure 3-418 Remove three screws .................................................................................................................................................. 485
Figure 3-419 Remove the guide-duplex lower ............................................................................................................................... 486
Figure 3-420 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 486
Figure 3-421 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 486
Figure 3-422 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 487
Figure 3-423 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 487
Figure 3-424 Release the MP Tray linker ......................................................................................................................................... 487
Figure 3-425 Release the MP unit ..................................................................................................................................................... 488
Figure 3-426 Remove the MP Tray upper ........................................................................................................................................ 488
Figure 3-427 Remove the MP paper length sensor ....................................................................................................................... 488
Figure 3-428 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 491
Figure 3-429 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 492
Figure 3-430 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 492
Figure 3-431 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 493
ENWW lxxix
Figure 3-432 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 493
Figure 3-433 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 494
Figure 3-434 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 494
Figure 3-435 Remove three screws and the lower cable cover ................................................................................................... 495
Figure 3-436 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 495
Figure 3-437 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 495
Figure 3-438 Remove the feed guide take away lower ................................................................................................................. 496
Figure 3-439 Remove the feed guide take away upper ................................................................................................................ 496
Figure 3-440 Remove one e-ring and bushing ............................................................................................................................... 496
Figure 3-441 Remove one e-ring and bushing ............................................................................................................................... 497
Figure 3-442 Remove the shaft ......................................................................................................................................................... 497
Figure 3-443 Remove three screws .................................................................................................................................................. 497
Figure 3-444 Remove the guide-duplex lower ............................................................................................................................... 498
Figure 3-445 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 498
Figure 3-446 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 498
Figure 3-447 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 499
Figure 3-448 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 499
Figure 3-449 Release the MP Tray linker ......................................................................................................................................... 499
Figure 3-450 Release the MP unit ..................................................................................................................................................... 500
Figure 3-451 Remove two screws and three gears ....................................................................................................................... 500
Figure 3-452 Remove the bracket-rear ............................................................................................................................................ 500
Figure 3-453 Remove seven screws ................................................................................................................................................. 501
Figure 3-454 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 501
Figure 3-455 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 504
Figure 3-456 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 505
Figure 3-457 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 505
Figure 3-458 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 506
Figure 3-459 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 506
Figure 3-460 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 507
Figure 3-461 Remove the front top inner cover ............................................................................................................................. 507
Figure 3-462 Remove two screws and rotate the cover ................................................................................................................ 508
Figure 3-463 Remove the front power cover .................................................................................................................................. 508
Figure 3-464 Remove the top right cover ........................................................................................................................................ 509
Figure 3-465 Fuser unit screw locations .......................................................................................................................................... 509
Figure 3-466 Fuser unit removal ....................................................................................................................................................... 510
Figure 3-467 Disconnect two connectors and remove four screws ............................................................................................ 510
Figure 3-468 Remove the output unit .............................................................................................................................................. 511
Figure 3-469 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 513
Figure 3-470 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 514
Figure 3-471 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 514
Figure 3-472 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 515
lxxx ENWW
Figure 3-473 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 515
Figure 3-474 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 516
Figure 3-475 Remove the front top inner cover ............................................................................................................................. 516
Figure 3-476 Remove two screws and rotate the cover ................................................................................................................ 517
Figure 3-477 Remove the front power cover .................................................................................................................................. 517
Figure 3-478 Remove the top right cover ........................................................................................................................................ 518
Figure 3-479 Fuser unit screw locations .......................................................................................................................................... 518
Figure 3-480 Fuser unit removal ....................................................................................................................................................... 519
Figure 3-481 Disconnect two connectors and remove four screws ............................................................................................ 519
Figure 3-482 Remove the output unit .............................................................................................................................................. 520
Figure 3-483 Return sensor ............................................................................................................................................................... 520
Figure 3-484 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 523
Figure 3-485 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 524
Figure 3-486 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 524
Figure 3-487 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 525
Figure 3-488 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 525
Figure 3-489 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 526
Figure 3-490 Remove the front top inner cover ............................................................................................................................. 526
Figure 3-491 Remove two screws and rotate the cover ................................................................................................................ 527
Figure 3-492 Remove the front power cover .................................................................................................................................. 527
Figure 3-493 Remove the top right cover ........................................................................................................................................ 528
Figure 3-494 Fuser unit screw locations .......................................................................................................................................... 528
Figure 3-495 Fuser unit removal ....................................................................................................................................................... 529
Figure 3-496 Disconnect two connectors and remove four screws ............................................................................................ 529
Figure 3-497 Remove the output unit .............................................................................................................................................. 530
Figure 3-498 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 530
Figure 3-499 Remove the duplex 1 sensor ..................................................................................................................................... 531
Figure 3-500 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 533
Figure 3-501 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 534
Figure 3-502 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 534
Figure 3-503 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 535
Figure 3-504 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 535
Figure 3-505 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 536
Figure 3-506 Remove the front top inner cover ............................................................................................................................. 536
Figure 3-507 Remove two screws and rotate the cover ................................................................................................................ 537
Figure 3-508 Remove the front power cover .................................................................................................................................. 537
Figure 3-509 Remove the top right cover ........................................................................................................................................ 538
Figure 3-510 Fuser unit screw locations .......................................................................................................................................... 538
Figure 3-511 Fuser unit removal ....................................................................................................................................................... 539
Figure 3-512 Disconnect two connectors and remove four screws ............................................................................................ 539
Figure 3-513 Remove the output unit .............................................................................................................................................. 540
ENWW lxxxi
Figure 3-514 Remove one screw and the guide ............................................................................................................................. 540
Figure 3-515 Remove the black adhesive strip ............................................................................................................................... 541
Figure 3-516 Release two tabs .......................................................................................................................................................... 541
Figure 3-517 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 542
Figure 3-518 Remove the output 1 bin full sensor ........................................................................................................................ 542
Figure 3-519 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 545
Figure 3-520 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 546
Figure 3-521 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 546
Figure 3-522 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 547
Figure 3-523 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 547
Figure 3-524 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 548
Figure 3-525 Remove the front top inner cover ............................................................................................................................. 548
Figure 3-526 Remove two screws and rotate the cover ................................................................................................................ 549
Figure 3-527 Remove the front power cover .................................................................................................................................. 549
Figure 3-528 Remove the top right cover ........................................................................................................................................ 550
Figure 3-529 Fuser unit screw locations .......................................................................................................................................... 550
Figure 3-530 Fuser unit removal ....................................................................................................................................................... 551
Figure 3-531 Disconnect two connectors and remove four screws ............................................................................................ 551
Figure 3-532 Remove the output unit .............................................................................................................................................. 552
Figure 3-533 On the output unit, disconnect one connector and remove two gears ............................................................... 552
Figure 3-534 Output gate solenoid ................................................................................................................................................... 553
Figure 3-535 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 555
Figure 3-536 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 555
Figure 3-537 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 556
Figure 3-538 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 556
Figure 3-539 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 557
Figure 3-540 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 557
Figure 3-541 Remove one screw and the cover ............................................................................................................................. 558
Figure 3-542 Remove three screws .................................................................................................................................................. 558
Figure 3-543 Rotate pickup unit 2 ..................................................................................................................................................... 559
Figure 3-544 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 559
Figure 3-545 Align gear, coupler, and bracket ................................................................................................................................ 560
Figure 3-546 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 562
Figure 3-547 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 563
Figure 3-548 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 563
Figure 3-549 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 564
Figure 3-550 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 564
Figure 3-551 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 565
Figure 3-552 Remove one screw and the cover ............................................................................................................................. 565
Figure 3-553 Remove three screws .................................................................................................................................................. 566
Figure 3-554 Rotate pickup unit 2 ..................................................................................................................................................... 566
lxxxii ENWW
Figure 3-555 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 567
Figure 3-556 Align gear, coupler, and bracket ................................................................................................................................ 567
Figure 3-557 Remove the sensor ...................................................................................................................................................... 568
Figure 3-558 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 570
Figure 3-559 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 570
Figure 3-560 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 571
Figure 3-561 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 571
Figure 3-562 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 572
Figure 3-563 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 572
Figure 3-564 Remove one screw and the cover ............................................................................................................................. 573
Figure 3-565 Remove three screws .................................................................................................................................................. 573
Figure 3-566 Rotate pickup unit 2 ..................................................................................................................................................... 574
Figure 3-567 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 574
Figure 3-568 Align gear, coupler, and bracket ................................................................................................................................ 575
Figure 3-569 Remove prefeed sensor 2 .......................................................................................................................................... 575
Figure 3-570 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 578
Figure 3-571 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 578
Figure 3-572 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 579
Figure 3-573 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 579
Figure 3-574 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 580
Figure 3-575 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 580
Figure 3-576 Remove one screw and the cover ............................................................................................................................. 581
Figure 3-577 Remove three screws .................................................................................................................................................. 581
Figure 3-578 Rotate pickup unit 2 ..................................................................................................................................................... 582
Figure 3-579 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 582
Figure 3-580 Align gear, coupler, and bracket ................................................................................................................................ 583
Figure 3-581 Remove three screws .................................................................................................................................................. 583
Figure 3-582 Rotate pickup unit 1 ..................................................................................................................................................... 584
Figure 3-583 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 584
Figure 3-584 Align gear, coupler, and bracket ................................................................................................................................ 585
Figure 3-585 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 587
Figure 3-586 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 588
Figure 3-587 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 588
Figure 3-588 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 589
Figure 3-589 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 589
Figure 3-590 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 590
Figure 3-591 Remove one screw and the cover ............................................................................................................................. 590
Figure 3-592 Remove three screws .................................................................................................................................................. 591
Figure 3-593 Rotate pickup unit 2 ..................................................................................................................................................... 591
Figure 3-594 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 592
Figure 3-595 Align gear, coupler, and bracket ................................................................................................................................ 592
ENWW lxxxiii
Figure 3-596 Remove three screws .................................................................................................................................................. 593
Figure 3-597 Rotate pickup unit 1 ..................................................................................................................................................... 593
Figure 3-598 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 594
Figure 3-599 Align gear, coupler, and bracket ................................................................................................................................ 594
Figure 3-600 Remove the pickup lifting and empty sensor .......................................................................................................... 595
Figure 3-601 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 597
Figure 3-602 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 598
Figure 3-603 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 598
Figure 3-604 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 599
Figure 3-605 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 599
Figure 3-606 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 600
Figure 3-607 Remove one screw and the cover ............................................................................................................................. 600
Figure 3-608 Remove three screws .................................................................................................................................................. 601
Figure 3-609 Rotate pickup unit 2 ..................................................................................................................................................... 601
Figure 3-610 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 602
Figure 3-611 Align gear, coupler, and bracket ................................................................................................................................ 602
Figure 3-612 Remove three screws .................................................................................................................................................. 603
Figure 3-613 Rotate pickup unit 1 ..................................................................................................................................................... 603
Figure 3-614 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 604
Figure 3-615 Align gear, coupler, and bracket ................................................................................................................................ 604
Figure 3-616 Remove five screws and the bracket. ....................................................................................................................... 605
Figure 3-617 Remove the sensor ...................................................................................................................................................... 605
Figure 3-618 Remove the front top inner cover ............................................................................................................................. 608
Figure 3-619 Remove the output bin ................................................................................................................................................ 608
Figure 3-620 Remove the HDD cover ............................................................................................................................................... 609
Figure 3-621 Remove the HDD .......................................................................................................................................................... 609
Figure 3-622 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 612
Figure 3-623 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 612
Figure 3-624 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 613
Figure 3-625 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 613
Figure 3-626 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 614
Figure 3-627 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 614
Figure 3-628 Remove the paper dust brush ................................................................................................................................... 615
Figure 3-629 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 615
Figure 3-630 Remove the gear cover ............................................................................................................................................... 616
Figure 3-631 Disconnect one connector and remove two screws ............................................................................................... 616
Figure 3-632 Remove the registration assembly ........................................................................................................................... 617
Figure 3-633 Install the gear side of the shaft ................................................................................................................................ 617
Figure 3-634 Remove the bushing .................................................................................................................................................... 618
Figure 3-635 Install the bushing ........................................................................................................................................................ 618
Figure 3-636 Install the front of the shaft ....................................................................................................................................... 619
lxxxiv ENWW
Figure 3-637 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 621
Figure 3-638 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 622
Figure 3-639 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 622
Figure 3-640 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 623
Figure 3-641 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 623
Figure 3-642 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 624
Figure 3-643 Remove the paper dust brush ................................................................................................................................... 624
Figure 3-644 Remove two screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 625
Figure 3-645 Remove the gear cover ............................................................................................................................................... 625
Figure 3-646 Disconnect one connector and remove two screws ............................................................................................... 626
Figure 3-647 Remove the registration assembly ........................................................................................................................... 626
Figure 3-648 Install the gear side of the shaft ................................................................................................................................ 627
Figure 3-649 Remove the bushing .................................................................................................................................................... 627
Figure 3-650 Install the bushing ........................................................................................................................................................ 628
Figure 3-651 Install the front of the shaft ....................................................................................................................................... 628
Figure 3-652 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 629
Figure 3-653 Remove three screws and the registration sensor assembly .............................................................................. 629
Figure 3-654 Loosen one screw ........................................................................................................................................................ 632
Figure 3-655 Remove the drum unit ................................................................................................................................................. 633
Figure 3-656 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 633
Figure 3-657 Remove the lower rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 634
Figure 3-658 Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 634
Figure 3-659 Remove the left rear corner cover ............................................................................................................................ 635
Figure 3-660 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 635
Figure 3-661 Disconnect formatter connectors and screws ......................................................................................................... 636
Figure 3-662 Identify the formatter cables ..................................................................................................................................... 636
Figure 3-663 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 637
Figure 3-664 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 637
Figure 3-665 Remove five screws ..................................................................................................................................................... 638
Figure 3-666 Install the flat cable ...................................................................................................................................................... 638
Figure 3-667 Disconnect one connector and release two retainers ............................................................................................ 639
Figure 3-668 Remove the main drive unit ....................................................................................................................................... 639
Figure 3-669 Rotate the coupler ....................................................................................................................................................... 640
Figure 3-670 Disconnect two connectors and release cables ...................................................................................................... 640
Figure 3-671 Remove one ground screw ......................................................................................................................................... 641
Figure 3-672 Disconnect three connectors ...................................................................................................................................... 641
Figure 3-673 Remove three screws and the high voltage terminal ............................................................................................ 642
Figure 3-674 Remove document feeder connector cover ............................................................................................................ 644
Figure 3-675 Remove the cable choke ............................................................................................................................................. 644
Figure 3-676 Disconnect document feeder harness ...................................................................................................................... 645
Figure 3-677 Alignment marks .......................................................................................................................................................... 645
ENWW lxxxv
Figure 3-678 Remove screws ............................................................................................................................................................ 646
Figure 3-679 Release the document feeder .................................................................................................................................... 646
Figure 3-680 Remove the document feeder front cover top screws .......................................................................................... 649
Figure 3-681 Remove the document feeder front cover bottom screws ................................................................................... 649
Figure 3-682 Remove the document feeder back cover top screws ........................................................................................... 650
Figure 3-683 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws ................................................................................... 650
Figure 3-684 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 651
Figure 3-685 Remove the jam access cover ground wire ............................................................................................................. 651
Figure 3-686 Remove the jam access cover door arm support ................................................................................................... 652
Figure 3-687 Remove the document feeder front cover top screws .......................................................................................... 655
Figure 3-688 Remove the document feeder front cover bottom screws ................................................................................... 655
Figure 3-689 Remove the document feeder back cover top screws ........................................................................................... 656
Figure 3-690 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws ................................................................................... 656
Figure 3-691 Remove the document feeder damping unit .......................................................................................................... 657
Figure 3-692 Remove the document feeder pickup roller assembly cover screws .................................................................. 657
Figure 3-693 Remove the document feeder pickup roller assembly .......................................................................................... 658
Figure 3-694 Disconnect the document feeder PCA connector ................................................................................................... 658
Figure 3-695 Remove the document feeder front cover top screws .......................................................................................... 662
Figure 3-696 Remove the document feeder front cover bottom screws ................................................................................... 662
Figure 3-697 Remove the document feeder back cover top screws ........................................................................................... 663
Figure 3-698 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws ................................................................................... 663
Figure 3-699 Remove the pickup roller assembly .......................................................................................................................... 664
Figure 3-700 Remove the document feeder paper path cover .................................................................................................... 664
Figure 3-701 Remove the CIS front alignment cover screws ....................................................................................................... 665
Figure 3-702 Disconnect the CIS connector and lift the alignment pin ....................................................................................... 665
Figure 3-703 Remove the document feeder back cover top screws ........................................................................................... 668
Figure 3-704 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws ................................................................................... 668
Figure 3-705 Remove the document feeder front motor ............................................................................................................. 669
Figure 3-706 Document feeder motors ........................................................................................................................................... 673
Figure 3-707 Remove the document feeder back cover top screws ........................................................................................... 674
Figure 3-708 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws ................................................................................... 674
Figure 3-709 Remove the motor ....................................................................................................................................................... 675
Figure 3-710 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 676
Figure 3-711 Pickup motor ................................................................................................................................................................. 677
Figure 3-712 Pre-REGI motor ............................................................................................................................................................. 677
Figure 3-713 Remove the main fan .................................................................................................................................................. 678
Figure 3-714 Remove the motor ....................................................................................................................................................... 678
Figure 3-715 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 679
Figure 3-716 Remove the motor ....................................................................................................................................................... 679
Figure 3-717 Remove the document feeder back cover top screws ........................................................................................... 682
Figure 3-718 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws ................................................................................... 682
lxxxvi ENWW
Figure 3-719 Remove the document feeder PCA fan connector ................................................................................................. 683
Figure 3-720 Remove the document feeder back cover top screws ........................................................................................... 685
Figure 3-721 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws ................................................................................... 685
Figure 3-722 Remove the document feeder PCA fan .................................................................................................................... 686
Figure 3-723 Remove the document feeder front cover top screws .......................................................................................... 689
Figure 3-724 Remove the document feeder front cover bottom screws ................................................................................... 689
Figure 3-725 Remove the document feeder back cover top screws ........................................................................................... 690
Figure 3-726 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws ................................................................................... 690
Figure 3-727 Remove the pickup roller assembly .......................................................................................................................... 691
Figure 3-728 Remove the document feeder paper path cover .................................................................................................... 691
Figure 3-729 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 692
Figure 3-730 Remove the pick/feed cover ....................................................................................................................................... 692
Figure 3-731 Remove the ultrasonic sensor ................................................................................................................................... 693
Figure 3-732 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 697
Figure 3-733 Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 698
Figure 3-734 Remove document feeder connector cover ............................................................................................................ 698
Figure 3-735 Remove the cable choke ............................................................................................................................................. 699
Figure 3-736 Disconnect document feeder harness ...................................................................................................................... 699
Figure 3-737 Alignment marks .......................................................................................................................................................... 700
Figure 3-738 Remove screws ............................................................................................................................................................ 700
Figure 3-739 Release the document feeder .................................................................................................................................... 701
Figure 3-740 Remove the document feeder bezel ........................................................................................................................ 701
Figure 3-741 Remove the control panel screws and disconnect connectors ............................................................................ 702
Figure 3-742 Remove the USB interconnect cable ......................................................................................................................... 702
Figure 3-743 Disconnect one FFC ...................................................................................................................................................... 703
Figure 3-744 Remove the control-panel keyboard ........................................................................................................................ 703
Figure 3-745 Remove screw-caps and screws and release scan-front cover ........................................................................... 704
Figure 3-746 Release scan-left cover ............................................................................................................................................... 704
Figure 3-747 Remove scan-right cover ............................................................................................................................................ 705
Figure 3-748 Disconnect scan cables ............................................................................................................................................... 705
Figure 3-749 Remove screws ............................................................................................................................................................ 706
Figure 3-750 Remove screws ............................................................................................................................................................ 706
Figure 3-751 Lift up and release image scanner unit .................................................................................................................... 706
Figure 3-752 Remove scan glass ...................................................................................................................................................... 709
Figure 3-753 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 711
Figure 3-754 Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 711
Figure 3-755 Remove document feeder connector cover ............................................................................................................ 712
Figure 3-756 Remove the cable choke ............................................................................................................................................. 712
Figure 3-757 Disconnect document feeder harness ...................................................................................................................... 713
Figure 3-758 Alignment marks .......................................................................................................................................................... 713
Figure 3-759 Remove screws ............................................................................................................................................................ 714
ENWW lxxxvii
Figure 3-760 Release the document feeder .................................................................................................................................... 714
Figure 3-761 Remove scan glass ...................................................................................................................................................... 715
Figure 3-762 Remove transparent tape ........................................................................................................................................... 716
Figure 3-763 Disconnect cable .......................................................................................................................................................... 716
Figure 3-764 Remove screws and release LED lamp module ...................................................................................................... 716
Figure 3-765 Remove scan glass ...................................................................................................................................................... 719
Figure 3-766 Remove screws and release imaging unit cover ..................................................................................................... 719
Figure 3-767 Disconnect flat cable .................................................................................................................................................... 720
Figure 3-768 Remove screws and release scanner imaging unit ................................................................................................ 720
Figure 3-769 Remove the formatter cover ...................................................................................................................................... 723
Figure 3-770 Remove the upper rear cover ..................................................................................................................................... 723
Figure 3-771 Remove document feeder connector cover ............................................................................................................ 724
Figure 3-772 Remove the cable choke ............................................................................................................................................. 724
Figure 3-773 Disconnect document feeder harness ...................................................................................................................... 725
Figure 3-774 Alignment marks .......................................................................................................................................................... 725
Figure 3-775 Remove screws ............................................................................................................................................................ 726
Figure 3-776 Release the document feeder .................................................................................................................................... 726
Figure 3-777 Release scan-left cover ............................................................................................................................................... 727
Figure 3-778 Remove scan-right cover ............................................................................................................................................ 727
Figure 3-779 Remove three screws .................................................................................................................................................. 728
Figure 3-780 Remove three screws and the scanner rear cover ................................................................................................. 728
Figure 3-781 Remove screws and release scan joint board ......................................................................................................... 729
Figure 3-782 Remove document feeder connector cover ............................................................................................................ 731
Figure 3-783 Remove the cable choke ............................................................................................................................................. 731
Figure 3-784 Disconnect document feeder harness ...................................................................................................................... 732
Figure 3-785 Alignment marks .......................................................................................................................................................... 732
Figure 3-786 Remove screws ............................................................................................................................................................ 733
Figure 3-787 Release the document feeder .................................................................................................................................... 733
Figure 3-788 Remove scan glass ...................................................................................................................................................... 734
Figure 3-789 Remove joint board cover ........................................................................................................................................... 734
Figure 3-790 Remove screw .............................................................................................................................................................. 734
Figure 3-791 Disconnect harness ...................................................................................................................................................... 735
Figure 3-792 Remove screws and release APS sensor ................................................................................................................. 735
Figure 3-793 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 739
Figure 3-794 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 739
Figure 3-795 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 740
Figure 3-796 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 740
Figure 3-797 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 741
Figure 3-798 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 741
Figure 3-799 Remove the lower right cover .................................................................................................................................... 742
Figure 3-800 Slide the hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................................ 742
lxxxviii ENWW
Figure 3-801 Remove the DCF right door ........................................................................................................................................ 743
Figure 3-802 Remove the DCF rear cover ........................................................................................................................................ 745
Figure 3-803 Disconnect two connectors and open one retainer ................................................................................................ 745
Figure 3-804 Remove the feed drive unit ........................................................................................................................................ 746
Figure 3-805 Remove the feed motor .............................................................................................................................................. 746
Figure 3-806 Remove the DCF rear cover ........................................................................................................................................ 749
Figure 3-807 Remove the DCF pickup motor .................................................................................................................................. 749
Figure 3-808 Remove the DCF rear cover ........................................................................................................................................ 751
Figure 3-809 Remove the DCF PCA ................................................................................................................................................... 751
Figure 3-810 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 754
Figure 3-811 Remove the right rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 754
Figure 3-812 Disconnect one connector .......................................................................................................................................... 755
Figure 3-813 Release the right hinge ............................................................................................................................................... 755
Figure 3-814 Release the left dampener ......................................................................................................................................... 756
Figure 3-815 Remove the right door ................................................................................................................................................ 756
Figure 3-816 Remove the lower right cover .................................................................................................................................... 757
Figure 3-817 Slide the hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................................ 757
Figure 3-818 Remove the DCF right door ........................................................................................................................................ 758
Figure 3-819 Remove two screws and the cable cover ................................................................................................................. 758
Figure 3-820 Remove five screws and two brackets ..................................................................................................................... 759
Figure 3-821 Disconnect two connectors and remove eight screws .......................................................................................... 759
Figure 3-822 Remove the pickup units ............................................................................................................................................. 760
Figure 3-823 Remove the rear cover ................................................................................................................................................ 763
Figure 3-824 Disconnect two connectors and open the clamp .................................................................................................... 763
Figure 3-825 Remove the feed drive unit ........................................................................................................................................ 763
Figure 3-826 Remove the feed motor .............................................................................................................................................. 764
Figure 3-827 Remove the rear cover ................................................................................................................................................ 766
Figure 3-828 Remove the bottom HCI tray pickup motor ............................................................................................................. 766
Figure 3-829 Remove the rear cover ................................................................................................................................................ 769
Figure 3-830 Remove the bottom HCI tray PCA .............................................................................................................................. 769
Figure 3-831 Remove the rear cover ................................................................................................................................................ 772
Figure 3-832 Remove the bottom HCI tray lift-up motor .............................................................................................................. 772
Figure 3-833 Remove the rear cover ................................................................................................................................................ 774
Figure 3-834 Remove the shaft motor ............................................................................................................................................. 774
Figure 3-835 Remove the sHCI rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 777
Figure 3-836 Right sHCI cover ............................................................................................................................................................ 779
Figure 3-837 Remove the sHCI cable cover ..................................................................................................................................... 779
Figure 3-838 Remove the sHCI rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 779
Figure 3-839 Drive PH ......................................................................................................................................................................... 780
Figure 3-840 Feed motor .................................................................................................................................................................... 780
Figure 3-841 Right sHCI cover ............................................................................................................................................................ 783
ENWW lxxxix
Figure 3-842 Remove the sHCI cable cover ..................................................................................................................................... 783
Figure 3-843 Remove the sHCI rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 783
Figure 3-844 Pickup motor ................................................................................................................................................................. 784
Figure 3-845 Right sHCI cover ............................................................................................................................................................ 786
Figure 3-846 Remove the sHCI cable cover ..................................................................................................................................... 786
Figure 3-847 Remove the sHCI rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 786
Figure 3-848 sHCI PCA ......................................................................................................................................................................... 787
Figure 3-849 Right sHCI cover ............................................................................................................................................................ 789
Figure 3-850 Remove the sHCI cable cover ..................................................................................................................................... 789
Figure 3-851 Remove the sHCI rear cover ....................................................................................................................................... 789
Figure 3-852 sHCI lift-up motor ......................................................................................................................................................... 790
Figure 4-1 Main assembly ................................................................................................................................................................... 794
Figure 4-2 Main assembly 2 ................................................................................................................................................................ 796
Figure 4-3 Output ................................................................................................................................................................................. 798
Figure 4-4 First cassette ...................................................................................................................................................................... 800
Figure 4-5 Second cassette ................................................................................................................................................................ 802
Figure 4-6 Main assembly frame ....................................................................................................................................................... 804
Figure 4-7 Main frame registration assembly ................................................................................................................................. 806
Figure 4-8 Drive system ...................................................................................................................................................................... 808
Figure 4-9 Frame main pickup 1 and 2 ............................................................................................................................................. 810
Figure 4-10 Frame main pickup ......................................................................................................................................................... 812
Figure 4-11 Cover ................................................................................................................................................................................. 814
Figure 4-12 Right door ........................................................................................................................................................................ 816
Figure 4-13 MP tray ............................................................................................................................................................................. 818
Figure 4-14 Right door guide ............................................................................................................................................................. 820
Figure 4-15 Right door output and takeaway ................................................................................................................................. 822
Figure 4-16 PTB transfer ..................................................................................................................................................................... 824
Figure 4-17 Flow ADF (z models) ....................................................................................................................................................... 826
Figure 4-18 Flow ADF open cover (z models) .................................................................................................................................. 828
Figure 4-19 Flow ADF pickup roller assembly ................................................................................................................................. 830
Figure 4-20 Flow ADF stacker ............................................................................................................................................................ 832
Figure 4-21 Flow ADF main frame (z models) ................................................................................................................................. 834
Figure 4-22 Flow ADF image scanner ............................................................................................................................................... 836
Figure 4-23 Flow ADF image scanner, lower ................................................................................................................................... 838
Figure 4-24 Reservoir .......................................................................................................................................................................... 840
Figure 4-25 DCF main .......................................................................................................................................................................... 842
Figure 4-26 DCF frame ........................................................................................................................................................................ 844
Figure 4-27 DCF rear frame ................................................................................................................................................................ 846
Figure 4-28 Opt feed drive .................................................................................................................................................................. 848
Figure 4-29 DCF second pickup .......................................................................................................................................................... 850
Figure 4-30 HCI main ........................................................................................................................................................................... 852
xc ENWW
Figure 4-31 HCI drive ........................................................................................................................................................................... 854
Figure 4-32 HCI cassette ..................................................................................................................................................................... 856
Figure 4-33 HCI frame ......................................................................................................................................................................... 858
Figure 4-34 HCI main pickup ............................................................................................................................................................... 860
Figure 4-35 sHCI main 1 ...................................................................................................................................................................... 862
Figure 4-36 sHCI main 3 ...................................................................................................................................................................... 864
Figure 4-37 sHCI main 5 ...................................................................................................................................................................... 866
Figure 4-38 sHCI main 6 ...................................................................................................................................................................... 868
Figure 4-39 Pickup cover unit ............................................................................................................................................................. 870
Figure 4-40 sHCI frame ....................................................................................................................................................................... 872
Figure 4-41 Booklet finisher ............................................................................................................................................................... 874
Figure 4-42 Mainline finisher 1 ........................................................................................................................................................... 876
Figure 4-43 Mainline finisher 2 ........................................................................................................................................................... 878
Figure 4-44 Mainline finisher 3 ........................................................................................................................................................... 880
Figure 4-45 Mainline finisher 4 ........................................................................................................................................................... 882
Figure 4-46 Mainline finisher 5 ........................................................................................................................................................... 884
Figure 4-47 Mainline finisher 6 ........................................................................................................................................................... 886
Figure 4-48 Three fold motor, curl pawl motor, curl pawl, and three fold output .................................................................... 888
Figure 4-49 Low output, hb motor, and top guide .......................................................................................................................... 890
Figure 4-50 SCU motor, STK motor, and entrance guide ............................................................................................................... 892
Figure 4-51 Entrance motor, low paddle, alignment, and paddle motor .................................................................................... 894
Figure 4-52 Drive buffer, top lower, and top jam ............................................................................................................................ 896
Figure 4-53 FD stopper unit, jam clear, and BKT main blade ........................................................................................................ 898
Figure 4-54 Fold roller, main blade, and top frame ........................................................................................................................ 900
Figure 4-55 Three fold blade .............................................................................................................................................................. 902
Figure 4-56 Door, top door, top cover, and registration guide ..................................................................................................... 904
Figure 4-57 Entrance guide, mid jam, and main output ................................................................................................................ 906
Figure 4-58 Transfer buffer, right jam, div cam, hb motor, and paddle motor .......................................................................... 908
Figure 4-59 Front alignment (tamper) .............................................................................................................................................. 910
Figure 4-60 Rear alignment (tamper) ............................................................................................................................................... 912
Figure 4-61 Shield ................................................................................................................................................................................ 914
Figure 4-62 PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and paddle .................................................................................................................. 916
Figure 4-63 Finisher sub booklet ....................................................................................................................................................... 918
Figure 4-64 IPTU (bridge) .................................................................................................................................................................... 920
Figure 4-65 Sub-inner finisher ........................................................................................................................................................... 922
Figure 4-66 Finisher sub 1 .................................................................................................................................................................. 924
Figure 4-67 Finisher sub 7 .................................................................................................................................................................. 926
Figure 4-68 Finisher sub 8 .................................................................................................................................................................. 928
Figure 5-1 Touchscreen blank, white, or dim (no image) ............................................................................................................... 979
Figure 5-2 Touchscreen has an unresponsive zone ....................................................................................................................... 980
Figure 5-3 No control panel sound .................................................................................................................................................... 981
ENWW xci
Figure 5-4 Home button is unresponsive ......................................................................................................................................... 982
Figure 5-5 Hardware integration pocket (HIP) is not functioning (control panel functional) ................................................... 983
Figure 5-7 Defeat the toner cartridge door interlock ..................................................................................................................... 985
Figure 5-8 Defeat the front door interlock ....................................................................................................................................... 986
Figure 5-12 Open the Control Panel ............................................................................................................................................... 1003
Figure 5-13 Turn Windows features on or off ............................................................................................................................... 1003
Figure 5-14 Enable the telnet client feature ................................................................................................................................. 1004
Figure 5-15 Select the +3:Administrator item .............................................................................................................................. 1005
Figure 5-16 Select the +A:Remote Admin item ............................................................................................................................ 1005
Figure 5-17 Select the 1:Start Telnet item .................................................................................................................................... 1005
Figure 5-18 Telnet connecting message ....................................................................................................................................... 1005
Figure 5-19 Telnet error message .................................................................................................................................................. 1006
Figure 5-20 Telnet server function initialized ............................................................................................................................... 1006
Figure 5-21 Open a command window .......................................................................................................................................... 1007
Figure 5-22 Start a telnet session ................................................................................................................................................... 1007
Figure 5-23 Establish a telnet connection ..................................................................................................................................... 1007
Figure 5-24 Enter the PIN ................................................................................................................................................................. 1008
Figure 5-25 Remote Admin window ............................................................................................................................................... 1008
Figure 5-26 Access the administrator menu ................................................................................................................................. 1009
Figure 5-27 Access the remote admin menu ................................................................................................................................ 1009
Figure 5-28 Terminate the telnet connection ............................................................................................................................... 1010
Figure 5-29 Open the Flow ADF cover ............................................................................................................................................ 1083
Figure 5-30 Remove jam from the Flow ADF ................................................................................................................................ 1084
Figure 5-31 Open the Flow ADF cover ............................................................................................................................................ 1084
Figure 5-32 Remove jam from the Flow ADF ................................................................................................................................ 1085
Figure 5-33 Open input tray ............................................................................................................................................................. 1085
Figure 5-34 Remove jam from the Flow ADF ................................................................................................................................ 1086
Figure 5-35 Open the Flow ADF ....................................................................................................................................................... 1086
Figure 5-36 Remove jam from the feed area ................................................................................................................................ 1087
Figure 5-37 Open right door ............................................................................................................................................................ 1087
Figure 5-38 Remove jam .................................................................................................................................................................. 1088
Figure 5-39 Remove tray .................................................................................................................................................................. 1088
Figure 5-40 Remove jam .................................................................................................................................................................. 1089
Figure 5-41 Open bottom right door .............................................................................................................................................. 1089
Figure 5-42 Remove jam .................................................................................................................................................................. 1090
Figure 5-43 Remove paper .............................................................................................................................................................. 1090
Figure 5-44 Open right door ............................................................................................................................................................ 1091
Figure 5-45 Remove jam .................................................................................................................................................................. 1091
Figure 5-46 Open right door ............................................................................................................................................................ 1092
Figure 5-47 Remove jam .................................................................................................................................................................. 1092
Figure 5-48 Open right door ............................................................................................................................................................ 1093
xcii ENWW
Figure 5-49 Remove jam .................................................................................................................................................................. 1093
Figure 5-50 Open right door ............................................................................................................................................................ 1094
Figure 5-51 Remove jam .................................................................................................................................................................. 1094
Figure 5-52 Remove paper .............................................................................................................................................................. 1095
Figure 5-53 Bin full sensor ............................................................................................................................................................... 1095
Figure 5-54 Service tools view ......................................................................................................................................................... 1096
Figure 5-55 Information .................................................................................................................................................................... 1097
Figure 5-56 Maintenance counts ..................................................................................................................................................... 1098
Figure 5-57 Diagnostics .................................................................................................................................................................... 1099
Figure 5-58 Service functions .......................................................................................................................................................... 1100
Figure 5-62 Typical faulty images ................................................................................................................................................... 1135
Figure 5-63 Typical faulty images ................................................................................................................................................... 1136
Figure 5-64 Typical faulty images ................................................................................................................................................... 1137
Figure 5-65 Typical faulty images ................................................................................................................................................... 1138
Figure 5-66 Typical faulty images ................................................................................................................................................... 1139
Figure 5-67 Typical faulty images ................................................................................................................................................... 1140
Figure 5-68 Typical faulty images ................................................................................................................................................... 1141
Figure 5-69 Typical faulty images ................................................................................................................................................... 1141
Figure 5-70 Typical faulty images ................................................................................................................................................... 1143
Figure 5-71 Typical faulty images ................................................................................................................................................... 1143
Figure 5-72 Typical faulty images ................................................................................................................................................... 1144
Figure 7-1 Sensor locations ............................................................................................................................................................. 1182
Figure 7-2 Roller location ................................................................................................................................................................. 1183
Figure 7-3 Jam removal guide ......................................................................................................................................................... 1185
Figure 7-4 Paper path ....................................................................................................................................................................... 1186
Figure 7-5 Electrical parts layout (1 of 2) ....................................................................................................................................... 1187
Figure 7-6 Electrical parts layout (2 of 2) ....................................................................................................................................... 1188
Figure 7-7 IPTU ................................................................................................................................................................................... 1191
Figure 7-8 Punch unit ........................................................................................................................................................................ 1191
Figure 7-9 ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 1192
Figure 7-10 Finisher PCA ................................................................................................................................................................... 1193
Figure 7-11 Switch PCA ..................................................................................................................................................................... 1194
Figure 7-12 Booklet maker PCA ...................................................................................................................................................... 1194
Figure 7-13 Remove the top output bin ......................................................................................................................................... 1201
Figure 7-14 Remove six screws and the right top cover ............................................................................................................. 1203
Figure 7-15 Remove six screws and the right top cover ............................................................................................................. 1206
Figure 7-16 Remove six screws ....................................................................................................................................................... 1207
Figure 7-17 Remove six screws ....................................................................................................................................................... 1207
Figure 7-18 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ..................................................................................................... 1208
Figure 7-19 Remove six screws and the right top cover ............................................................................................................. 1210
Figure 7-20 Remove six screws ....................................................................................................................................................... 1211
ENWW xciii
Figure 7-21 Remove six screws ....................................................................................................................................................... 1211
Figure 7-22 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ..................................................................................................... 1212
Figure 7-23 Lift the top hinge pin .................................................................................................................................................... 1212
Figure 7-24 Remove the top hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................... 1213
Figure 7-25 Release the lower hinge pin ....................................................................................................................................... 1213
Figure 7-26 Remove the lower hinge pin ....................................................................................................................................... 1214
Figure 7-27 Remove one screw and the front door ..................................................................................................................... 1214
Figure 7-28 Remove six screws and the right top cover ............................................................................................................. 1217
Figure 7-29 Remove six screws ....................................................................................................................................................... 1218
Figure 7-30 Remove six screws ....................................................................................................................................................... 1218
Figure 7-31 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ..................................................................................................... 1219
Figure 7-32 Remove seven screws ................................................................................................................................................. 1219
Figure 7-33 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................... 1220
Figure 7-34 Remove six screws and the right top cover ............................................................................................................. 1222
Figure 7-35 Remove six screws ....................................................................................................................................................... 1223
Figure 7-36 Remove six screws ....................................................................................................................................................... 1223
Figure 7-37 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ..................................................................................................... 1224
Figure 7-38 Lift the top hinge pin .................................................................................................................................................... 1224
Figure 7-39 Remove the top hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................... 1225
Figure 7-40 Release the lower hinge pin ....................................................................................................................................... 1225
Figure 7-41 Remove the lower hinge pin ....................................................................................................................................... 1226
Figure 7-42 Remove one screw and the front door ..................................................................................................................... 1226
Figure 7-43 Remove the jam-access knob .................................................................................................................................... 1227
Figure 7-44 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 1227
Figure 7-45 Remove five screws and the front cover .................................................................................................................. 1228
Figure 7-46 Remove six screws and the right top cover ............................................................................................................. 1230
Figure 7-47 Remove six screws ....................................................................................................................................................... 1231
Figure 7-48 Remove six screws ....................................................................................................................................................... 1231
Figure 7-49 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ..................................................................................................... 1232
Figure 7-50 Lift the top hinge pin .................................................................................................................................................... 1232
Figure 7-51 Remove the top hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................... 1233
Figure 7-52 Release the lower hinge pin ....................................................................................................................................... 1233
Figure 7-53 Remove the lower hinge pin ....................................................................................................................................... 1234
Figure 7-54 Remove one screw and the front door ..................................................................................................................... 1234
Figure 7-55 Remove the jam-access knob .................................................................................................................................... 1235
Figure 7-56 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 1235
Figure 7-57 Remove five screws and the front cover .................................................................................................................. 1236
Figure 7-58 Remove three screws and the front lower cover .................................................................................................... 1236
Figure 7-59 Remove the booklet tray ............................................................................................................................................ 1239
Figure 7-60 Install the booklet tray ................................................................................................................................................ 1239
Figure 7-61 Remove the booklet tray ............................................................................................................................................ 1242
xciv ENWW
Figure 7-62 Install the booklet tray ................................................................................................................................................ 1242
Figure 7-63 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1243
Figure 7-64 Remove the caster cover ............................................................................................................................................ 1243
Figure 7-65 Remove six screws and the right top cover ............................................................................................................. 1246
Figure 7-66 Remove six screws ....................................................................................................................................................... 1247
Figure 7-67 Remove six screws ....................................................................................................................................................... 1247
Figure 7-68 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ..................................................................................................... 1248
Figure 7-69 Lift the top hinge pin .................................................................................................................................................... 1248
Figure 7-70 Remove the top hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................... 1249
Figure 7-71 Release the lower hinge pin ....................................................................................................................................... 1249
Figure 7-72 Remove the lower hinge pin ....................................................................................................................................... 1250
Figure 7-73 Remove one screw and the front door ..................................................................................................................... 1250
Figure 7-74 Remove the jam-access knob .................................................................................................................................... 1251
Figure 7-75 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 1251
Figure 7-76 Remove five screws and the front cover .................................................................................................................. 1252
Figure 7-77 Remove seven screws ................................................................................................................................................. 1252
Figure 7-78 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................... 1253
Figure 7-79 Remove the booklet tray ............................................................................................................................................ 1253
Figure 7-80 Install the booklet tray ................................................................................................................................................ 1254
Figure 7-81 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1254
Figure 7-82 Remove the caster cover ............................................................................................................................................ 1255
Figure 7-83 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1255
Figure 7-84 Release the lower shield ............................................................................................................................................. 1256
Figure 7-85 Disconnect two connectors ........................................................................................................................................ 1256
Figure 7-86 Locate sensors .............................................................................................................................................................. 1257
Figure 7-87 Remove six screws and the right top cover ............................................................................................................. 1259
Figure 7-88 Remove six screws ....................................................................................................................................................... 1260
Figure 7-89 Remove six screws ....................................................................................................................................................... 1260
Figure 7-90 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ..................................................................................................... 1261
Figure 7-91 Lift the top hinge pin .................................................................................................................................................... 1261
Figure 7-92 Remove the top hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................... 1262
Figure 7-93 Release the lower hinge pin ....................................................................................................................................... 1262
Figure 7-94 Remove the lower hinge pin ....................................................................................................................................... 1263
Figure 7-95 Remove one screw and the front door ..................................................................................................................... 1263
Figure 7-96 Remove the jam-access knob .................................................................................................................................... 1264
Figure 7-97 Remove one screw ....................................................................................................................................................... 1264
Figure 7-98 Remove five screws and the front cover .................................................................................................................. 1265
Figure 7-99 Remove seven screws ................................................................................................................................................. 1265
Figure 7-100 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1266
Figure 7-101 Remove the booklet tray .......................................................................................................................................... 1266
Figure 7-102 Install the booklet tray .............................................................................................................................................. 1267
ENWW xcv
Figure 7-103 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1267
Figure 7-104 Remove the caster cover .......................................................................................................................................... 1268
Figure 7-105 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1268
Figure 7-106 Release the lower shield ........................................................................................................................................... 1269
Figure 7-107 Disconnect two connectors ...................................................................................................................................... 1269
Figure 7-108 Locate sensors ........................................................................................................................................................... 1270
Figure 7-109 Lower the output tray ............................................................................................................................................... 1270
Figure 7-110 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1271
Figure 7-111 Release the shield ...................................................................................................................................................... 1271
Figure 7-112 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1272
Figure 7-113 Locate sensors ........................................................................................................................................................... 1272
Figure 7-114 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1275
Figure 7-115 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1276
Figure 7-116 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1276
Figure 7-117 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1277
Figure 7-118 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1277
Figure 7-119 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1278
Figure 7-120 Remove the controller PCA ...................................................................................................................................... 1278
Figure 7-121 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1281
Figure 7-122 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1282
Figure 7-123 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1282
Figure 7-124 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1283
Figure 7-125 Lift the top hinge pin ................................................................................................................................................. 1283
Figure 7-126 Remove the top hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................ 1284
Figure 7-127 Release the lower hinge pin ..................................................................................................................................... 1284
Figure 7-128 Remove the lower hinge pin .................................................................................................................................... 1285
Figure 7-129 Remove one screw and the front door ................................................................................................................... 1285
Figure 7-130 Remove the jam-access knob ................................................................................................................................. 1286
Figure 7-131 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1286
Figure 7-132 Remove five screws and the front cover ................................................................................................................ 1287
Figure 7-133 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1287
Figure 7-134 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1288
Figure 7-135 Move the staple unit to the front ............................................................................................................................. 1288
Figure 7-136 Remove the staple cartridge .................................................................................................................................... 1289
Figure 7-137 Disconnect three connectors and remove two screws ........................................................................................ 1289
Figure 7-138 Disconnect one connector and remove two screws ............................................................................................ 1290
Figure 7-139 Remove the staple unit ............................................................................................................................................. 1290
Figure 7-140 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1293
Figure 7-141 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1294
Figure 7-142 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1294
Figure 7-143 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1295
xcvi ENWW
Figure 7-144 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1295
Figure 7-145 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1296
Figure 7-146 Remove two screws and the feed guide ................................................................................................................ 1296
Figure 7-147 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1299
Figure 7-148 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1300
Figure 7-149 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1300
Figure 7-150 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1301
Figure 7-151 Lift the top hinge pin ................................................................................................................................................. 1301
Figure 7-152 Remove the top hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................ 1302
Figure 7-153 Release the lower hinge pin ..................................................................................................................................... 1302
Figure 7-154 Remove the lower hinge pin .................................................................................................................................... 1303
Figure 7-155 Remove one screw and the front door ................................................................................................................... 1303
Figure 7-156 Remove the jam-access knob ................................................................................................................................. 1304
Figure 7-157 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1304
Figure 7-158 Remove five screws and the front cover ................................................................................................................ 1305
Figure 7-159 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1305
Figure 7-160 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1306
Figure 7-161 Remove the feed exit motor .................................................................................................................................... 1306
Figure 7-162 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1307
Figure 7-163 Remove the top jam access cover ........................................................................................................................... 1307
Figure 7-164 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1310
Figure 7-165 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1311
Figure 7-166 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1311
Figure 7-167 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1312
Figure 7-168 Lift the top hinge pin ................................................................................................................................................. 1312
Figure 7-169 Remove the top hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................ 1313
Figure 7-170 Release the lower hinge pin ..................................................................................................................................... 1313
Figure 7-171 Remove the lower hinge pin .................................................................................................................................... 1314
Figure 7-172 Remove one screw and the front door ................................................................................................................... 1314
Figure 7-173 Remove the jam-access knob ................................................................................................................................. 1315
Figure 7-174 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1315
Figure 7-175 Remove five screws and the front cover ................................................................................................................ 1316
Figure 7-176 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1316
Figure 7-177 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1317
Figure 7-178 Remove the feed exit motor .................................................................................................................................... 1317
Figure 7-179 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1318
Figure 7-180 Remove the top jam access cover ........................................................................................................................... 1318
Figure 7-181 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1319
Figure 7-182 Remove three screws and disconnect one connector ......................................................................................... 1319
Figure 7-183 Remove three screws ............................................................................................................................................... 1320
Figure 7-184 Remove the feed assembly ..................................................................................................................................... 1320
ENWW xcvii
Figure 7-185 Locate sensors and connector ................................................................................................................................. 1321
Figure 7-186 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1323
Figure 7-187 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1324
Figure 7-188 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1324
Figure 7-189 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1325
Figure 7-190 Lift the top hinge pin ................................................................................................................................................. 1325
Figure 7-191 Remove the top hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................ 1326
Figure 7-192 Release the lower hinge pin ..................................................................................................................................... 1326
Figure 7-193 Remove the lower hinge pin .................................................................................................................................... 1327
Figure 7-194 Remove one screw and the front door ................................................................................................................... 1327
Figure 7-195 Remove the jam-access knob ................................................................................................................................. 1328
Figure 7-196 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1328
Figure 7-197 Remove five screws and the front cover ................................................................................................................ 1329
Figure 7-198 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1329
Figure 7-199 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1330
Figure 7-200 Remove the booklet tray .......................................................................................................................................... 1330
Figure 7-201 Install the booklet tray .............................................................................................................................................. 1331
Figure 7-202 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1331
Figure 7-203 Remove the caster cover .......................................................................................................................................... 1332
Figure 7-204 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1332
Figure 7-205 Release the lower shield ........................................................................................................................................... 1333
Figure 7-206 Disconnect two connectors ...................................................................................................................................... 1333
Figure 7-207 Locate sensors ........................................................................................................................................................... 1334
Figure 7-208 Lower the output tray ............................................................................................................................................... 1334
Figure 7-209 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1335
Figure 7-210 Release the shield ...................................................................................................................................................... 1335
Figure 7-211 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1336
Figure 7-212 Locate sensors ........................................................................................................................................................... 1336
Figure 7-213 Move the staple unit to the center .......................................................................................................................... 1337
Figure 7-214 Disconnect three connectors ................................................................................................................................... 1337
Figure 7-215 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1338
Figure 7-216 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1338
Figure 7-217 Rotate the sensor ...................................................................................................................................................... 1339
Figure 7-218 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1339
Figure 7-219 Remove the front tamper shaft .............................................................................................................................. 1340
Figure 7-220 Disconnect two connectors and remove three screws ........................................................................................ 1340
Figure 7-221 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1341
Figure 7-222 Remove the rear tamper shaft ................................................................................................................................ 1341
Figure 7-223 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1342
Figure 7-224 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1342
Figure 7-225 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1343
xcviii ENWW
Figure 7-226 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1343
Figure 7-227 Lift the edges of the tampers .................................................................................................................................. 1344
Figure 7-228 Remove the ejector unit ........................................................................................................................................... 1344
Figure 7-229 Reinstall the front tamper shaft .............................................................................................................................. 1345
Figure 7-230 Reinstall the rear tamper shaft ............................................................................................................................... 1345
Figure 7-231 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1348
Figure 7-232 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1349
Figure 7-233 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1349
Figure 7-234 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1350
Figure 7-235 Lift the top hinge pin ................................................................................................................................................. 1350
Figure 7-236 Remove the top hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................ 1351
Figure 7-237 Release the lower hinge pin ..................................................................................................................................... 1351
Figure 7-238 Remove the lower hinge pin .................................................................................................................................... 1352
Figure 7-239 Remove one screw and the front door ................................................................................................................... 1352
Figure 7-240 Remove the jam-access knob ................................................................................................................................. 1353
Figure 7-241 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1353
Figure 7-242 Remove five screws and the front cover ................................................................................................................ 1354
Figure 7-243 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1354
Figure 7-244 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1355
Figure 7-245 Remove the booklet tray .......................................................................................................................................... 1355
Figure 7-246 Install the booklet tray .............................................................................................................................................. 1356
Figure 7-247 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1356
Figure 7-248 Remove the caster cover .......................................................................................................................................... 1357
Figure 7-249 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1357
Figure 7-250 Release the lower shield ........................................................................................................................................... 1358
Figure 7-251 Disconnect two connectors ...................................................................................................................................... 1358
Figure 7-252 Locate sensors ........................................................................................................................................................... 1359
Figure 7-253 Lower the output tray ............................................................................................................................................... 1359
Figure 7-254 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1360
Figure 7-255 Release the shield ...................................................................................................................................................... 1360
Figure 7-256 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1361
Figure 7-257 Locate sensors ........................................................................................................................................................... 1361
Figure 7-258 Move the staple unit to the center .......................................................................................................................... 1362
Figure 7-259 Disconnect three connectors ................................................................................................................................... 1362
Figure 7-260 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1363
Figure 7-261 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1363
Figure 7-262 Rotate the sensor ...................................................................................................................................................... 1364
Figure 7-263 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1364
Figure 7-264 Remove the front tamper shaft .............................................................................................................................. 1365
Figure 7-265 Disconnect two connectors and remove three screws ........................................................................................ 1365
Figure 7-266 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1366
ENWW xcix
Figure 7-267 Remove the rear tamper shaft ................................................................................................................................ 1366
Figure 7-268 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1367
Figure 7-269 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1367
Figure 7-270 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1368
Figure 7-271 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1368
Figure 7-272 Lift the edges of the tampers .................................................................................................................................. 1369
Figure 7-273 Remove the ejector unit ........................................................................................................................................... 1369
Figure 7-274 Reinstall the front tamper shaft .............................................................................................................................. 1370
Figure 7-275 Reinstall the rear tamper shaft ............................................................................................................................... 1370
Figure 7-276 Remove the front tamper ......................................................................................................................................... 1371
Figure 7-277 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1373
Figure 7-278 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1374
Figure 7-279 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1374
Figure 7-280 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1375
Figure 7-281 Lift the top hinge pin ................................................................................................................................................. 1375
Figure 7-282 Remove the top hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................ 1376
Figure 7-283 Release the lower hinge pin ..................................................................................................................................... 1376
Figure 7-284 Remove the lower hinge pin .................................................................................................................................... 1377
Figure 7-285 Remove one screw and the front door ................................................................................................................... 1377
Figure 7-286 Remove the jam-access knob ................................................................................................................................. 1378
Figure 7-287 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1378
Figure 7-288 Remove five screws and the front cover ................................................................................................................ 1379
Figure 7-289 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1379
Figure 7-290 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1380
Figure 7-291 Remove the booklet tray .......................................................................................................................................... 1380
Figure 7-292 Install the booklet tray .............................................................................................................................................. 1381
Figure 7-293 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1381
Figure 7-294 Remove the caster cover .......................................................................................................................................... 1382
Figure 7-295 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1382
Figure 7-296 Release the lower shield ........................................................................................................................................... 1383
Figure 7-297 Disconnect two connectors ...................................................................................................................................... 1383
Figure 7-298 Locate sensors ........................................................................................................................................................... 1384
Figure 7-299 Lower the output tray ............................................................................................................................................... 1384
Figure 7-300 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1385
Figure 7-301 Release the shield ...................................................................................................................................................... 1385
Figure 7-302 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1386
Figure 7-303 Locate sensors ........................................................................................................................................................... 1386
Figure 7-304 Move the staple unit to the center .......................................................................................................................... 1387
Figure 7-305 Disconnect three connectors ................................................................................................................................... 1387
Figure 7-306 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1388
Figure 7-307 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1388
c ENWW
Figure 7-308 Rotate the sensor ...................................................................................................................................................... 1389
Figure 7-309 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1389
Figure 7-310 Remove the front tamper shaft .............................................................................................................................. 1390
Figure 7-311 Disconnect two connectors and remove three screws ........................................................................................ 1390
Figure 7-312 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1391
Figure 7-313 Remove the rear tamper shaft ................................................................................................................................ 1391
Figure 7-314 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1392
Figure 7-315 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1392
Figure 7-316 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1393
Figure 7-317 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1393
Figure 7-318 Lift the edges of the tampers .................................................................................................................................. 1394
Figure 7-319 Remove the ejector unit ........................................................................................................................................... 1394
Figure 7-320 Reinstall the front tamper shaft .............................................................................................................................. 1395
Figure 7-321 Reinstall the rear tamper shaft ............................................................................................................................... 1395
Figure 7-322 Remove the rear tamper .......................................................................................................................................... 1396
Figure 7-323 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1398
Figure 7-324 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1399
Figure 7-325 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1399
Figure 7-326 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1400
Figure 7-327 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1400
Figure 7-328 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1401
Figure 7-329 Remove the feed entrance motor ........................................................................................................................... 1401
Figure 7-330 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1404
Figure 7-331 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1405
Figure 7-332 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1405
Figure 7-333 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1406
Figure 7-334 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1406
Figure 7-335 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1407
Figure 7-336 Remove the feed exit motor .................................................................................................................................... 1407
Figure 7-337 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1410
Figure 7-338 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1411
Figure 7-339 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1411
Figure 7-340 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1412
Figure 7-341 Remove the jam-access knob ................................................................................................................................. 1412
Figure 7-342 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1413
Figure 7-343 Remove five screws and the front cover ................................................................................................................ 1413
Figure 7-344 Disconnect two connectors and remove two screws .......................................................................................... 1414
Figure 7-345 Slide the gear off of the shaft .................................................................................................................................. 1414
Figure 7-346 Remove the sensor ................................................................................................................................................... 1415
Figure 7-347 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1415
Figure 7-348 Remove the buffer motor ......................................................................................................................................... 1416
ENWW ci
Figure 7-349 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1418
Figure 7-350 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1419
Figure 7-351 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1419
Figure 7-352 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1420
Figure 7-353 Lift the top hinge pin ................................................................................................................................................. 1420
Figure 7-354 Remove the top hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................ 1421
Figure 7-355 Release the lower hinge pin ..................................................................................................................................... 1421
Figure 7-356 Remove the lower hinge pin .................................................................................................................................... 1422
Figure 7-357 Remove one screw and the front door ................................................................................................................... 1422
Figure 7-358 Remove the jam-access knob ................................................................................................................................. 1423
Figure 7-359 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1423
Figure 7-360 Remove five screws and the front cover ................................................................................................................ 1424
Figure 7-361 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1424
Figure 7-362 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1425
Figure 7-363 Remove the booklet tray .......................................................................................................................................... 1425
Figure 7-364 Install the booklet tray .............................................................................................................................................. 1426
Figure 7-365 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1426
Figure 7-366 Remove the caster cover .......................................................................................................................................... 1427
Figure 7-367 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1427
Figure 7-368 Release the lower shield ........................................................................................................................................... 1428
Figure 7-369 Disconnect two connectors ...................................................................................................................................... 1428
Figure 7-370 Locate sensors ........................................................................................................................................................... 1429
Figure 7-371 Lower the output tray ............................................................................................................................................... 1429
Figure 7-372 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1430
Figure 7-373 Release the shield ...................................................................................................................................................... 1430
Figure 7-374 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1431
Figure 7-375 Locate sensors ........................................................................................................................................................... 1431
Figure 7-376 Move the staple unit to the center .......................................................................................................................... 1432
Figure 7-377 Disconnect three connectors ................................................................................................................................... 1432
Figure 7-378 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1433
Figure 7-379 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1433
Figure 7-380 Rotate the sensor ...................................................................................................................................................... 1434
Figure 7-381 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1434
Figure 7-382 Remove the front tamper shaft .............................................................................................................................. 1435
Figure 7-383 Disconnect two connectors and remove three screws ........................................................................................ 1435
Figure 7-384 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1436
Figure 7-385 Remove the rear tamper shaft ................................................................................................................................ 1436
Figure 7-386 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1437
Figure 7-387 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1437
Figure 7-388 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1438
Figure 7-389 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1438
cii ENWW
Figure 7-390 Lift the edges of the tampers .................................................................................................................................. 1439
Figure 7-391 Remove the ejector unit ........................................................................................................................................... 1439
Figure 7-392 Reinstall the front tamper shaft .............................................................................................................................. 1440
Figure 7-393 Reinstall the rear tamper shaft ............................................................................................................................... 1440
Figure 7-394 Remove the front tamper ......................................................................................................................................... 1441
Figure 7-395 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1441
Figure 7-396 Release the belt and remove the motor ................................................................................................................ 1442
Figure 7-397 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1444
Figure 7-398 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1445
Figure 7-399 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1445
Figure 7-400 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1446
Figure 7-401 Lift the top hinge pin ................................................................................................................................................. 1446
Figure 7-402 Remove the top hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................ 1447
Figure 7-403 Release the lower hinge pin ..................................................................................................................................... 1447
Figure 7-404 Remove the lower hinge pin .................................................................................................................................... 1448
Figure 7-405 Remove one screw and the front door ................................................................................................................... 1448
Figure 7-406 Remove the jam-access knob ................................................................................................................................. 1449
Figure 7-407 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1449
Figure 7-408 Remove five screws and the front cover ................................................................................................................ 1450
Figure 7-409 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1450
Figure 7-410 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1451
Figure 7-411 Remove the booklet tray .......................................................................................................................................... 1451
Figure 7-412 Install the booklet tray .............................................................................................................................................. 1452
Figure 7-413 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1452
Figure 7-414 Remove the caster cover .......................................................................................................................................... 1453
Figure 7-415 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1453
Figure 7-416 Release the lower shield ........................................................................................................................................... 1454
Figure 7-417 Disconnect two connectors ...................................................................................................................................... 1454
Figure 7-418 Locate sensors ........................................................................................................................................................... 1455
Figure 7-419 Lower the output tray ............................................................................................................................................... 1455
Figure 7-420 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1456
Figure 7-421 Release the shield ...................................................................................................................................................... 1456
Figure 7-422 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1457
Figure 7-423 Locate sensors ........................................................................................................................................................... 1457
Figure 7-424 Move the staple unit to the center .......................................................................................................................... 1458
Figure 7-425 Disconnect three connectors ................................................................................................................................... 1458
Figure 7-426 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1459
Figure 7-427 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1459
Figure 7-428 Rotate the sensor ...................................................................................................................................................... 1460
Figure 7-429 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1460
Figure 7-430 Remove the front tamper shaft .............................................................................................................................. 1461
ENWW ciii
Figure 7-431 Disconnect two connectors and remove three screws ........................................................................................ 1461
Figure 7-432 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1462
Figure 7-433 Remove the rear tamper shaft ................................................................................................................................ 1462
Figure 7-434 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1463
Figure 7-435 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1463
Figure 7-436 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1464
Figure 7-437 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1464
Figure 7-438 Lift the edges of the tampers .................................................................................................................................. 1465
Figure 7-439 Remove the ejector unit ........................................................................................................................................... 1465
Figure 7-440 Reinstall the front tamper shaft .............................................................................................................................. 1466
Figure 7-441 Reinstall the rear tamper shaft ............................................................................................................................... 1466
Figure 7-442 Remove the rear tamper .......................................................................................................................................... 1467
Figure 7-443 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1467
Figure 7-444 Release the belt and remove the motor ................................................................................................................ 1468
Figure 7-445 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1470
Figure 7-446 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1471
Figure 7-447 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1471
Figure 7-448 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1472
Figure 7-449 Lift the top hinge pin ................................................................................................................................................. 1472
Figure 7-450 Remove the top hinge pin ........................................................................................................................................ 1473
Figure 7-451 Release the lower hinge pin ..................................................................................................................................... 1473
Figure 7-452 Remove the lower hinge pin .................................................................................................................................... 1474
Figure 7-453 Remove one screw and the front door ................................................................................................................... 1474
Figure 7-454 Remove the jam-access knob ................................................................................................................................. 1475
Figure 7-455 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1475
Figure 7-456 Remove five screws and the front cover ................................................................................................................ 1476
Figure 7-457 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1476
Figure 7-458 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1477
Figure 7-459 Remove the booklet tray .......................................................................................................................................... 1477
Figure 7-460 Install the booklet tray .............................................................................................................................................. 1478
Figure 7-461 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1478
Figure 7-462 Remove the caster cover .......................................................................................................................................... 1479
Figure 7-463 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1479
Figure 7-464 Release the lower shield ........................................................................................................................................... 1480
Figure 7-465 Disconnect two connectors ...................................................................................................................................... 1480
Figure 7-466 Locate sensors ........................................................................................................................................................... 1481
Figure 7-467 Lower the output tray ............................................................................................................................................... 1481
Figure 7-468 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1482
Figure 7-469 Release the shield ...................................................................................................................................................... 1482
Figure 7-470 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1483
Figure 7-471 Locate sensors ........................................................................................................................................................... 1483
civ ENWW
Figure 7-472 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1484
Figure 7-473 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1484
Figure 7-474 Remove two screws and the motor ........................................................................................................................ 1485
Figure 7-475 Install the motor and bracket .................................................................................................................................. 1485
Figure 7-476 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1488
Figure 7-477 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1489
Figure 7-478 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1489
Figure 7-479 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1490
Figure 7-480 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1490
Figure 7-481 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1491
Figure 7-482 Lower the output tray ............................................................................................................................................... 1491
Figure 7-483 Open two retainers .................................................................................................................................................... 1492
Figure 7-484 Disconnect three connectors ................................................................................................................................... 1492
Figure 7-485 Disconnect one connector ........................................................................................................................................ 1493
Figure 7-486 Remove four screws and the motor assembly ..................................................................................................... 1493
Figure 7-487 Remove the motor assembly .................................................................................................................................. 1494
Figure 7-488 Remove the bushing ................................................................................................................................................. 1494
Figure 7-489 Install the bushing ..................................................................................................................................................... 1495
Figure 7-490 Install the motor assembly ...................................................................................................................................... 1495
Figure 7-491 Remove five screws and the cover ......................................................................................................................... 1498
Figure 7-492 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1501
Figure 7-493 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1502
Figure 7-494 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1502
Figure 7-495 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1503
Figure 7-496 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1503
Figure 7-497 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1504
Figure 7-498 Slide the booklet finisher away from the finisher ................................................................................................. 1504
Figure 7-499 Disconnect one connector and remove one screw .............................................................................................. 1505
Figure 7-500 Release the metal bracket ....................................................................................................................................... 1505
Figure 7-501 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1506
Figure 7-502 Slide the right rail ....................................................................................................................................................... 1506
Figure 7-503 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1507
Figure 7-504 Remove the booklet finisher .................................................................................................................................... 1507
Figure 7-505 Position the hooks ..................................................................................................................................................... 1508
Figure 7-506 Align arrows ................................................................................................................................................................ 1508
Figure 7-507 Align arrows ................................................................................................................................................................ 1509
Figure 7-508 Extend the right rail ................................................................................................................................................... 1509
Figure 7-509 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1512
Figure 7-510 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1513
Figure 7-511 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1513
Figure 7-512 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1514
ENWW cv
Figure 7-513 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1514
Figure 7-514 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1515
Figure 7-515 Slide the booklet finisher away from the finisher ................................................................................................. 1515
Figure 7-516 Disconnect one connector and remove one screw .............................................................................................. 1516
Figure 7-517 Release the metal bracket ....................................................................................................................................... 1516
Figure 7-518 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1517
Figure 7-519 Slide the right rail ....................................................................................................................................................... 1517
Figure 7-520 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1518
Figure 7-521 Remove the booklet finisher .................................................................................................................................... 1518
Figure 7-522 Position the hooks ..................................................................................................................................................... 1519
Figure 7-523 Align arrows ................................................................................................................................................................ 1519
Figure 7-524 Align arrows ................................................................................................................................................................ 1520
Figure 7-525 Extend the right rail ................................................................................................................................................... 1520
Figure 7-526 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1521
Figure 7-527 Remove one screw and the metal cover ................................................................................................................ 1521
Figure 7-528 Remove four screws and the PCA ........................................................................................................................... 1522
Figure 7-529 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1524
Figure 7-530 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1525
Figure 7-531 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1525
Figure 7-532 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1526
Figure 7-533 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1526
Figure 7-534 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1527
Figure 7-535 Remove five screws and the cover ......................................................................................................................... 1527
Figure 7-536 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1528
Figure 7-537 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1528
Figure 7-538 Remove the lower right shield ................................................................................................................................. 1529
Figure 7-539 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1529
Figure 7-540 Raise the jam access cover ....................................................................................................................................... 1530
Figure 7-541 Raise the booklet width guide ................................................................................................................................. 1530
Figure 7-542 Disconnect three connectors ................................................................................................................................... 1531
Figure 7-543 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1531
Figure 7-544 Release the guide arm .............................................................................................................................................. 1532
Figure 7-545 Lower the width guide .............................................................................................................................................. 1532
Figure 7-546 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1533
Figure 7-547 Remove the fold stopper unit .................................................................................................................................. 1533
Figure 7-548 Adjust the alignment gauge ..................................................................................................................................... 1534
Figure 7-549 Remove five screws and the cover ......................................................................................................................... 1536
Figure 7-550 Remove the booklet feed entrance motor ............................................................................................................ 1537
Figure 7-551 Remove five screws and the cover ......................................................................................................................... 1539
Figure 7-552 Remove the TE presser motor ................................................................................................................................. 1540
Figure 7-553 Remove five screws and the cover ......................................................................................................................... 1542
cvi ENWW
Figure 7-554 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1543
Figure 7-555 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1543
Figure 7-556 Remove the lower right shield ................................................................................................................................. 1544
Figure 7-557 Remove the stopper moving motor ....................................................................................................................... 1544
Figure 7-558 Remove five screws and the cover ......................................................................................................................... 1547
Figure 7-559 Remove the separate pawl motor .......................................................................................................................... 1548
Figure 7-560 Remove six screws and the right top cover ........................................................................................................... 1550
Figure 7-561 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1551
Figure 7-562 Remove six screws .................................................................................................................................................... 1551
Figure 7-563 Disconnect one connector and release retainer ................................................................................................... 1552
Figure 7-564 Remove seven screws .............................................................................................................................................. 1552
Figure 7-565 Remove four screws and the rear cover ................................................................................................................ 1553
Figure 7-566 Remove the folding roller motor ............................................................................................................................. 1553
Figure 7-567 Remove five screws and the cover ......................................................................................................................... 1556
Figure 7-568 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1557
Figure 7-569 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1557
Figure 7-570 Remove the lower right shield ................................................................................................................................. 1558
Figure 7-571 Remove the blade motor .......................................................................................................................................... 1558
Figure 7-572 Remove five screws and the cover ......................................................................................................................... 1561
Figure 7-573 Check arrow alignment ............................................................................................................................................. 1562
Figure 7-574 Disconnect two connectors ...................................................................................................................................... 1562
Figure 7-575 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1563
Figure 7-576 Remove one e-clip, gear, and belt .......................................................................................................................... 1563
Figure 7-577 Remove the bracket and motor .............................................................................................................................. 1564
Figure 7-578 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1564
Figure 7-579 Install one screw ........................................................................................................................................................ 1565
Figure 7-580 Check arrow alignment ............................................................................................................................................. 1565
Figure 7-581 Align arrows ................................................................................................................................................................ 1566
Figure 7-582 Finisher system diagram .......................................................................................................................................... 1569
Figure 8-1 Finisher system—sectional view ................................................................................................................................. 1581
Figure 8-2 Finisher system—paper path ....................................................................................................................................... 1582
Figure 8-3 Finisher system—electrical parts layout .................................................................................................................... 1583
Figure 8-4 Finisher system—block diagram ................................................................................................................................. 1585
Figure 8-5 Finisher system—PBA connection information ......................................................................................................... 1585
Figure 8-6 Remove the entrance sensor (1 of 7) .......................................................................................................................... 1591
Figure 8-7 Remove the entrance sensor (2 of 7) .......................................................................................................................... 1591
Figure 8-8 Remove the entrance sensor (3 of 7) .......................................................................................................................... 1592
Figure 8-9 Remove the entrance sensor (4 of 7) .......................................................................................................................... 1592
Figure 8-10 Remove the entrance sensor (5 of 7) ....................................................................................................................... 1593
Figure 8-11 Remove the entrance sensor (6 of 7) ....................................................................................................................... 1593
Figure 8-12 Remove the entrance sensor (7 of 7) ....................................................................................................................... 1593
ENWW cvii
Figure 8-13 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1595
Figure 8-14 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1595
Figure 8-15 Remove the entrance motor (3 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1596
Figure 8-16 Remove the entrance motor (4 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1596
Figure 8-17 Remove the entrance motor (5 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1597
Figure 8-18 Remove the entrance motor (5 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1598
Figure 8-19 Remove the entrance motor (6 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1598
Figure 8-20 Remove the entrance motor (7 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1599
Figure 8-21 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1601
Figure 8-22 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1601
Figure 8-23 Remove the entrance motor (3 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1602
Figure 8-24 Remove the entrance motor (4 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1602
Figure 8-25 Remove the entrance motor (5 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1603
Figure 8-26 Remove the exit sensor .............................................................................................................................................. 1604
Figure 8-27 Remove the exit motor (1 of 3) .................................................................................................................................. 1606
Figure 8-28 Remove the exit motor (2 of 3) .................................................................................................................................. 1606
Figure 8-29 Remove the exit motor (3 of 3) .................................................................................................................................. 1607
Figure 8-30 Remove the sub paddle shaft sub-assembly (1 of 6) ............................................................................................ 1609
Figure 8-31 Remove the sub paddle shaft sub-assembly (2 of 6) ............................................................................................ 1609
Figure 8-32 Remove the Sub Paddle Shaft Sub assembly (3 of 6) ............................................................................................ 1610
Figure 8-33 Remove the sub paddle shaft sub assembly (4 of 6) ............................................................................................. 1610
Figure 8-34 Remove the sub paddle shaft sub assembly (5 of 6) ............................................................................................. 1611
Figure 8-35 Remove the front jogger motor (1 of 22) ................................................................................................................. 1613
Figure 8-36 Remove the front jogger motor (2 of 22) ................................................................................................................. 1613
Figure 8-37 Remove the front jogger motor (3 of 22) ................................................................................................................. 1614
Figure 8-38 Remove the front jogger motor (4 of 22) ................................................................................................................. 1614
Figure 8-39 Remove the front jogger motor (5 of 22) ................................................................................................................. 1615
Figure 8-40 Remove the front jogger motor (6 of 22) ................................................................................................................. 1615
Figure 8-41 Remove the front jogger motor (7 of 22) ................................................................................................................. 1616
Figure 8-42 Remove the front jogger motor (8 of 22) ................................................................................................................. 1616
Figure 8-43 Remove the front jogger motor (9 of 22) ................................................................................................................. 1617
Figure 8-44 Remove the front jogger motor (10 of 22) .............................................................................................................. 1617
Figure 8-45 Remove the front jogger motor (11 of 22) .............................................................................................................. 1618
Figure 8-46 Remove the front jogger motor (12 of 22) .............................................................................................................. 1618
Figure 8-47 Remove the front jogger motor (13 of 22) .............................................................................................................. 1619
Figure 8-48 Remove the front jogger motor (14 of 22) .............................................................................................................. 1619
Figure 8-49 Remove the front jogger motor (15 of 22) .............................................................................................................. 1620
Figure 8-50 Remove the front jogger motor (16 of 22) .............................................................................................................. 1620
Figure 8-51 Remove the front jogger motor (17 of 22) .............................................................................................................. 1621
Figure 8-52 Remove the front jogger motor (18 of 22) .............................................................................................................. 1621
Figure 8-53 Remove the front jogger motor (19 of 22) .............................................................................................................. 1622
cviii ENWW
Figure 8-54 Remove the front jogger motor (20 of 22) .............................................................................................................. 1622
Figure 8-55 Remove the front jogger motor (21 of 22) .............................................................................................................. 1623
Figure 8-56 Remove the front jogger motor (22 of 22) .............................................................................................................. 1623
Figure 8-57 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1625
Figure 8-58 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1625
Figure 8-59 Remove the front jogger home sensor (1 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1626
Figure 8-60 Remove the front jogger home sensor (2 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1626
Figure 8-61 Remove the front jogger home sensor (3 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1627
Figure 8-62 Remove the front jogger home sensor (4 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1627
Figure 8-63 Remove the front jogger home sensor (5 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1628
Figure 8-64 Remove the front jogger home sensor (6 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1628
Figure 8-65 Remove the front jogger home sensor (7 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1629
Figure 8-66 Remove the front jogger home sensor (8 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1629
Figure 8-67 Remove the front jogger home sensor (9 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1630
Figure 8-68 Remove the sub paddle shaft sub assembly (1 of 6) ............................................................................................. 1630
Figure 8-69 Remove the sub paddle shaft sub assembly (2 of 6) ............................................................................................. 1631
Figure 8-70 Remove the sub paddle shaft sub assembly (3 of 6) ............................................................................................. 1631
Figure 8-71 Remove the sub paddle shaft sub assembly (4 of 6) ............................................................................................. 1632
Figure 8-72 Remove the sub paddle shaft sub assembly (5 of 6) ............................................................................................. 1632
Figure 8-73 Remove the front jogger home sensor (10 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1633
Figure 8-74 Remove the front jogger home sensor (11 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1633
Figure 8-75 Remove the front jogger home sensor (12 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1634
Figure 8-76 Remove the front jogger home sensor (13 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1634
Figure 8-77 Remove the front jogger home sensor .................................................................................................................... 1635
Figure 8-78 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1637
Figure 8-79 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ........................................................................................................................ 1637
Figure 8-80 Remove the front jogger home sensor (1 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1638
Figure 8-81 Remove the front jogger home sensor (2 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1638
Figure 8-82 Remove the front jogger home sensor (3 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1639
Figure 8-83 Remove the front jogger home sensor (4 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1639
Figure 8-84 Remove the front jogger home sensor (5 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1640
Figure 8-85 Remove the front jogger home sensor (6 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1640
Figure 8-86 Remove the front jogger home sensor (9 of 15) .................................................................................................... 1641
Figure 8-87 Remove the rear jogger motor (1 of 3) ..................................................................................................................... 1641
Figure 8-88 Remove the rear jogger motor (2 of 3) ..................................................................................................................... 1642
Figure 8-89 Remove the rear jogger motor (3 of 3) ..................................................................................................................... 1642
Figure 8-90 Remove the rear jogger motor (1 of 3) ..................................................................................................................... 1643
Figure 8-91 Remove the rear jogger motor (2 of 3) ..................................................................................................................... 1643
Figure 8-92 Remove the rear jogger motor (3 of 3) ..................................................................................................................... 1644
Figure 8-93 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 11) ...................................................................................................................... 1646
Figure 8-94 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 11) ...................................................................................................................... 1646
ENWW cix
Figure 8-95 Remove the front jogger home sensor (3 of 11) .................................................................................................... 1647
Figure 8-96 Remove the front jogger home sensor (4 of 11) .................................................................................................... 1647
Figure 8-97 Remove the front jogger home sensor (5 of 11) .................................................................................................... 1648
Figure 8-98 Remove the front jogger home sensor (6 of 11) .................................................................................................... 1648
Figure 8-99 Remove the front jogger home sensor (8 of 11) .................................................................................................... 1649
Figure 8-100 Remove the front jogger home sensor (9 of 11) .................................................................................................. 1649
Figure 8-101 Remove the front jogger home sensor (10 of 11) ............................................................................................... 1650
Figure 8-102 Remove the rear jogger home sensor (11 of 11) ................................................................................................. 1650
Figure 8-103 Remove the exit motor (1 of 3) ............................................................................................................................... 1652
Figure 8-104 Remove the exit motor (2 of 3) ............................................................................................................................... 1652
Figure 8-105 Remove the stapler (1 of 2) ..................................................................................................................................... 1653
Figure 8-106 Remove the stapler (2 of 2) ..................................................................................................................................... 1653
Figure 8-107 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1655
Figure 8-108 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1655
Figure 8-109 Remove the entrance motor (3 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1656
Figure 8-110 Remove the entrance motor (4 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1656
Figure 8-111 Remove the entrance motor (5 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1657
Figure 8-112 Remove the sub paddle shaft sub-assembly (1 of 6) ......................................................................................... 1658
Figure 8-113 Remove the sub paddle shaft sub-assembly (2 of 6) ......................................................................................... 1658
Figure 8-114 Remove the Sub Paddle Shaft Sub assembly (3 of 6) ......................................................................................... 1659
Figure 8-115 Remove the sub paddle shaft sub assembly (4 of 6) .......................................................................................... 1659
Figure 8-116 Remove the sub paddle shaft sub assembly (5 of 6) .......................................................................................... 1660
Figure 8-117 Remove the stapler position sensor (1 of 7) ......................................................................................................... 1661
Figure 8-118 Remove the stapler position sensor (2 of 7) ......................................................................................................... 1661
Figure 8-119 Remove the stapler position sensor (3 of 7) ......................................................................................................... 1662
Figure 8-120 Remove the stapler position sensor (4 of 7) ......................................................................................................... 1662
Figure 8-121 Remove the stapler position sensor (5 of 7) ......................................................................................................... 1663
Figure 8-122 Remove the stapler position sensor (6 of 7) ......................................................................................................... 1663
Figure 8-123 Remove the stapler position sensor (7 of 7) ......................................................................................................... 1664
Figure 8-124 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1666
Figure 8-125 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1666
Figure 8-126 Remove the entrance motor (3 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1667
Figure 8-127 Remove the entrance motor (4 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1667
Figure 8-128 Remove the entrance motor (5 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1668
Figure 8-129 Remove the traverse motor (1 of 2) ....................................................................................................................... 1669
Figure 8-130 Remove the traverse motor (2 of 2) ....................................................................................................................... 1669
Figure 8-131 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1671
Figure 8-132 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1671
Figure 8-133 Remove the front jogger home sensor (1 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1672
Figure 8-134 Remove the front jogger home sensor (2 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1672
Figure 8-135 Remove the front jogger home sensor (3 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1673
cx ENWW
Figure 8-136 Remove the front jogger home sensor (4 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1673
Figure 8-137 Remove the front jogger home sensor (5 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1674
Figure 8-138 Remove the front jogger home sensor (6 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1674
Figure 8-139 Remove the front jogger home sensor (7 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1675
Figure 8-140 Remove the front jogger home sensor (8 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1675
Figure 8-141 Remove the stacker motor ...................................................................................................................................... 1676
Figure 8-142 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1678
Figure 8-143 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1678
Figure 8-144 Remove the front jogger home sensor (1 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1679
Figure 8-145 Remove the front jogger home sensor (2 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1679
Figure 8-146 Remove the front jogger home sensor (3 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1680
Figure 8-147 Remove the front jogger home sensor (4 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1680
Figure 8-148 Remove the front jogger home sensor (5 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1681
Figure 8-149 Remove the front jogger home sensor (6 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1681
Figure 8-150 Remove the front jogger home sensor (7 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1682
Figure 8-151 Remove the front jogger home sensor (8 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1682
Figure 8-152 Remove the stacker encoder sensor ...................................................................................................................... 1683
Figure 8-153 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1685
Figure 8-154 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1685
Figure 8-155 Remove the front jogger home sensor (1 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1686
Figure 8-156 Remove the front jogger home sensor (2 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1686
Figure 8-157 Remove the front jogger home sensor (3 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1687
Figure 8-158 Remove the front jogger home sensor (4 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1687
Figure 8-159 Remove the front jogger home sensor (5 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1688
Figure 8-160 Remove the front jogger home sensor (6 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1688
Figure 8-161 Remove the front jogger home sensor (7 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1689
Figure 8-162 Remove the front jogger home sensor (8 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1689
Figure 8-163 Remove the stacker lower limit switch (1 of 2) .................................................................................................... 1690
Figure 8-164 Remove the stacker lower limit switch (2 of 2) .................................................................................................... 1690
Figure 8-165 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1692
Figure 8-166 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1692
Figure 8-167 Remove the front jogger home sensor (1 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1693
Figure 8-168 Remove the front jogger home sensor (2 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1693
Figure 8-169 Remove the front jogger home sensor (3 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1694
Figure 8-170 Remove the front jogger home sensor (4 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1694
Figure 8-171 Remove the stack beam sensor .............................................................................................................................. 1695
Figure 8-172 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1697
Figure 8-173 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1697
Figure 8-174 Remove the entrance motor (3 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1698
Figure 8-175 Remove the entrance motor (4 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1698
Figure 8-176 Remove the entrance motor (5 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1699
ENWW cxi
Figure 8-177 Remove the tray ......................................................................................................................................................... 1700
Figure 8-178 Remove the sub-tray ................................................................................................................................................ 1700
Figure 8-179 Remove the PBA ........................................................................................................................................................ 1701
Figure 8-180 Remove the PBA ........................................................................................................................................................ 1701
Figure 8-181 Remove the sub-stacker plate ................................................................................................................................ 1702
Figure 8-182 Remove the main paddle home sensor sub assembly ....................................................................................... 1702
Figure 8-183 Release the motor paddle sub assembly .............................................................................................................. 1703
Figure 8-184 Remove the guide harness front ............................................................................................................................. 1703
Figure 8-185 Release the finisher sub-motor tray ....................................................................................................................... 1704
Figure 8-186 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1704
Figure 8-187 Release the sensor .................................................................................................................................................... 1705
Figure 8-188 Remove the sensor ................................................................................................................................................... 1705
Figure 8-189 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1707
Figure 8-190 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1707
Figure 8-191 Remove the front jogger home sensor (1 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1708
Figure 8-192 Remove the front jogger home sensor (2 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1708
Figure 8-193 Remove the front jogger home sensor (3 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1709
Figure 8-194 Remove the front jogger home sensor (4 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1709
Figure 8-195 Remove the front jogger home sensor (5 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1710
Figure 8-196 Remove the front jogger home sensor (6 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1710
Figure 8-197 Remove the front jogger home sensor (7 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1711
Figure 8-198 Remove the front jogger home sensor (8 of 15) .................................................................................................. 1711
Figure 8-199 Remove the paper holding lever solenoid (1 of 4) ............................................................................................... 1712
Figure 8-200 Remove the paper holding lever solenoid (1 of 4) ............................................................................................... 1712
Figure 8-201 Remove the paper holding lever solenoid (1 of 4) ............................................................................................... 1713
Figure 8-202 Remove the paper holding lever solenoid (1 of 4) ............................................................................................... 1713
Figure 8-203 Remove the tray ......................................................................................................................................................... 1715
Figure 8-204 Remove the sub-tray ................................................................................................................................................ 1715
Figure 8-205 Remove the PBA ........................................................................................................................................................ 1716
Figure 8-206 Remove the PBA ........................................................................................................................................................ 1716
Figure 8-207 Remove the sub-stacker plate ................................................................................................................................ 1717
Figure 8-208 Remove the main paddle home sensor sub assembly ....................................................................................... 1717
Figure 8-209 Release the motor paddle sub assembly .............................................................................................................. 1718
Figure 8-210 Remove the guide harness front ............................................................................................................................. 1718
Figure 8-211 Release the finisher sub-motor tray ....................................................................................................................... 1719
Figure 8-212 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1719
Figure 8-213 Release the sensor .................................................................................................................................................... 1720
Figure 8-214 Remove the sensor ................................................................................................................................................... 1720
Figure 8-215 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1724
Figure 8-216 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1724
Figure 8-217 Remove the entrance motor (3 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1725
cxii ENWW
Figure 8-218 Remove the entrance motor (4 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1725
Figure 8-219 Remove the entrance motor (5 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1726
Figure 8-220 Remove the tray ......................................................................................................................................................... 1727
Figure 8-221 Remove the sub-tray ................................................................................................................................................ 1727
Figure 8-222 Remove the PBA ........................................................................................................................................................ 1728
Figure 8-223 Remove the PBA ........................................................................................................................................................ 1728
Figure 8-224 Remove the sub-stacker plate ................................................................................................................................ 1729
Figure 8-225 Remove the main paddle home sensor sub assembly ....................................................................................... 1729
Figure 8-226 Release the motor paddle sub assembly .............................................................................................................. 1730
Figure 8-227 Remove the guide harness front ............................................................................................................................. 1730
Figure 8-228 Release the finisher sub-motor tray ....................................................................................................................... 1731
Figure 8-229 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1731
Figure 8-230 Release the sensor .................................................................................................................................................... 1732
Figure 8-231 Remove the sensor ................................................................................................................................................... 1732
Figure 8-232 Remove the paper support home sensor (1 of 4) ................................................................................................ 1733
Figure 8-233 Remove the paper support home sensor (2 of 4) ................................................................................................ 1733
Figure 8-234 Remove the paper support home sensor (3 of 4) ................................................................................................ 1734
Figure 8-235 Remove the paper support home sensor (4 of 4) ................................................................................................ 1734
Figure 8-236 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1736
Figure 8-237 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1736
Figure 8-238 Remove the entrance motor (3 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1737
Figure 8-239 Remove the entrance motor (4 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1737
Figure 8-240 Remove the entrance motor (5 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1738
Figure 8-241 Remove the tray ......................................................................................................................................................... 1739
Figure 8-242 Remove the sub-tray ................................................................................................................................................ 1739
Figure 8-243 Remove the PBA ........................................................................................................................................................ 1740
Figure 8-244 Remove the PBA ........................................................................................................................................................ 1740
Figure 8-245 Remove the sub-stacker plate ................................................................................................................................ 1741
Figure 8-246 Remove the main paddle home sensor sub assembly ....................................................................................... 1741
Figure 8-247 Release the motor paddle sub assembly .............................................................................................................. 1742
Figure 8-248 Remove the guide harness front ............................................................................................................................. 1742
Figure 8-249 Release the finisher sub-motor tray ....................................................................................................................... 1743
Figure 8-250 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1743
Figure 8-251 Release the sensor .................................................................................................................................................... 1744
Figure 8-252 Remove the sensor ................................................................................................................................................... 1744
Figure 8-253 Remove the paper support home sensor (1 of 4) ................................................................................................ 1745
Figure 8-254 Remove the paper support home sensor (2 of 4) ................................................................................................ 1745
Figure 8-255 Remove the ejector motor assembly (1 of 6) ....................................................................................................... 1746
Figure 8-256 Remove the ejector motor assembly (2 of 6) ....................................................................................................... 1746
Figure 8-257 Remove two belt-timing gears ................................................................................................................................ 1747
Figure 8-258 Remove the belt-timing gear and one screw ........................................................................................................ 1747
ENWW cxiii
Figure 8-259 Disconnect connectors .............................................................................................................................................. 1748
Figure 8-260 Remove the motor assembly .................................................................................................................................. 1748
Figure 8-261 Remove the motor assembly .................................................................................................................................. 1750
Figure 8-262 Remove the main paddle motor ............................................................................................................................. 1750
Figure 8-263 Remove the bracket-paddle sensor ....................................................................................................................... 1752
Figure 8-264 Remove the main paddle home sensor ................................................................................................................. 1752
Figure 8-265 Remove the main paddle ......................................................................................................................................... 1754
Figure 8-266 Remove the tray ......................................................................................................................................................... 1756
Figure 8-267 Remove the sub-tray ................................................................................................................................................ 1756
Figure 8-268 Remove the PBA ........................................................................................................................................................ 1757
Figure 8-269 Remove the PBA ........................................................................................................................................................ 1757
Figure 8-270 Remove the sub-stacker plate ................................................................................................................................ 1758
Figure 8-271 Remove the main paddle home sensor sub assembly ....................................................................................... 1758
Figure 8-272 Release the motor paddle sub assembly .............................................................................................................. 1759
Figure 8-273 Remove the guide harness front ............................................................................................................................. 1759
Figure 8-274 Release the finisher sub-motor tray ....................................................................................................................... 1760
Figure 8-275 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1760
Figure 8-276 Release the sensor .................................................................................................................................................... 1761
Figure 8-277 Remove the sensor ................................................................................................................................................... 1761
Figure 8-278 Remove the paper support home sensor (1 of 4) ................................................................................................ 1762
Figure 8-279 Remove the paper support home sensor (2 of 4) ................................................................................................ 1762
Figure 8-280 Remove the ejector motor assembly (1 of 6) ....................................................................................................... 1763
Figure 8-281 Remove the ejector motor assembly (2 of 6) ....................................................................................................... 1763
Figure 8-282 Remove two belt-timing gears ................................................................................................................................ 1764
Figure 8-283 Remove the belt-timing gear and one screw ........................................................................................................ 1764
Figure 8-284 Disconnect connectors .............................................................................................................................................. 1765
Figure 8-285 Remove the motor assembly .................................................................................................................................. 1765
Figure 8-286 Remove two screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1766
Figure 8-287 Remove the ejector assembly ................................................................................................................................. 1766
Figure 8-288 Remove the entrance motor (1 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1768
Figure 8-289 Remove the entrance motor (2 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1768
Figure 8-290 Remove the entrance motor (3 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1769
Figure 8-291 Remove the entrance motor (4 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1769
Figure 8-292 Remove the entrance motor (5 of 7) ...................................................................................................................... 1770
Figure 8-293 Remove the punch dust full sensor sub-assembly ............................................................................................. 1771
Figure 8-294 Remove the punch dust full sensor ........................................................................................................................ 1771
Figure 8-295 Remove three screws ............................................................................................................................................... 1773
Figure 8-296 Remove the e-ring ..................................................................................................................................................... 1773
Figure 8-297 Remove the sheet-punch front ............................................................................................................................... 1774
Figure 8-298 Remove the punch dummy ...................................................................................................................................... 1774
Figure 8-299 Remove the bracket-SPT B ...................................................................................................................................... 1775
cxiv ENWW
Figure 8-300 Remove the door switch ........................................................................................................................................... 1775
Figure 8-301 Remove the cover-rear ............................................................................................................................................. 1777
Figure 8-302 Remove the finisher sub-cover middle and finisher sub-cover compile .......................................................... 1777
Figure 8-303 Remove the tray ......................................................................................................................................................... 1778
Figure 8-304 Remove the finisher sub-tray frame ...................................................................................................................... 1778
Figure 8-305 Remove the PBA cover .............................................................................................................................................. 1779
Figure 8-306 Remove four screws .................................................................................................................................................. 1779
Figure 8-307 Remove one screw .................................................................................................................................................... 1780
Figure 8-308 Remove the switch assembly .................................................................................................................................. 1780
Figure 8-309 Remove the sensor ................................................................................................................................................... 1780
Figure 8-310 Remove the end fence home sensor ..................................................................................................................... 1782
ENWW cxv
cxvi ENWW
1 Precautions
Please read the precautions listed below and follow them closely in order to prevent accidents or damage to the
printer.
● Safety warning
● ESD precautions
ENWW 1
Safety warning
1. Service should be performed by a factory trained service technician.
This printer contains high voltages and lasers which are dangerous. This printer should only be serviced by
a factory trained service technician.
There are no customer serviceable parts inside the printer. Do not make any unauthorized changes or
additions to the printer as these could cause the printer to malfunction and create an electric shock or fire
hazard.
The printer is certified in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR, chapter 1 Subchapter J
for Class I(1) laser products, and elsewhere is certified as a Class I laser product conforming to the
requirements of IEC 60825-1. Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The laser system
and printer are designed so that there is never human access to laser radiation above a Class I level during
normal operation, user maintenance or a prescribed service condition.
– Wavelength: 800 nm
– Beam divergence
○ Parallel: 11 degrees
○ Perpendicular: 35 degrees
WARNING! Do not operate or service the printer when the protective cover is removed from the laser/
scanner assembly. The reflected laser, although invisible, can cause eye damage.
Following these safety precautions will reduce the risk of fire, electric shock, and personal injury.
● Keep the imaging unit and toner cartridge away from children. The toner powder in the imaging unit and
the toner cartridge might be harmful. If the toner powder is swallowed, contact a doctor.
1. Use the correct voltage. Failure to do so could damage the printer and cause fire or electric shock.
2. Use the power cable supplied with the printer. Use of an incorrectly specified cable could cause overheating
and fire.
3. Do not overload the power socket. This could lead to overheating of the cables inside the wall and cause
fire.
4. Keep water and other liquids, paper clips, pins, and other foreign objects away from the printer. Contact
with liquids or these objects might cause electric shock or fire.
5. Do not touch the plugs on the ends of the power cable with wet hands. When servicing the printer, remove
the power plug from the wall socket.
8. Make sure that the power outlet and plugs are not cracked or broken. Repair these defects as soon as
possible. Be careful to not cut or damage the power cable or plugs when moving the printer.
9. Use caution during thunder or lightning storms. HP recommends the printer be disconnected from the
power source when thunder or lightning is expected. Do not touch the machine or the power cable if it is
still connected to the power outlet during these weather conditions.
10. Do not place the printer in damp or dusty areas. Install the printer in a clean, well-ventilated location. Do
not position the machine near a humidifier or in front of an air conditioner. Moisture and dust build up inside
the printer can lead to overheating and cause fire or rust.
11. Do not place the printer in direct sunlight. Direct sunlight can cause the temperature inside the printer to
rise causing failure to work properly, and in extreme conditions, might lead to fire.
12. Do not insert metal objects into the printer through the ventilator fan or other parts of the casing. Doing so
could lead to the metal object making contact with the high voltage conductor inside the printer, causing
electric shock.
13. Wait 5 minutes after unplugging the power cable before replacing the SMPS board to avoid electric shock.
1. Make sure the printer is placed on a level surface capable of supporting the weight of the printer. Failure to
do so could cause the printer to tip or fall.
2. The printer contains rollers, gears, and fans. Make sure to not catch fingers, hair, or clothing in any these
rotating devices.
3. Do not place any small metal objects, or containers of water, chemicals, or other liquids close to the printer.
If spilled, these objects or liquids could get into the printer and cause damage, or cause electric shock or
fire.
4. Do not place the printer in damp or dusty areas, near an open window, or close to a humidifier or heater.
These conditions can cause damage to the printer.
5. Do place candles or burning cigarettes on the printer. Doing so could cause fire.
6. Make sure that the printer is installed and operated in an area that meets temperature and humidity
specifications.
– The printer cannot be used immediately after being stored at below zero Celsius for long periods of
time. Doing so could cause malfunction. Place the printer in an area where it can reach room
temperature before operation.
2. Make sure that the power cable is disconnected before servicing or replacing any electrical parts.
4. Use approved replacement parts. Make sure that the part number, printer name, voltage, and current or
temperature ratings are correct.
5. Do not excessive force to remove or refit parts, especially when fitting screws into plastic.
6. Make sure not to drop any small parts into the printer.
– The OPC Drum can be permanently damaged if exposed to light. Be careful not to expose the OPC
Drum to direct sunlight, fluorescent light, or incandescent room lighting. Exposure for as little as 5
minutes can damage the surface of the photoconductive properties and will result in print quality
degradation. Be careful when servicing the printer. Remove the OPC Drum and store it in a black bag
or other lightproof container. Be careful when working with the printer if the covers, especially the top
cover, are open, as light is admitted to the OPC area and can damage the OPC Drum.
– Make sure not to scratch the green surface of the OPC Drum Unit. If the green surface of the Drum
Cartridge is scratched or touched, the print quality will be compromised.
To avoid injury, do not put fingers, hair, or clothes near moving parts such as the paper feeding entrance,
motor, and fan.
The printer is heavy. To avoid injury, use the lifting handles located on each side of the printer and lift
carefully.
Make sure the printer is placed on a level surface that is capable of supporting the weight of the printer.
Failure to do so could cause the printer to tip or fall, possibly causing personal injury or damage to the
printer.
5. Do not install the printer on a sloping or unstable surface. After installation, make sure that the printer is
stable.
Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
● Product overview
● Specifications
● Feeding system
● Fuser unit
● Image creation
● Drive system
● Hardware configuration
ENWW 9
Product overview
● Printing speed
– E82540
○ Up to 40 ppm in A4/Letter
○ Up to 21 ppm in A3
– E82550
○ Up to 50 ppm in A4/Letter
○ Up to 26 ppm in A3
– E82560
○ Up to 60 ppm in A4/Letter
○ Up to 31 ppm in A3
● Processor
● Memory
– 7 GB (3 GB Formatter + 4 GB)
● ADF
– Flow ADF
● Control panel
LED 2 (Power/Status)
Key/Button 1 (Power)
ENWW Specifications 11
Table 2-1 General specifications (continued)
Item Specification
● E82560
Duplex
● E82540, E82550
● E82560
● E82550, E82560
Duplex
● E82540
● E82550
● E82560
Item Specification
Print specifications
Table 2-2 Print specifications
Item Specification
● E82550
● E82560
ENWW Specifications 13
Table 2-2 Print specifications (continued)
Item Specification
● E82550
● E82560
Item Specification
● Secure print
● Stored print
● Booklet
● N-up
● Cover page
● Barcode
● Eco
● Poster
● Glossy
● Watermark
● Tray protection
● USB print
ENWW Specifications 15
Scan specifications
Table 2-3 Scan specifications
Item Specification
● Searchable PDF
● Compact PDF
● PDF Encryption
● PDF/A
● Single-Page PDF
● Multi-page PDF
● TIFF
● Single-Page TIFF
● Multi-page TIFF
● XPS
● Single-Page XPS
● Multi-page XPS
● JPEG
Item Specification
● FTP
● SMB
● HDD
● USB
● WSD
● PC
● Internet FAX
Multi-destinations Yes
● WSD
● T4Net
Copy specifications
Table 2-4 Copy specifications
Item Specification
– Up to 40 cpm in A4
● E82550
– Up to 50 cpm in A4
● E82560
– Up to 60 cpm in A4
ENWW Specifications 17
Table 2-4 Copy specifications (continued)
Item Specification
– Simplex to Simplex: Up to 40
cpm in A4/Letter
● E82550
– Simplex to Simplex: Up to 50
cpm in A4/Letter
● E82560
– Simplex to Simplex: Up to 60
cpm in A4/Letter
● E82550: 3.7 s
● E82560: 3.1 s
Item Specification
● Newspaper
● Printed Photo
● Glossy Photo
● Copied Original
● Map
● Light Original
● N-up
● Booklet
● Image Repeat
● Auto Fit
● Book Copy
● Poster Copy
● Watermark
● Image Overlay
● Stamp
● Covers
● Job Build
● Preview
● Erase Edge
● Image Shift
● Image Adjustment
● Background Adjustment
Supplies
Table 2-5 Supplies
Item Part number Average yield Conditions for yield
ENWW Specifications 19
Table 2-5 Supplies (continued)
NOTE: Depending on the print pattern and job mode used, the lifespan of the consumable can vary.
Maintenance parts
Some of the printer parts have a shorter lifespan than the life of the printer.
HP recommends replacing the following maintenance parts at specific intervals to make sure the printer
produces quality copies and to extend the service life of the printer.
SAM-JC91-01195A 110 V
NOTE:
● Depending on the print patterns and job mode used, the lifespan can differ.
● C: Clean
● R: Replace
NOTE: The total pages at the top of the table represents the lifespan for each maintenance part.
Waste Waste C R
Toner Toner
Container
Around C
Waste
Toner
Container
Imaging Toner C R
Unit Cartridge
Drum C R
Unit
Develope C R
r Unit
Around C
Toner
Pipe
Paper C
Dust
Stick
Transfer Paper C R
Unit Transfer
Belt
(PTB)
Paper Pickup/ C R
Path Feed/
Reverse
(Separati
on) Roller
(for Tray
2-X)*
MP C R
Pickup/
Feed/
Reverse
(Separati
on) roller*
ENWW Specifications 21
Table 2-6 Maintenance table (continued)
Section Item EM 45K 50K 100K 200K 300K 360K 450K 1200K
Registrati C
on
assembly
/Feed/
Duplex
Roller
Flow ADF C R
reverse
(separati
on) roller
assembly
White C
sheet/
White
sponge/
Feed
roller
* Replace those three parts at the same time.
Item Specification
● Thin
● Bond
● Hole Punched
● Pre-Printed
● Recycled
● Thin Cardstock
● Thick Cardstock
● Heavy Cardstock
● Letterhead
● Thick
● Cotton
● Colored
● Archive
● Thin Glossy
● Thick Glossy
● Heavy Glossy
● Heavy Weight
● Label
● Transparency
ENWW Specifications 23
Table 2-7 Paper handling specifications (continued)
Item Specification
Item Specification
● Thin
● Bond
● Hole Punched
● Pre-Printed
● Recycled
● Thin Cardstock
● Letterhead
● Thick
● Cotton
● Colored
● Archive
● Thin Glossy
● Thick Glossy
● Heavy Glossy
● Heavy Weight
● Envelope
● Transparency
● Label
ENWW Specifications 25
Table 2-7 Paper handling specifications (continued)
Item Specification
Maximum Printing Area Simplex Top: 4.2 +/- 1.5 mm / Left: 4.2 +/- 1.5 mm
Item Specification
● Thin
● Bond
● Hole Punched
● Pre-Printed
● Recycled
● Thin Cardstock
● Letterhead
● Thick
● Cotton
● Colored
● Archive
● Thin Glossy
● Thick Glossy
● Heavy Glossy
● Heavy Weight
ENWW Specifications 27
Network and software specifications
Network interface
Table 2-8 Network interface
Item Specifications
Network OS Windows
● XP (32/64 bit)
● Windows 7
● Windows 8
Mac
● Mac OS 10.5 –10.8
Linux
● RedHat 8–9
● Mandrake 9.2–10.1
● SuSE 8.2–9.2
Novell
● Netware 5.x, 6.x (TCP/IP Only)
Others
● Unix (HP-UX, Solaris, SumOS, SCO)
IPX/SPX No
Ether Talk No
Auto IP Yes
BOOTP Yes
DHCP Yes
Item Specifications
LPR/LPD Yes
IPP Yes
Netware I-Print No
Netware NDPS No
Ether Talk No
SLP Yes
ENWW Specifications 29
Table 2-9 Software and solutions (continued)
Item Specifications
Airprint Yes
IP Sec Yes
ENWW Specifications 31
Options list
Table 2-10 Options list
Fax Kit
HP LaserJet Paper Tray Heaters Department Y1G22A For dual cassette feeder (DCF)
Wireless/NFC Kit
Wireless/NFC/BLE Kit
HP LaserJet Inner Finisher Hole 2/3 Punch Y1G02A Two and three hole punch (for America,
Asia, and Africa)
HP LaserJet Inner Finisher Hole 2/4 Punch Y1G03A Two and four hole punch (for Europe)
HP LaserJet Inner Finisher Swedish Punch Y1G04A Swedish four hole punch (for Sweden)
HP LaserJet Hole Punch 2/3 Accessory Y1G10A Two and three hole punch (for America,
Asia, and Africa)
HP LaserJet Hole Punch 2/4 Accessory Y1G11A Two and four hole punch (for Europe)
HP LaserJet Hole Punch Swedish Accessory Y1G12A Swedish four hole punch (for Sweden)
HP LaserJet Inner/Booklet Finisher Staples Y1G13A ● Regular staples for the HP LaserJet
Inner Finisher
NOTE: The HP LaserJet Booklet Finisher
and HP LaserJet Stapler/Stacker Finisher ● Regular saddle staples for the HP
have two staple slots. LaserJet Booklet Finisher
ENWW Specifications 33
Table 2-11 Option specifications (continued)
Item Specification
Weight (Net) 18 kg
Item Specification
ENWW Specifications 35
Table 2-11 Option specifications (continued)
Item Specification
3. HP LaserJet Inner Finisher Swedish Available Unit Auto change 2/3 hole or auto change 2/4
Punch hole, Swedish 4
12
13
14 11
8 On/off button
9 Tray 1
10 Power switch
11 Power connection
14 Tray 3
15 Output bin
Rear view
Figure 2-3 Printer rear view
1 Formatter cover
2 Interface ports
1 TCU
2 Toner Cartridge
– This roller is placed against the reverse roller. It transfers the paper from the pickup roller to the feed
roller.
– This roller is placed against the feed roller and transfers only one sheet of paper to the feed roller.
When two or more sheets of paper are being transferred from the pickup roller, the load of the torque
limiter of the reverse roller is heavier than the frictional force between the sheets of paper. As a
result, the reverse roller is stopped and the lower sheet of paper is not transferred.
● Feed roller
– This roller transfers the paper sent from the feed/reverse roller to the registration roller.
● Registration roller
– This roller aligns the leading edge of the paper and transfers the paper to the transfer roller
assembly.
Roller Periodic
OPC/Drum 188.5 mm
Tray 2 paper Lead Edge detection Detects Tray 2 paper Lead Edge
sensor
Item Function
Tray 3 paper Lead Edge detection Detects Tray 3 paper Lead Edge
sensor
Tray 3 paper feed jam detection sensor Detects Tray 3 paper feed jam
Tray 4 paper Lead Edge detection Detects Tray 4 paper Lead Edge
(option) sensor
Tray 4/4 paper feed jam detection Detects Tray 4/4 paper feed jam
(option) sensor
Tray 5 paper size detection (option) Detects Tray 5 paper size detection
sensor
Tray 5 paper Lead Edge detection Detects Tray 5 paper Lead Edge
(option) sensor
Output Tray 2 paper full detection Detects output Tray 2 paper full
sensor
Output Tray 3 paper full detection Detects output Tray 3 paper full
sensor
Item Function
Tray 2 Pickup and Lift motor Drives the pickup roller and the knock up plate
Tray 3 Pickup and Lift motor Drives the pickup roller and the knock up plate
Tray 4 Pickup and Lift motor Drives the pickup roller and the knock up plate
Tray 5 Pickup and Lift motor Drives the pickup roller and the knock up plate
Paper Loop Detection sensor Detects paper loop between transfer Nip and fusing Nip
Cassette
The cassette stores paper. The paper size is set using the guides in each tray.
Item Description
3 Paper type
● Plain paper: A5, A4, A3, B5, B4, Letter, 11 in x 17 in (Ledger), Statement, Legal
4 Paper weight
Pickup unit
When paper pickup occurs, the pickup roller moves down in order to come in contact with the surface of the
paper. If the cassette is installed, the LEVER-INPUT CST is pushed and the pickup roller moves down. The feed
and separation rollers make sure that a single sheet of paper is moved into the paper path, and that the feed
roller moves the paper as far as the registration (REGI) roller.
NOTE: The pickup unit 1 and pickup unit 2 are not interchangeable.
Registration unit
The registration roller is driven by the registration/multipurpose motor. The registration roller clutch is located
between the registration/Tray 1 motor and registration roller, or on the transfer belt (for color), and it controls
MP feeder assembly
The MP feed assembly allows feeding of special media cardstock and custom size paper.
Specification
● Capacity: 100 sheets (80g/m² paper standard)
● Media size: 98 mm x 148 mm – 320 mm x 1200 mm (3.87 in x 5.8 in – 12.6 in x 47.2 in)
● Feeding speed: 32 ppm, 40 ppm, 48 ppm Letter/A4 LEF (Long Edge Feeding)
When the MP paper detection [A] sensor detects paper and the machine gets a MP printing job, the MP solenoid
[B] drops the pickup roller [C] onto the top of the paper stack in the MP Tray.
This machine uses a Feed and Reverse Roller (FRR) system for feeding paper. The friction between the reverse
roller [D] and feed roller [E] separates the top sheet of paper from the stack.
This unit fuses the toner that was transferred by the transfer roller onto the paper, by applying a combination of
heat and pressure to complete the fusing process. This printer uses an instant fusing system (NIF type). The
fuser unit design for this model has improved. The fuser belt has been changed to require less heat capacity and
still fuse the toner properly. Additionally, the life has been improved by incorporating a sub-bush system with a
lubricant storage design.
● Lamp halogen
The fuser unit has two halogen lamps. One heats the center of the fusing belt, the other heats the end of
axial direction. These halogen lamps are lit alternately to heat the fusing belt. Each lamp has its coil in a
different location. The coil of the center heater lamp is in the center, the coils on the side heater lamp are
on both sides. The lamps are fixed inside of the fusing belt. When the fusing belt rotates, the lamps do not
rotate.
● Belt fuser
The belt fuser gets heat from the halogen lamp and transfers it to the toner and paper. The belt fuser
consists of three thin-layers. The thin fusing belt reduces warm up and mode changing time. To prevent the
fusing belt from adhering to the toner, the surface of the fuser belt is fluorinated. There is a nip inside the
fusing belt. Tension springs are used to keep a constant nip area where the fusing belt contacts the
pressure roller.
The pressure roller makes sure there is a proper nip width between the pressure roller and fusing belt. It is
made up of the soft silicone sponge rubber. The pressure roller is driven by the driving system and drives
the fusing belt.
The temperature of the fusing belt is maintained by NC sensors (non-contact type thermistors) located
near the center and the end of the fusing belt.
● Thermostats
The thermostat cuts off the power supply to the halogen lamp by opening the circuit when the fusing belt
becomes abnormally hot as a result of a problem, such as a NC sensor malfunction. The thermostat is used
to prevent abnormal operation. When a thermostat is triggered, it must be replaced as well as the other
damaged parts in the fuser unit.
The fuser motor (A) drives the pressure roller (B) through the gear train. The fuser belt is driven by the pressure
roller.
Overheat protection
● The CPU cuts power to the fusing lamp in the following cases:
– The belt temperature detected by the NC sensors keeps higher than 220°C for 20 seconds.
– The belt temperature detected by the NC sensors keeps higher than 230°C for 3 seconds.
– The relay off works when the belt temperature detected by the NC sensors is higher than 230°C.
● The following components are used when thermistor overheat protection fails:
– Two thermostats get into line with the common ground wire of the fusing lamp.
– If one of the thermostat temperatures becomes higher than 195°C, it opens and cuts power to the
fusing lamp. If the other thermostat temperature becomes higher than 195°C, it also opens and cuts
power to the fusing lamp.
Loop control
The tension of the paper between the OPC nip and the fuser nip is known as the paper loop level.
The paper loop level is controlled by monitoring photo sensors 1 and 2. The fuser unit controls the motor speed
for the paper loop level.
The OPC drum (A) is charged with a negative voltage and is exposed to light from the laser scanner assembly (B).
The light produced by a laser creates a latent image by discharging on the surface of the OPC drum. The
negatively charged toners are attracted to the latent drum image by an electric field. The toners (mono image)
on the OPC drum are transferred to the paper by the positive bias.
1. OPC drum charge: The charge roller gives the drum a negative charge.
2. Laser exposure: Light produced by a laser diode hits the charged OPC through the lens and mirrors.
3. Development: The magnetic roller carries negatively charged toner to the latent image on the drum
surface.
4. Transfer: The Paper Transfer Belt (PTB) transfers the toner from the OPC drum to the paper.
5. Cleaning the OPC drum: The cleaning blade removes remaining toner on the drum surface after image
transfer to the paper.
6. Quenching for OPC drum: Quenching is done by illuminating the whole area of the drum with the laser at
the end of every job.
Imaging unit
Drum unit overview
This printer has one drum unit and one development unit.
The drum unit has a charge roller to charge the drum surface and a cleaning roller to clean the charge roller.
The e-label is the sub part of the Drum unit and stores the count information and other data. If the Drum unit is
replaced, the count information stored by the old drum unit will not be kept.
Drum drive
The OPC drum and magnetic roller are driven by one BLDC motor and supplied with power from the coupling.
The drive shaft is directly inserted into the OPC drum to fix the drum unit. This structure provides stable printing
quality.
The developer powder is supplied to the magnetic (development) roller [A] by the two mixing augers [B]. The
diameter of the magnetic roller is 18 mm.
The development unit has a Toner Carrier (TC) sensor [C]. It is used for controlling the operating range of the
toner density.
Developer agitation
Two mixing augers (A) circulate the developer forward and backward to agitate the developer in order to
sufficiently mix the toner and developer.
If the developer unit is stored above 45°C (113°F), the toner might harden and will not work properly. If the toner
in the development unit has hardened, an installation error occurs.
Toner cartridge
When the toner and carrier in the toner cartridge is mixing:
● The toner in the cartridge is transferred from Wheel-Paddle Toner [A] to Wheel-Auger Toner [B] and
transferred from Wheel-Auger Toner [B] to the Reservoir.
● The toner cartridge has an e-label that stores the count information.
● The toner in toner cartridge when stored at temperatures above 45°C (113°F) might harden.
The charged toner on the drum is moved to the paper by the transfer roller in PTB unit (1). The rubber belt in PTB
unit removes the static of the paper then separates the paper from the drum so the paper can move into the
paper path.
This process is done with rotation of the PTB. The rotation is made by the friction between the drive roller (3) and
PTB (1). For this process, the drive roller (3) and guide roller (4) provides proper tension to block slip.
There is one actuator (8) and two photo sensors (5). The actuator recognizes the paper path and controls the
paper speed for stable image quality.
2 Transfer Roller
3 Drive Roller
4 Guide Roller
5 Photo Interrupter
6 Actuator
The drive motor [A] drives the transfer belt [B] by using gears and the PTB drive roller [C].
Cleaning blade
The cleaning blade in the PTB unit removes toner (during printing). Belt cleaning is completed while the transfer
belt makes one rotation.
The cleaning blade [A] always contacts the transfer belt [B], and removes the used toner from the belt.
The film [C] on the cleaning unit protects against toner contamination. The lens [D] always detects waste toner
level. If the light is blocked by waste toner, the machine displays an error message to inform the PTB unit needs
replacement.
The laser scanner assembly has cover glass to protect the glass on the optical path from contamination. The LD
PCA interfaces with the printer.
1 LD PCA
2 P/Mirror Motor
3 F1 Lens
Item Description
4 F2 Lens
5 Cover Glass
The laser scanner assembly has three types depending on printing speed. The difference between the three
models is shown in the following table.
Power train Pickup: normal rotation (pickup input) counter rotation (cassette lift input)
● 1 PM STEP → counter rotation → 3 Gear → 4 5 Gear → 6 Gear & Coupler (cassette lift driving)
● 1 HP STEP → 2 Pulley & Coupler → 3 Gear → 4 Gear & Coupler (Feed Roller driving) → 5 E-Clutch & Gear (MP driving)
● 1 HP STEP → 2 Pulley & Coupler → 6 Gear & Coupler (Feed Roller driving) → 7 Pulley & Coupler (Feed Roller driving)
Drive motors
The following diagram shows the location of the printer drive motors.
Power Train PM STEP Motor → Toner Reservoir Auger & Paddle driving
● 1 PM STEP Motor → 2 Gear → 4 Gear & Latch → 5 Pulley & Gear (Paddle driving)
For scan operation, the scanner uses a full rate (FR) carriage and a half rate (HR) carriage that is moved by a wire.
It scans the original document on the scanner glass or from the ADF.
● Full Rate (FR) carriage: Illuminates the original and reflects the light at a 90 degree angle.
● Half Rate (HR) carriage: Transfers the reflected light from the FR carriage to the lens.
The HR carriage moves half the distance at half the speed of the FR carriage. This keeps a regular gap between
the original and the imaging lens.
2. The reflected light from Mirror #1 is sent to the imaging lens through Mirror #2 and #3.
4. The optical image is generated to the electrical signal by the CCD sensor.
To make a stable image, a gap must be maintained between the original and the lens. To maintain this gap, the
HR carriage moves half the distance and half the speed of the FR carriage.
The optical image made by the CCD sensor is changed to an electrical-analog signal.
Each color element signal in the optical image is separated by the CCD sensor into red, green, and blue.
The red CCD sensor extracts the red color from the optical image, the green CCD sensor extracts the green color
from the optical image, and the blue CCD sensor extracts the blue color from the optical image.
The image scan of the main scanning direction is performed by the CCD sensor. The CCD sensor consists of
approximately 7500 pixels. The image scan of the sub scanning direction is performed by the FR carriage and HR
carriage. The carriage is moved by a wire driven by the scan motor.
To scan the original on the scanner glass, two carriages driven by the motor move at a regular speed. The motor
drives the timing belt, pulley, and wire. The wire pulley rolls and releases the wire to move the carriage.
The scanner consists of the scanner glass, FR carriage, HR carriage, imaging unit, and driving unit.
● FR Carriage
This module illuminates the original. Two white LEDs are assembled on the side of the module. The
original is illuminated by the light-guide. The heat sink is attached to the LED PCB. When the heat sink
is broken or expired, an engineer needs to replace it.
○ Light-guide
The light-guide changes the light from point type to line type. The light-guide is made by
transparent resin and controls the amount of light in the scan area uniformly.
○ White LED
The white LED emits white light. The heat sink attached to the PCA prevents heat deterioration.
○ Reflection holder
The reflection holder reflects the light that has passed through the light-guide.
– Mirror #1
● Mirror #2 and #3
Mirrors #2 and #3 are positioned at a 45 degree angle in order to change the direction of the light. The
reflected light from mirror #1 is sent to the imaging lens through mirrors #2 and #3.
● Pulley
The pulley is a ball bearing type. The pulley rolls and releases the wire which makes the HR carriage move.
The HR carriage moves half the distance at half the speed of the FR carriage.
Imaging unit
● Imaging lens
The reflected light from the imaging lens is focused on the CCD. The image is reduced to the fixed CCD
sensor and pixel size.
● CCD PCA
The image made by the imaging lens is changed to an electrical signal by the CCD. The CCD consists of
three channel line sensors for image creation. The brightness and darkness of the image depends on the
voltage level from the CCD. The output voltage is changed to a digital signal. The digital signal makes the
scanned image.
Wire driving
The original is placed on the scanner glass for scan or copy jobs. The scanner glass is made of tempered glass
and is held in place by the frame to prevent distortion.
Drive motor
Timing belt
The timing belt has a regular sawtooth gear and transfers the motor power to the pulley.
The paper size sensor automatically detects the size of the original on the scanner glass. The paper size sensor
uses two sensors. An infrared LED is used to detect the dark original.
Home sensor
The home sensor detects the FR carriage position. The home sensor is a transmission photosensor.
When the ADF unit opens and closes, a function is triggered which detects whether the paper size sensor is on or
off.
The cover open sensor #2 detects when the ADF unit is closed using magnetic force.
ADF glass
ADF glass scans the original through the ADF unit. The FR carriage reads the original as it passes. If the original is
contaminated, a horizontal black or white line might appear.
Shading sheet
When installing
After unpacking, before turning on the printer, the scan locking screw must be removed. If the locking screw is
not removed scanner failure will occur.
2. After removing the screw, assemble the screw cap from the accessory package.
When moving the printer, tighten the scan locking screw to prevent damage to the carriages.
R8 R9 R1 R11 R1 R1 R1
0 2 3 4
Part Function
R11 SIMPLEX SCAN OUT ROLLER Transfer a scanned original paper to the duplex white-roller
R13 DUPLEX SCAN OUT ROLLER Transfer a scanned original paper to the exit roller
ENWW Flow Automatic Document Feeder (Flow ADF) dn/z bundles (GX) 81
Sensors
Figure 2-50 Flow ADF sensors
10. MSO 8.Cover Open 7. Pickup Position 5. Detect Sensor 2. Paper Width
3.LIFT
Scan CIS
13. SIM Scan Idle
SIMPLEX
Scan In WHITE-R
OLLER
16. Exit
Scan CCD
MSO Sensors 15. DUP Scan
15 DUP Scan Sensor Detects if there is a jam on the Scan Out path
Rx Sensor
● Component: Ultrasonic Sensor Tx Board, Rx Board , HIC Board (Amp and Filter)
● The Rx Sensor has a different level on each paper status: no paper, one paper, multiple papers.
The Flow ADF drive system has eight sections: Pickup Release Drive, Pickup Drive, Pre-Regi Drive, Regi Drive,
Scan-in Roller Release Drive, Scan Drive, Exit Drive, and Lift Drive sections.
ENWW Flow Automatic Document Feeder (Flow ADF) dn/z bundles (GX) 83
Flow ADF document lifting drive system
Figure 2-53 Flow ADF document lifting drive system
● LIFT MOTOR Starts > LIFT SHAFT and LIFT BAR lift Tray
Pickup Semi-Retard
Motor 8 each
Stacker Lifting
MSO Support
Registration
Roller
ENWW Flow Automatic Document Feeder (Flow ADF) dn/z bundles (GX) 85
Flow ADF Scanning Position
Figure 2-56 Flow ADF Scanning Position
6LPSOH[
'XSOH[
ENWW Flow Automatic Document Feeder (Flow ADF) dn/z bundles (GX) 87
Figure 2-60 Dual sensor cleaning method
3XOOWKHOHYHU
Color 40 ppm Same at Scan Speed USM Capacity Scan Speed USM Capacity
whole model
50 ppm 90/180 ipm X 250 sheet 120/240 O 250 sheet
ipm
60 ppm
Mono 40 ppm
50 ppm
60 ppm
● OPE unit
● HVPS board
● LVPS board
The main controller handles the video controller, engine controller, and scan controller.
The main controller receives print data from the host through the network or USB port and receives copy data
from the scan controller. The main controller uses this information to generate printable video bitmap data. It
controls all modules required to print, including the laser scanner assembly, HVPS, FAN, fuser, and so on.
The main controller uses Quad Core CPU 1.5 GHz, DDR3 4 GB memory, Micro SD 4 GB, and a 320 GB SATA HDD to
control the engine driving, video signal processing, and user interface.
A MICOM controls power to the fuser lamp and power to the system according to an optimized energy saving
algorithm. The MICOM communicates with the OPE controller through the USB 3.0 protocol to display the system
information on the control panel.
The OPE unit displays the status of the system using the control panel TFT LCD in response to user actions or the
main controller.
The soft power switch in the OPE unit is used to safely shut down the system.
The ADF controller controls some mechanisms required to scan continuously from the ADF. The ADF controller
communicates with the main controller to synchronize scan timing.
The HVPS board generates and controls high-voltage channels. The fuser drive assembly controls power to the
fuser lamp. The LVPS board generates 5 V and 24 V power for the system.
The following diagrams show the locations of the printer circuit boards:
Main controller
NOTE: The main controller for the previous model is not compatible with the new model (IR/UI). Take care to
not use the incompatible Main Controller during replacement.
RTS5401
U SB3.0 H U B
12M hz
Crystal
Input
M AC0
SA TA _REFCLK_P(100M hz) M A C0_G TX_CLK(125M hz)
25M hz PL602-21 Clk0 NETWORK PH Y
Crystal SA TA _REFCLK_N M A C0_RX_CLK(125M hz)
Input Clk1 RTL8211
RX_CLK_CCD M _N
RX_CLK_D CIS_N
NOTE: This main board is for all models of the HP LaserJet MFP E82540, E82550, E82560.
Main controller
The main controller consists of the main processor (A3000), memory (DDR3 6 GB), eMMC (4 GB)1 G Ethernet
PHY, USB 3.0 HUB, and Micom (Power/Fuser control). It can control Video/UI/FAX signal interface connection,
motor driving IC, engine signal interface connection, and power interface.
The main processor (Quad Core 1.5 GHz CPU) controls video, engine, UI display, and communicates with the
various devices. The HDD is connected to the main controller by a SATA cable and connected to the other device
(such as ADF, dual cassette feeder (DCF), Finisher, and Modem) by UART.
EN G IN E
STEP M O T
PIC KU P1/2, FEED , REG I, T1 EN G AG E,
D R V 8825
X15
A 3000 M AC0 R T L8211E
G igabit phy
R J45
B ASE
FA N SA TA
SEN SO R EXIT1/2/3/4,SM PS(LX/G X), SA TA
2.5", 320G B
EM PTY 1/2, LIFT1/2, PRE FEED 1/2, FEED C PU , LSU , D EVE,SID E,
REG I, M P_EM PTY/SIZEL/W , C U RL2, FU SER O U T CTRL. G P IO
FU SER IN /O U T, B IN _FU LL_EXIT1/2, PW M
D U PLEX_JAM 1/2, D U PLEX_RETU RN , B LD C 4B E A M LS U
PAPER_SIZE1/2, W ASTE_IN STALL, O PC Y,M ,C ,K/ITB , YM CK
O PC _PH ASE Y/M /C /K, RESERVO IR Y/M /C /K, FU SER LS U C CTRL. LD 1,2,3,4
TO N ER SU P YM /C K, ITB H O M E, FU SER PO S, LSU _M O T1
C O VER O PEN FRO N T/SID E, H V PS VD O 1B _YM C K
SC AN H O M E / APS 1,2 SH U TTER AC R, M H V YM C K
VD O 2B _YM C K
PLATEN C O VER O PEN 1,2 D EV D C YM C K H PV C VD O D ATA VD O 3B _YM C K
D EV AC VPP YM C K
VD O 4B _YM C K
S O LE N O ID / C LT D EV AC
C LT : M P D EV AC EN YM C K
SO L : M P / EXIT TH V1 YM C K
TH V2(C V/C C ) / TH V eM M C
DC M OT C LEAN MMC CTRL. 4G B
AC R SH U TTER, C ST LO C K 1/2 SAW / FU SER B IAS B oot D evice
12M hz
RTS5401 A3000 CH 0_CLK_P(800M hz)
Crystal
U SB3.0 H U B D D R3 2G B
Input D D R3 C H 0 CH 0_CLK_N
(4G b*8*4ea)
RTC D D R3 2G B
(4G b*8*4ea)
CH 1_CLK_P(800M hz) D D R3 2G B
N .C
12M hz
ASM 3P2863 Clk0 D D R3 C H 1 CH 1_CLK_N (4G b*8*4ea)
CLK_M A IN (Spread 12M hz)
Crystal Clk1
Input CLK_PU RE(Reference 12M hz)
Sel Clk2 D D R3 2G b_tem p
(4G b*8*4ea)
M AC 0
SA TA _REFCLK_P(100M hz) M A C0_G TX_CLK(125M hz)
25M hz ID T6U 41362 D IF_CLK_P N ETW O RK PH Y 12M hz
Crystal SA TA _REFCLK_N
Input D IF_CLK_N M A C0_RX_CLK(125M hz) RTL8211 Crystal
Input
PCI_REFCLK_P(100M hz)
M AC 1 N ETW O RK O PTIO N PBA
D IF_CLK_P M A C1_G TX_CLK(125M hz)
PCI_REFCLK_N N ETW O RK PH Y 12M hz
D IF_CLK_N M A C1_RX_CLK(125M hz) RTL8211 Crystal
Input
NOTE: This main board is for all HP LaserJet MFP E82540, E82550, E82560 models.
NOTE: When a main board needs to be exchanged, reinstall the MSOK PCA to the new main board to retain the
system information.
IMPORTANT: Do not lose or damage the MSOK chip. It must be installed on the replacement main board in the
same orientation as when it was removed in order for the printer to function.
The low voltage power supply (LVPS) board supplies electric power to the main board and other boards. The
voltage provided includes +5 V, and +24 V from a 110 V/220 V power input. It has safety protection modes for
over current and overload.
1 INPUT_AC
3 24 V on/off
Specification
● General input/output voltage
○ DC 5 V: 35 W
○ DC 24 V: 240 W
110 V 220 V
Input/output connector
● AC input connector (CN1)
1 AC_L AC input
2 AC_N
1 +5V1 Power
2 GND 5 V ground
3 +5V2 Power
4 GND 5 V ground
1 +24V1 Power
2 GND 24 V ground
3 +24V2 Power
4 GND 24 V ground
5 +24V3 Power
6 GND 24 V ground
7 +24V4 Power
8 GND 24 V ground
2 24 V On/Off
3 GND
The low voltage power supply (LVPS) board supplies electric power to the main board and other boards. The
voltage provided includes +5 V, and +24 V from a 110 V/220 V power input. It has safety protection modes for
over current and overload.
Specification
● General input/output voltage
○ DC 5 V: 20 W
○ DC 24 V: 144 W
110 V 220 V
Input/output connector
● AC input connector (CN1)
1 AC_L AC input
2 AC_N
2 AC_N
1 +5V1 DC 5 V
2 GND Ground
3 +24V1 DC 24 V
4 GND Ground
5 +24V2 DC 24 V
6 GND Ground
7 +24V3 DC 24 V
1 GND Ground
The low voltage power supply (LVPS) board supplies electric power to the main board and other boards. The
voltage provided includes +5 V, and +24 V from a 110 V/220 V power input. It has safety protection modes for
over current and overload.
1 INPUT_AC
3 24 V on/off
Specification
● General input/output voltage
○ DC 5 V: 25 W
○ DC 24 V: 180 W
Information
110 V 220 V
1 AC_L AC input
2 AC_N
1 +5V1 Power
2 GND 5 V ground
3 +5V2 Power
4 GND 5 V ground
5 +24V1 Power
6 GND 24 V ground
7 +24V2 Power
8 GND 24 V ground
9 +24V3 Power
2 24 V On/Off
3 GND
1 Option Heater
2 Fuser Lamp
4 LVPS (Type 5)
5 Main Switch
6 AC Inlet
8 LVPS (Type 4)
9/10 Reactor
Information
110 V 220 V
Part name Fuser Drive Board 110V Fuser Drive Board 220V
1 DETECT
2 24 V Input voltage
3 24 V Input voltage
4 ADC_HVPS_24 Signal
5 24 V Input voltage
6 GND GND
7 GND GND
9 GND GND
10 OPEN
24 DETECT
Connections
Specification
● Input voltage: DC 24 V, 3.3 V
● Output voltage:
– MHV: –1387 V
– SAW: –990 V
– FUSER: 400 V
Information
● Part number: SAM-JC44-00241A
Eraser PCA
The eraser PCA has one LED. The LED is used for erasing the negative charges on the surface of the drum after
printing.
Information
● Part number:
Fuser PCA
The Fuser PCA includes a CRU memory for Fuser Unit Life Cycle counting. The Fuser PCA provides a connection
interface for the pressure sensor.
Information
● Part number:
Information
● Part number:
The flow ADF-PCA has three motor driver ICs to control the BLDC/step motor and controls one BLDC motor, two
step motors, one clutch, one fan, and 11 sensors.
Information
● Part number: SAM-JC92-02964A
The scan joint PCA also functions as the relay board to interface with the ADF I/F and power board.
1 WLED IF PCA
2 MAIN PCA
Information
● Part number: SAM-JC92-02781A
CCDM PCA
The CCDM PCA is used in the scanner unit and converts the reflected light from an original document to electrical
signals. The reflected light from an original document is converted to three-color analog signals: red, green, and
blue. The ADC converts each analog signal to digital. For a high speed data transmission, the digital data signal is
converted to a LVDS format with serialization. The CCDM PCA includes the CCD, ADC, Logic IC, and so on.
1 MAIN PCA
Information
● Part number:
4 WLED PCA
Information
● Part number:
WLED PCA
The WLED PCA consists of two WLEDs used as scanner light.
1 WLED PCA
Information
● Part number:
4/5 SW1 Side door open switch Detects opening of right cover.
CN501 13 T4 SENSOR
High capacity input tray (HCI)
Paper feeding system (rollers and functions)
3/4 S7 Main tray level sensor 1 Detects paper residual paper quantity in
main tray.
3/4 S8 Main tray level sensor 2 Detects paper residual paper quantity in
main tray.
3/4 S9 Shift tray no paper sensor Detects paper empty in sub tray.
3/4 S10 Shift tray level sensor 1 Detects paper residual quantity in sub
tray.
3/4 S11 Shift tray level sensor 2 Detects paper residual quantity in sub
tray.
3/4 S12 Shift plate home sensor Detects home position of shift plate.
3/4 S13 Shift plate end sensor Detects end position of shift plate.
CN502 14 T3 SENSOR
CN501 13 T4 SENSOR
CN502 14 T3 SENSOR
● Service approach
– Post-service test
● Maintenance
– Accessories
● Formatter cover
– Introduction
● Accelerator board
– Introduction
– Introduction
ENWW 127
– Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly
– Introduction
● Formatter
– Introduction
● Control panel
– Introduction
● Keyboard (z bundles)
– Introduction
– Introduction
– Output bin
– Left cover
– Right door
– Front cover
– Developer fan
– Main board
– CRUM connector
– Fuser fan
– Inductor unit
ENWW 129
– Right door open switch
– Reservoir unit
– Output unit
– Pickup unit 2
– Pickup unit 1
– Registration assembly
● Flow ADF
– White backing
– Scan glass
– APS sensor
ENWW 131
– Side HCI pickup motor
● Printer specifications
● Service advisories
Channel partners, access training materials in the HP University and Partner Learning Center at
https://content.ext.hp.com/sites/LMS/HPU.page.
To access HP PartSurfer information from any mobile device, go to http://partsurfermobile.hp.com/ or scan the
Quick Response (QR) code below.
Service approach
Precautions when replacing parts
Precautions when assembling and disassembling
● Use only HP approved replacement parts. Make sure that the part number, product name, voltage, and
current or temperature ratings are correct. Failure to do so might result in damage to the machine, circuit
overload, fire, or electric shock.
● Do not make unauthorized changes or additions to the printer. Unauthorized changes might cause the
printer to malfunction and create electric shock or fire hazards.
● Use caution when dismantling the unit. Take note of the location of each screw or other part. This printer
contains 19 different screws. Using the wrong screw might lead to system failure, short circuit or electric
shock.
● Regularly check the condition of the power cable, plug and socket. Bad contacts might lead to overheating
and fire. Damaged cables might lead to electric shock or unit malfunction.
– Do not touch any soldered connections, connector terminals, or other electronic parts when handling
insulated parts.
– Touch a grounded area of the printer chassis to discharge static electric charge before touching a PCA.
– Do not touch a PCA with bare hands or metal objects. Doing so might create a short circuit or cause
electric shock. Use caution when handling a PCA with moving parts such as sensors, motors, or
lamps, as they might become very hot.
– Use caution when fitting and removing screws. Watch for hidden screens. Make sure that the correct
screw is used and make sure that when toothed washers are removed, they are refitted in their
original positions.
– Place the product on an ESD workstation or mat, or use an ESD strap (if one is available). If an ESD
workstation, mat, or strap is not available, ground yourself by touching the sheet-metal chassis
before touching an ESD-sensitive part.
● Remove any finishing devices and the side HCI, if they are installed.
● Place the product on an ESD workstation or mat, or use an ESD strap (if one is available). If an ESD
workstation, mat, or strap is not available, ground yourself by touching the sheet-metal chassis before
touching an ESD-sensitive part.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Post-service test
Perform the following tests to verify that the repair or replacement was successful:
Print-quality test
1. Verify that you have completed the necessary reassembly steps.
3. Attach the power cord and interface cable or interface cables, and then turn on the product.
5. Print a print quality page, and then verify that there are no lines, streaks, banding, or other print quality
defects.
6. Send a print job from the host computer, and then verify that the output meets expectations.
Copy-quality test
1. Place the configuration page in the document feeder, print a copy job, and then verify the results.
2. Place the configuration page on the flatbed glass, print a copy job, and then verify the results
Fax-quality test
1. Place the configuration page in the document feeder.
3. Verify that the send quality and the receive quality meet expectations.
7. Close the front door. Make sure the cover is securely closed. If the message still appears, repeat Steps 3
and 4.
Cleaning the flow ADF white bar and CISCleaning the flow document feeder white bar and CIS
1. Open the ADF unit, peel back the white backing (callout 1), and then release the green tab (callout 2).
Figure 3-9 Peel back the white backing and release one tab
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the trusted platform module (TPM).
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
CAUTION: This part contains components that are electrostatic discharge (ESD) sensitive. To reduce the
possibility of ESD damage, always touch the sheet-metal chassis to ground yourself before touching an ESD
sensitive part.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
http://h20141.www2.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are needed to remove or install this assembly.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
IMPORTANT: Do not replace the HDD and the island of data (IOD) at the same time. Replace one
component, turn the printer on and off, and then replace the second component.
2. Gently pull the TPM straight off the formatter to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to install the Foreign Interface Harness (FIH) accessory.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove this part.
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Connect a third party solution to the FIH, and then verify it correctly functions.
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at an
ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal chassis
to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by
placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from the
replacement part prior to installation.
Introduction
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● Small, flat-blade screwdriver.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Verify that the light on the NFC accessory illuminates to confirm the installation is correct.
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at an
ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal chassis
to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by
placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from the
part prior to installation.
3. Identify the USB connector in the HIP, and then attach the appropriate USB cable:
a. Locate the USB connector that is along one of the short edges. A USB Mini B receptacle (callout 1) is
the most common. However, on some models, a USB Mini B plug (callout 2) is used.
b. Select the appropriate cable from the two that are provided.
a. Attach the white power connector of the cable into the corresponding receptacle on the NFC
accessory.
a. Install the hook-shaped clips on the NFC accessory into the HIP recess..
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the toner collection unit (TCU).
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● No special tools are needed to remove or install this assembly.
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the imaging drum unit.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
NOTICE: Do not grip the waste toner connection when removing the drum unit.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the developer unit.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● No special tools are needed to remove or install this assembly.
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
3. Move the developer locking lever (callout 1) to the down position. Remove three screws to release the
bracket, and then disconnect the small, black cable connector .
Figure 3-26 Remove three screws and disconnect the small, black cable connector
4. Hold the grip point of the developer unit and remove it.
NOTE: Do not grip the waste toner connection when removing the developer unit.
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the developer unit, press on the unit just above the waste toner
auger, and then slide the unit into the printer.
6. Hold the cover, and then release six hooks. Open the cover.
NOTE: Before filling the developer, shake the silver pack about three times to prevent the developer
powder from scattering.
NOTE: When filling the developer, intermittently rock and gently shake the developer from side to side to
avoid overflow.
9. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
i. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, select the Support Tools menu.
iii. Make sure that Service Access Code is selected in the drop-down menu, and then enter the
access code (04082517).
viii. Select the check box on the right side of the screen for the Black Developer Unit.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the fuser unit.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The temperature in the vicinity of the fuser becomes heated. To prevent the potential of
getting burned, make sure the fuser unit has cooled before replacing it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the paper transfer belt (PTB).
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
Reinstallation tip: Before reinstalling the connector cover, roll the wires around the connector to ensure
they are all contained under the cover.
5. Remove one screw and position the lever as shown in the figure below.
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the PTB, slide it all the way to the back of the printer to engage the
prongs on the bottom of the PTB.
NOTE: There is one unused connector on the right door under the PTB.
7. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
i. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, select the Support Tools menu.
iii. Make sure that Service Access Code is selected in the drop-down menu, and then enter the
access code (04082517).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
● Step 1: Remove the Trays 2–x pick, feed, and separation rollers
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the Trays 2–x pick, feed, and separation rollers.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● No special tools are needed to remove or install this assembly.
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
Step 1: Remove the Trays 2–x pick, feed, and separation rollers
NOTE: HP recommends that all three rollers are replaced at the same time.
3. Inside the tray opening, slide the return guide toward the front of the printer until it stops.
Reinstallation tip: After installing the new rollers, slide the return guide toward the rear of the printer to
prevent paper jams.
5. When removing the rollers, make sure to leave the white couplers (callout 1) in place. If the couplers
become dislodged, reinstall them as shown in the figure below.
NOTE: The figure shows the pickup assembly removed from the printer to more clearly show the
positions of the couplers and rollers.
6. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
Special installation instructions: Trays 2–x pick, feed, and separation rollers
▲ After the replacement rollers are installed, follow these instructions to reset the firmware counter:
iii. Make sure that Service Access Code is selected in the drop-down menu, and then enter the
access code (04087617).
viii. Select the tray number for the rollers just replaced.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the multipurpose (MP) tray pickup/reverse/feed
roller.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● Small, flat-blade screwdriver
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
1. Open the multipurpose (MP) tray. Use a small flat blade screwdriver to release the tab on the right side of
the cover.
NOTE: The plastic tabs on the edges of the cover might require extra pressure to remove.
4. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
i. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, select the Support Tools menu.
iii. Make sure that Service Access Code is selected in the drop-down menu, and then enter the
service access code.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the flow ADF pickup roller assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
▲ Remove four screws (callout 1), disconnect two connectors (callout 2), and one ground wire (callout
3), and then remove the pickup roller assembly.
4. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
i. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, select the Support Tools menu.
iii. Make sure that Service Access Code is selected in the drop-down menu, and then enter the
service access code.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the Flow ADF separation roller assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
1. Slightly lift the input tray, and then remove the separation roller cover.
NOTE: Ensure the sponge washer (circled above) is retained during the removal of the roller assembly–it
may fall off.
Reinstallation tip: Position the spring and shaft before attaching the claws to the shaft.
4. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
i. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, select the Support Tools menu.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the formatter cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● No special tools are needed to remove or install this assembly.
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the accelerator board.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
▲ Loosen two screws, retained in plastic clips, on the outside of the formatter cage. Disconnect one
connector, release the plastic locator pin, and then gently lift the accelerator board away from the
formatter by the edges.
NOTE: A connector on the back of the accelerator board holds the board on the formatter.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the island of data (IOD).
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
▲ Disconnect one connector, remove one screw, and then remove the IOD.
IMPORTANT: Do not replace the HDD and the island of data (IOD) at the same time. Replace one
component, turn the printer on and off, and then replace the second component.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the hard disk drive (HDD) located on the
formatter board.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● No special tools are needed to remove or install this assembly.
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
IMPORTANT: Do not replace the HDD and the island of data (IOD) at the same time. Replace one
component, turn the printer on and off, and then replace the second component.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the formatter.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
NOTE: A connector on the back of the accelerator board holds the board on the formatter.
IMPORTANT: Do not replace the HDD and the island of data (IOD) at the same time. Replace one
component, turn the printer on and off, and then replace the second component.
IMPORTANT: Do not replace the formatter and the main PCA at the same time. Replace one component,
turn the printer on and off, and then replace the second component.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the control panel.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
3. Gently pry the control-panel bezel from the center screw hole, and then pry from the center of the control-
panel bezel to the edges to release.
CAUTION: Do not pry against the scanner glass when removing the control-panel bezel.
Figure 3-60 Remove the control panel screws and disconnect connectors
3. Remove the USB interconnect cable from its retainer and reroute out of the way.
4. Lift the control panel up from the front to release the tabs at the rear, and then remove the control panel.
Reinstallation tip: Align the four tabs at the rear or control panel, and then snap in the control panel.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the keyboard.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
3. Gently pry the control-panel bezel from the center screw hole, and then pry from the center of the control-
panel bezel to the edges to release.
CAUTION: Do not pry against the scanner glass when removing the control-panel bezel.
Figure 3-63 Remove the control panel screws and disconnect connectors
3. Remove the USB interconnect cable from its retainer and reroute out of the way.
4. Lift the control panel up from the front to release the tabs at the rear, and then remove the control panel.
Reinstallation tip: Align the four tabs at the rear or control panel, and then snap in the control panel.
2. Slide the keyboard out, and then depress two latches to remove the keyboard.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the intermediate paper transport unit (IPTU).
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the front top inner cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the front power cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
CAUTION: The cover is still attached to the printer by a cable. Do not completely remove the cover.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the front power switch.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Press the power switch and verify that the printer turns on.
CAUTION: The cover is still attached to the printer by a cable. Do not completely remove the cover.
2. Remove two screws, and then remove the power switch button.
Figure 3-76 Remove two screws and the power switch button
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the output bin.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the top right cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
CAUTION: The cover is still attached to the printer by a cable. Do not completely remove the cover.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the left cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
2. Remove seven screw-caps and eight screws, and lift the left cover off of the printer.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the lower rear cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the upper rear cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the left rear corner cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the right rear cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the right door.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Slightly raise the right door and carefully release the right hinge from the hinge pin.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
4. Open the lower paper feeder door. Lower the right door to 90°, and then rotate the rear side of the door
away from the printer. Slide the door to the rear of the printer to remove it.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the paper dust brush.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● No special tools are needed to remove or install this assembly.
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the front cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the inner front cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The cover is still attached to the printer by a cable. Do not completely remove the cover.
4. Remove two screw caps and two screws on the output bin.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the front cover open sensor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The cover is still attached to the printer by a cable. Do not completely remove the cover.
2. Remove one screw, and then remove the front cover open sensor.
Figure 3-121 Remove one screw and the cover open sensor
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the low voltage power supply (LVPS) cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
LVPS cover
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the laser scanner assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Remove seven screw-caps and eight screws, and lift the left cover off of the printer.
2. Pull the laser scanner assembly partially out of the printer, disconnect one flat cable, and then remove the
laser scanner assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the developer fan.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Developer fan
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
NOTICE: Do not grip the waste toner connection when removing the drum unit.
Figure 3-132 Remove three screws and disconnect the small, black cable connector
4. Hold the grip point of the developer unit and remove it.
NOTE: Do not grip the waste toner connection when removing the developer unit.
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the developer unit, press on the unit just above the waste toner
auger, and then slide the unit into the printer.
5. Unpack the new developer unit box and check the components. In the box is a developer unit and a silver
pack of developer powder.
NOTE: Before filling the developer, shake the silver pack about three times to prevent the developer
powder from scattering.
NOTE: When filling the developer, intermittently rock and gently shake the developer from side to side to
avoid overflow.
9. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
i. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, select the Support Tools menu.
iii. Make sure that Service Access Code is selected in the drop-down menu, and then enter the
access code (04082517).
viii. Select the check box on the right side of the screen for the Black Developer Unit.
2. Remove seven screw-caps and eight screws, and lift the left cover off of the printer.
7. Release the wire harness from the retainer, and then release six tabs to open the developer fan duct.
Reinstallation tip: Note the orientation of the fan in the duct and install it in the same orientation when
replacing it.
9. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the high voltage power supply (HVPS) board.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Remove seven screw-caps and eight screws, and lift the left cover off of the printer.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the main board.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
3. Before removing the formatter cage, place a piece of tape or a wire tie (callout 1) around the cables
disconnected from the formatter on the left side. This will identify the cables that will be connected to the
formatter during reassembly.
4. Lift the formatter cage up, push it to the right to clear the boss on the right side, and then pull it away from
the printer to remove it.
2. Disconnect all of the remaining connectors. Two of the flat cable connectors (callout 1) are zero insertion
force (ZIF) connectors. Open the latch on the connectors before removing the flat cables. Remove the
MSOK board (callout 2) and install it on the replacement main board. Remove nine screws, and then
remove the main board.
IMPORTANT: Do not lose or damage the MSOK chip. It must be installed on the replacement main board in
the correct orientation in order for the printer to function. The MSOK chip is extremely difficult to replace if
it is lost or damaged.
3. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
a. When reinstalling the MSOK board, note the dashed outline (callout 1) on the main board. When the
MSOK board is installed correctly, it fits within this outline.
b. Make sure that the MSOK board is installed correctly on the replacement main board.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the toner supply motor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
3. Before removing the formatter cage, place a piece of tape or a wire tie (callout 1) around the cables
disconnected from the formatter on the left side. This will identify the cables that will be connected to the
formatter during reassembly.
4. Lift the formatter cage up, push it to the right to clear the boss on the right side, and then pull it away from
the printer to remove it.
2. Do not disconnect the two hard disk drive (HDD) connectors at the top of the main board (callout 1).
Disconnect all of the remaining connectors. Two of the flat cable connectors (callout 2) are zero insertion
force (ZIF) connectors. Open the latch on the connectors before removing the flat cables. Release the
cables from six retainers (callout 3).
1
3 2
4. Lift the main board cage up, and then rotate the lower edge of the cage away from the printer to remove it.
5. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
2
1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the CRUM connector.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
CRUM connector
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The cover is still attached to the printer by a cable. Do not completely remove the cover.
4. Remove two screw caps and two screws on the output bin.
2
1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the low voltage power supply (LVPS) fans.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the low voltage power supply (LVPS) board 1.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
NOTE: Many of the connectors on this board have retainers attached. Be sure to release the retainer before
attempting to disconnect the connector.
▲ Disconnect all connectors. Remove four screws, and then remove the LVPS board 1.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the low voltage power supply (LVPS) board 2.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
NOTE: Many of the connectors on this board have retainers attached. Be sure to release the retainer before
attempting to disconnect the connector.
▲ Disconnect all connectors. Remove four screws, and then remove the LVPS board 2.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the low voltage power supply (LVPS) board 3.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
NOTE: Many of the connectors on this board have retainers attached. Be sure to release the retainer before
attempting to disconnect the connector.
2. Disconnect three connectors (callout 1), remove four screws, and then remove the LVPS board 3.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the fuser drive board.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
NOTE: Many of the connectors on this board have retainers attached. Be sure to release the retainer before
attempting to disconnect the connector.
Reinstallation tip: Two of the connectors (callout 1) can be mistakenly switched and connected to the
wrong connector on the fuser drive board. If this happens, the printer will not power on. Make sure that the
cables are installed in the correct positions.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the fuser fan.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
1. Release the cables from two retainers (callout 1), disconnect three connectors (callout 2), and then remove
three screws.
1
2
2. Lift the LVPS board and cage slightly away from the printer, and disconnect one connector behind the cage.
Remove the LVPS board and cage.
3. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
1
2
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
2. Pull the fuser fan housing slightly away from the printer, and then disconnect one connector.
4. If you are replacing the fuser fan, separate the fan housing, and then remove the fuser fan. If you are
removing the fuser fan housing to access an assembly behind it, skip this step.
Reinstallation tip: Note the orientation of the fan in the housing and install the replacement fan in the
same orientation.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the main drive unit.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
NOTICE: Do not grip the waste toner connection when removing the drum unit.
3. Move the developer locking lever (callout 1) to the down position. Remove three screws to release the
bracket, and then disconnect the small, black cable connector .
Figure 3-223 Remove three screws and disconnect the small, black cable connector
NOTE: Do not grip the waste toner connection when removing the developer unit.
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the developer unit, press on the unit just above the waste toner
auger, and then slide the unit into the printer.
5. Unpack the new developer unit box and check the components. In the box is a developer unit and a silver
pack of developer powder.
6. Hold the cover, and then release six hooks. Open the cover.
NOTE: Before filling the developer, shake the silver pack about three times to prevent the developer
powder from scattering.
NOTE: When filling the developer, intermittently rock and gently shake the developer from side to side to
avoid overflow.
9. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
i. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, select the Support Tools menu.
iii. Make sure that Service Access Code is selected in the drop-down menu, and then enter the
access code (04082517).
viii. Select the check box on the right side of the screen for the Black Developer Unit.
3. Remove three screws, and then remove the main drive unit.
NOTE: Remove only those screws marked in blue in the figure below.
4. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
● Step 4: Remove the fuser drive and low-voltage power supply (LVPS) boards and cage
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the inductor unit.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Inductor unit
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
Step 4: Remove the fuser drive and low-voltage power supply (LVPS) boards and cage
WARNING! Wait five minutes after turning the printer off to allow the capacitors to dissipate any residual
energy.
▲ Before removing the fuser drive and LVPS boards and cage, note the location of four connectors (callout 1)
that do not have to be disconnected. Disconnect the remaining connectors on the LVPS and fuser drive
boards, and then release the cables from five retainers. Remove three screws, and then tilt the top of the
cage out to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
● Step 4: Remove the fuser drive and low-voltage power supply (LVPS) boards and cage
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the auto closing unit.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
Step 4: Remove the fuser drive and low-voltage power supply (LVPS) boards and cage
WARNING! Wait five minutes after turning the printer off to allow the capacitors to dissipate any residual
energy.
▲ Before removing the fuser drive and LVPS boards and cage, note the location of four connectors (callout 1)
that do not have to be disconnected. Disconnect the remaining connectors on the LVPS and fuser drive
boards, and then release the cables from five retainers. Remove three screws, and then tilt the top of the
cage out to remove it.
2. Remove one screw, and then remove the cassette rail cover.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the fuser/output drive unit.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
1. Release the cables from two retainers (callout 1), disconnect three connectors (callout 2), and then remove
three screws.
1
2
2. Lift the LVPS board and cage slightly away from the printer, and disconnect one connector behind the cage.
Remove the LVPS board and cage.
3. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
1
2
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
3. If you are replacing the fuser fan, release five tabs along the edges of the fan housing. If you are removing
the fuser fan housing to access an assembly behind it, skip this step.
Reinstallation tip: Note the orientation of the fan in the housing and install the replacement fan in the
same orientation.
1
2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the right door open sensor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
1. Release the cables from two retainers (callout 1), disconnect three connectors (callout 2), and then remove
three screws.
1
2
2. Lift the LVPS board and cage slightly away from the printer, and disconnect one connector behind the cage.
Remove the LVPS board and cage.
3. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
1
2
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
3. If you are replacing the fuser fan, release five tabs along the edges of the fan housing. If you are removing
the fuser fan housing to access an assembly behind it, skip this step.
Reinstallation tip: Note the orientation of the fan in the housing and install the replacement fan in the
same orientation.
1
2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the right door open switch.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
1. Release the cables from two retainers (callout 1), disconnect three connectors (callout 2), and then remove
three screws.
1
2
2. Lift the LVPS board and cage slightly away from the printer, and disconnect one connector behind the cage.
Remove the LVPS board and cage.
3. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
1
2
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
3. If you are replacing the fuser fan, release five tabs along the edges of the fan housing. If you are removing
the fuser fan housing to access an assembly behind it, skip this step.
Reinstallation tip: Note the orientation of the fan in the housing and install the replacement fan in the
same orientation.
1
2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
● Step 4: Remove the fuser drive and LVPS boards and cage
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace pickup drive unit 1.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
Step 4: Remove the fuser drive and LVPS boards and cage
WARNING! Wait five minutes after turning the printer off to allow the capacitors to dissipate any residual
energy.
▲ Before removing the fuser drive and LVPS boards and cage, note the location of four connectors (callout 1)
that do not have to be disconnected. Disconnect the remaining connectors on the LVPS and fuser drive
boards, and then release the cables from five retainers. Remove three screws, and then tilt the top of the
cage out to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace pickup drive unit 2.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the feed/MP drive unit.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
3. Slightly raise the right door, and then release the left dampener.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
3. At the back of the printer, release one retainer (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
Remove three rubberized screws (callout 3), and then remove the feed/MP drive unit.
4. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the registration drive assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2
1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the toner collection unit (TCU) sensors.
Click here to view a video of the toner collection unit level sensor procedure.
Click here to view a video of the toner collection unit detect sensor procedure.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
4. Remove two screw caps and two screws on the output bin.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the reservoir unit.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
3. Move the developer locking lever (callout 1) to the down position. Remove three screws to release the
bracket, and then disconnect the small, black cable connector .
Figure 3-314 Remove three screws and disconnect the small, black cable connector
NOTE: Do not grip the waste toner connection when removing the developer unit.
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the developer unit, press on the unit just above the waste toner
auger, and then slide the unit into the printer.
5. Unpack the new developer unit box and check the components. In the box is a developer unit and a silver
pack of developer powder.
6. Hold the cover, and then release six hooks. Open the cover.
NOTE: Before filling the developer, shake the silver pack about three times to prevent the developer
powder from scattering.
NOTE: When filling the developer, intermittently rock and gently shake the developer from side to side to
avoid overflow.
9. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
i. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, select the Support Tools menu.
iii. Make sure that Service Access Code is selected in the drop-down menu, and then enter the
access code (04082517).
viii. Select the check box on the right side of the screen for the Black Developer Unit.
2. Remove seven screw-caps and eight screws, and lift the left cover off of the printer.
2. Pull the laser scanner assembly partially out of the printer, disconnect one flat cable, and then remove the
laser scanner assembly.
5. Remove the inner front cover while lifting the output bin.
2. Lift the front of the guide up and slide it slightly toward the rear of the printer (callout 1). Rotate the front
of the guide toward the left side of the printer, and then remove the guide through the left side opening.
1
2
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the reservoir assembly, install the tab in the back first, and then
rotate the assembly toward the sheet metal wall over the screw opening.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the auto size sensor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
● Disconnect the connector. Remove two screws, and then remove the sensor.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the fuser out sensor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Slightly raise the right door and carefully release the right hinge from the hinge pin.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
4. Open the lower paper feeder door. Lower the right door to 90°, and then rotate the rear side of the door
away from the printer. Slide the door to the rear of the printer to remove it.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
4. Remove one screw on the front, top corner of the door, and then open the cover-side output.
5. Remove one screw, and then rotate the sensor holder up.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
● Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the feed 2 sensor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Feed 2 sensor
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Slightly raise the right door and carefully release the right hinge from the hinge pin.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
4. Open the lower paper feeder door. Lower the right door to 90°, and then rotate the rear side of the door
away from the printer. Slide the door to the rear of the printer to remove it.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper
1. Remove four screws.
2. Remove three screws, and then remove the lower cable cover [A].
Figure 3-350 Remove three screws and the lower cable cover
6. Disconnect the sensor connector. Remove one screw, and then remove the feed guide take away upper.
Figure 3-355 Disconnect one connector and remove the feed 2 sensor
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
● Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the multi-purpose (MP) unit on the right door.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Slightly raise the right door and carefully release the right hinge from the hinge pin.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
4. Open the lower paper feeder door. Lower the right door to 90°, and then rotate the rear side of the door
away from the printer. Slide the door to the rear of the printer to remove it.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper
1. Remove four screws.
2. Remove three screws, and then remove the lower cable cover [A].
Figure 3-363 Remove three screws and the lower cable cover
6. Disconnect the sensor connector. Remove one screw, and then remove the feed guide take away upper.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
● Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the multi-purpose (MP) empty sensor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
3. Slightly raise the right door, and then release the left dampener.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper
1. Remove four screws.
Figure 3-386 Remove three screws and the lower cable cover
6. Disconnect the sensor connector. Remove one screw, and then remove the feed guide take away upper.
4. Release and position the PTB assembly as shown in the figure, and then remove three screws.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
● Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the multi-purpose (MP) paper length sensor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
3. Slightly raise the right door, and then release the left dampener.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper
1. Remove four screws.
Figure 3-410 Remove three screws and the lower cable cover
6. Disconnect the sensor connector. Remove one screw, and then remove the feed guide take away upper.
4. Release and position the PTB assembly as shown in the figure, and then remove three screws.
2. Disconnect one connector, and then remove the MP paper length sensor.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
● Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the multi-purpose (MP) solenoid.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
3. Slightly raise the right door, and then release the left dampener.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
Step 3: Remove the feed guide take away lower and feed guide take away upper
1. Remove four screws.
Figure 3-435 Remove three screws and the lower cable cover
6. Disconnect the sensor connector. Remove one screw, and then remove the feed guide take away upper.
4. Release and position the PTB assembly as shown in the figure, and then remove three screws.
2. Remove two screws, three e-rings, and three bushings. Remove the bracket-rear.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the output unit.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
SAM-JC90-01369A Exit
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
3. Slightly raise the right door, and then release the left dampener.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
CAUTION: The temperature in the vicinity of the fuser becomes heated. To prevent the potential of
getting burned, make sure the fuser unit has cooled before replacing it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the return sensor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
3. Slightly raise the right door, and then release the left dampener.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
CAUTION: The temperature in the vicinity of the fuser becomes heated. To prevent the potential of
getting burned, make sure the fuser unit has cooled before replacing it.
1
3
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the duplex 1 sensor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
3. Slightly raise the right door, and then release the left dampener.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
CAUTION: The temperature in the vicinity of the fuser becomes heated. To prevent the potential of
getting burned, make sure the fuser unit has cooled before replacing it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the output 1 bin full sensor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
3. Slightly raise the right door, and then release the left dampener.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
CAUTION: The temperature in the vicinity of the fuser becomes heated. To prevent the potential of
getting burned, make sure the fuser unit has cooled before replacing it.
3. Release two tabs, and then unhook the sensor from the sheet metal.
5. Rotate the shaft to release the sensor, and then remove the sensor.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the output gate solenoid.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
3. Slightly raise the right door, and then release the left dampener.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
CAUTION: The temperature in the vicinity of the fuser becomes heated. To prevent the potential of
getting burned, make sure the fuser unit has cooled before replacing it.
Figure 3-533 On the output unit, disconnect one connector and remove two gears
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace pickup unit 2.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Slightly raise the right door and carefully release the right hinge from the hinge pin.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
4. Open the lower paper feeder door. Lower the right door to 90°, and then rotate the rear side of the door
away from the printer. Slide the door to the rear of the printer to remove it.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
CAUTION: The pickup unit is still attached to the printer by a connector. Do not remove it completely
6. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the pickup lifting and empty sensor for pickup
unit 2.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
3. Slightly raise the right door, and then release the left dampener.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
4. Rotate the left side of pickup unit 2 away from the printer.
CAUTION: The pickup unit is still attached to the printer by a connector. Do not remove it completely
6. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the prefeed sensor 2 for pickup unit 2.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Slightly raise the right door and carefully release the right hinge from the hinge pin.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
4. Open the lower paper feeder door. Lower the right door to 90°, and then rotate the rear side of the door
away from the printer. Slide the door to the rear of the printer to remove it.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
CAUTION: The pickup unit is still attached to the printer by a connector. Do not remove it completely
6. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace pickup unit 1.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Slightly raise the right door and carefully release the right hinge from the hinge pin.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
4. Open the lower paper feeder door. Lower the right door to 90°, and then rotate the rear side of the door
away from the printer. Slide the door to the rear of the printer to remove it.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
CAUTION: The pickup unit is still attached to the printer by a connector. Do not remove it completely
6. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
CAUTION: The pickup unit is still attached to the printer by a connector. Do not remove it completely
4. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the pickup lifting and empty sensor for pickup
unit 1.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
3. Slightly raise the right door, and then release the left dampener.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
4. Rotate the left side of pickup unit 2 away from the printer.
CAUTION: The pickup unit is still attached to the printer by a connector. Do not remove it completely
6. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
2. Rotate the left side of pickup unit 1 away from the printer.
CAUTION: The pickup unit is still attached to the printer by a connector. Do not remove it completely
4. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the prefeed sensor 1 for pickup unit 1.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
3. Slightly raise the right door, and then release the left dampener.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
4. Rotate the left side of pickup unit 2 away from the printer.
CAUTION: The pickup unit is still attached to the printer by a connector. Do not remove it completely
6. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
2. Rotate the left side of pickup unit 1 away from the printer.
CAUTION: The pickup unit is still attached to the printer by a connector. Do not remove it completely
4. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures for removing the 320 GB hard-disk drive installed beneath the rear-exit
cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Remove four screws, disconnect the HDD cable, and then remove the HDD with its holder.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the registration assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Slightly raise the right door and carefully release the right hinge from the hinge pin.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
4. Open the lower paper feeder door. Lower the right door to 90°, and then rotate the rear side of the door
away from the printer. Slide the door to the rear of the printer to remove it.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
3. Release two retainers (callout 1), disconnect one in-line connector (callout 2), and then remove two screws
(callout 3).
5. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
a. Install the back, gear side of the shaft into the opening in the sheet metal first.
NOTE: The bushing is flat along the top and bottom edges. Install the bushing so the flat edges
match the keyed opening in the sheet metal.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the registration sensor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Registration sensor
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
3. Slightly raise the right door, and then release the left dampener.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
4. Rotate the left side of the registration assembly away from the printer, and then remove it.
5. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
a. Install the back, gear side of the shaft into the opening in the sheet metal first.
b. Remove the bushing (callout 1) from the end of the front of the shaft.
NOTE: The bushing is flat along the top and bottom edges. Install the bushing so the flat edges
match the keyed opening in the sheet metal.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
1
2
2. Remove three self-tapping screws, and then remove the registration sensor assembly.
Figure 3-653 Remove three screws and the registration sensor assembly
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the high voltage terminal.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
NOTICE: Do not grip the waste toner connection when removing the drum unit.
3. Before removing the formatter cage, place a piece of tape or a wire tie (callout 1) around the cables
disconnected from the formatter on the left side. This will identify the cables that will be connected to the
formatter during reassembly.
4. Lift the formatter cage up, push it to the right to clear the boss on the right side, and then pull it away from
the printer to remove it.
2. Do not disconnect the two hard disk drive (HDD) connectors at the top of the main board (callout 1).
Disconnect all of the remaining connectors. Two of the flat cable connectors (callout 2) are zero insertion
force (ZIF) connectors. Open the latch on the connectors before removing the flat cables. Release the
cables from six retainers (callout 3).
1
3 2
4. Lift the main board cage up, and then rotate the lower edge of the cage away from the printer to remove it.
5. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
3. Remove three screws, and then remove the main drive unit.
NOTE: Remove only those screws marked in blue in the figure below.
4. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
Figure 3-673 Remove three screws and the high voltage terminal
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the flow ADF whole unit assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Remove the plastic cable choke from the wire harness, and then disconnect the document feeder harness
from the main board. Disconnect the insulated ground wire from the chassis.
4. Release two hinge stops on the back of the document feeder to allow the document feeder to open to a
full 90°.
IMPORTANT: Note the alignment marks on the hinge stops. Any new document feeder must be reinstalled
with the same alignment.
6. Pull back and then lift up to release the document feeder unit.
NOTE: Complete a shading test and a skew alignment after replacing the document feeder unit.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the jam access cover assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
Figure 3-680 Remove the document feeder front cover top screws
2. Remove three screws from the bottom of the document feeder front cover, and then remove the
document feeder front cover.
Figure 3-681 Remove the document feeder front cover bottom screws
2. Remove three screws from the bottom of the document feeder back cover, and then remove the document
feeder back cover.
Figure 3-683 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws
Figure 3-686 Remove the jam access cover door arm support
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the input tray assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
Figure 3-687 Remove the document feeder front cover top screws
2. Remove three screws from the bottom of the document feeder front cover, and then remove the
document feeder front cover.
Figure 3-688 Remove the document feeder front cover bottom screws
2. Remove three screws from the bottom of the document feeder back cover, and then remove the document
feeder back cover.
Figure 3-690 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws
Figure 3-692 Remove the document feeder pickup roller assembly cover screws
2. Lift the tray from the front, and pivot the tray outward to remove.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the CIS assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
Figure 3-695 Remove the document feeder front cover top screws
2. Remove three screws from the bottom of the document feeder front cover, and then remove the
document feeder front cover.
Figure 3-696 Remove the document feeder front cover bottom screws
2. Remove three screws from the bottom of the document feeder back cover, and then remove the document
feeder back cover.
Figure 3-698 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws
Reinstallation tip: Note the orientation of the CIS front alignment cover for reinstallation; the cover must
reinstalled with the same orientation.
2. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then lift the alignment pin to release the CIS assembly (callout 2).
Figure 3-702 Disconnect the CIS connector and lift the alignment pin
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the front motor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
Figure 3-703 Remove the document feeder back cover top screws
2. Remove three screws from the bottom of the document feeder back cover, and then remove the document
feeder back cover.
Figure 3-704 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws
Reinstallation tip:
a. Reinstall the motor and lift the gear belt up to engage the motor pulley.
d. Tighten the motor mount screws just enough so that the tension spring (not the motor mount
screws) is providing the tension to the belt.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the rear motor assemblies.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
SAM-JC97-04680A
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
5 6 7
Callout Description
1 Motor 1
2 Motor 2
3 Pickup motor
4 Pre_REGI motor
5 Exit motor
6 Feed motor
7 REGI motor
Figure 3-707 Remove the document feeder back cover top screws
2. Remove three screws from the bottom of the document feeder back cover, and then remove the document
feeder back cover.
Figure 3-708 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws
Reinstallation tip: Reinstall the motor and lift the gear belt up to engage the motor pulley.
TIP: Remove the connector harness from the cable retainer, and then disconnect the connector.
● Reinstall the motor on the motor mounting screws, and then lift the gear belt up to engage the motor
pulley.
● Tighten the motor mount screws just enough so that the tension spring (not the motor mount
screws) is providing the tension to the belt.
2. Remove the spring (callout 1), disconnect one connector (callout 2), loosen three screws, and then remove
the exit motor.
Reinstallation tip:
a. Reinstall the motor and lift the gear belt up to engage the motor pulley.
c. Tighten the motor mount screws just enough so that the tension spring (not the motor mount
screws) is providing the tension to the belt.
TIP: Remove the connector harness from the cable retainer, and then disconnect the connector.
4. Remove one spring, loosen (do not remove) 3 screws, and then slide the motor off the screws to remove.
Reinstallation tip:
a. Reinstall the motor and lift the gear belt up to engage the motor pulley.
c. Tighten the motor mount screws just enough so that the tension spring (not the motor mount
screws) is providing the tension to the belt.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the document feeder PCA fan assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
Figure 3-717 Remove the document feeder back cover top screws
2. Remove three screws from the bottom of the document feeder back cover, and then remove the document
feeder back cover.
Figure 3-718 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws
Reinstallation tip: Install the fan with the correct orientation when reinstalling.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the CIS fan assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
CIS fan
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
Figure 3-720 Remove the document feeder back cover top screws
2. Remove three screws from the bottom of the document feeder back cover, and then remove the document
feeder back cover.
Figure 3-721 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the ultrasonic sensor with PCA assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
Figure 3-723 Remove the document feeder front cover top screws
2. Remove three screws from the bottom of the document feeder front cover, and then remove the
document feeder front cover.
Figure 3-724 Remove the document feeder front cover bottom screws
2. Remove three screws from the bottom of the document feeder back cover, and then remove the document
feeder back cover.
Figure 3-726 Remove the document feeder back cover bottom screws
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
White backing
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the ADF white backing.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
White backing
4. Replace any damaged or missing velcro tabs by positioning them on the new white backing.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the scanner whole unit.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
3. Disconnect the document feeder harness from the scan joint board. Remove one connector and one
grounding wire.
IMPORTANT: Note the alignment marks on the hinge stops. Any new document feeder must be reinstalled
with the same alignment.
NOTE: Complete a shading test and a skew alignment after replacing the document feeder unit.
3. Gently pry the control-panel bezel from the center screw hole, and then pry from the center of the control-
panel bezel to the edges to release.
CAUTION: Do not pry against the scanner glass when removing the control-panel bezel.
Figure 3-741 Remove the control panel screws and disconnect connectors
3. Remove the USB interconnect cable from its retainer and reroute out of the way.
4. Lift the control panel up from the front to release the tabs at the rear, and then remove the control panel.
Reinstallation tip: Align the four tabs at the rear or control panel, and then snap in the control panel.
2. Slide the keyboard out, and then depress two latches to remove the keyboard.
2. Remove three screw-caps and three screws. Release the scan-left cover.
2
1
NOTE: At the front of the scanner, remove the bracket (callout 2) and install it on the new scanner whole
unit.
4. Disconnect the two scan cables and one FFC at the top of the main board.
NOTE: After reassembly, utilize the target to adjust the scanner location as necessary.
Reinstallation tip: Reinstall the lower cover and ensure the cables are routed through the opening for the
control panel and the bracket is properly aligned in the cover.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the scanner glass.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the LED lamp module assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Remove the plastic cable choke from the wire harness, and then disconnect the document feeder harness
from the main board. Disconnect the insulated ground wire from the chassis.
4. Release two hinge stops on the back of the document feeder to allow the document feeder to open to a
full 90°.
IMPORTANT: Note the alignment marks on the hinge stops. Any new document feeder must be reinstalled
with the same alignment.
6. Pull back and then lift up to release the document feeder unit.
NOTE: Complete a shading test and a skew alignment after replacing the document feeder unit.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the scanner imaging unit assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
CAUTION: Do not remove or adjust the other two screws shown as they require factory setting only.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Scan joint board assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Remove the plastic cable choke from the wire harness, and then disconnect the document feeder harness
from the main board. Disconnect the insulated ground wire from the chassis.
4. Release two hinge stops on the back of the document feeder to allow the document feeder to open to a
full 90°.
IMPORTANT: Note the alignment marks on the hinge stops. Any new document feeder must be reinstalled
with the same alignment.
6. Pull back and then lift up to release the document feeder unit.
NOTE: Complete a shading test and a skew alignment after replacing the document feeder unit.
2. Remove three screw-caps and three screws, and then remove the scan-right cover.
2
1
4. At the back of the scanner, remove three screw caps and three screws, and then remove the scan-rear
cover.
Figure 3-780 Remove three screws and the scanner rear cover
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the APS sensor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
● Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
● Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
● Verify that the printer is in better condition than when you arrived, cosmetically and electrically.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Remove the plastic cable choke from the wire harness, and then disconnect the document feeder harness
from the main board. Disconnect the insulated ground wire from the chassis.
4. Release two hinge stops on the back of the document feeder to allow the document feeder to open to a
full 90°.
IMPORTANT: Note the alignment marks on the hinge stops. Any new document feeder must be reinstalled
with the same alignment.
6. Pull back and then lift up to release the document feeder unit.
NOTE: Complete a shading test and a skew alignment after replacing the document feeder unit.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the DCF right door.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Slightly raise the right door and carefully release the right hinge from the hinge pin.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
4. Open the lower paper feeder door. Lower the right door to 90°, and then rotate the rear side of the door
away from the printer. Slide the door to the rear of the printer to remove it.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
2. Open the DCF right door and slide the hinge pin to the left. Make sure that the pin slides under the tab
(callout 1).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the DCF motor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the DCF pickup motor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the DCF PCA.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the DCF pickup units.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Slightly raise the right door and carefully release the right hinge from the hinge pin.
CAUTION: The hinge is spring-loaded and might snap back forcefully. Raise the door to take the tension
off of the spring, and then hold the hinge firmly while releasing it from the hinge pin.
4. Open the lower paper feeder door. Lower the right door to 90°, and then rotate the rear side of the door
away from the printer. Slide the door to the rear of the printer to remove it.
CAUTION: Do not lower the door more than 90°. This might result in damage to the door.
2. Open the DCF right door and slide the hinge pin to the left. Make sure that the pin slides under the tab
(callout 1).
3. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove the wire harness from the cable guide (callout 2).
Remove eight screws (callout 3).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the bottom HCI tray feed motor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
2. Remove three screws, and then remove the feed drive unit.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the bottom HCI tray pickup motor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the bottom HCI tray PCA.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the bottom HCI tray lift-up motor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the bottom HCI tray shaft motor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the side HCI rear cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the side HCI feed motor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the side HCI pickup motor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the side HCI PCA.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the side HCI lift-up motor.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Turn on the power switch next to the power cable, and then press the power button on the front of the
printer.
○ Verify that all parts are correctly reinstalled and are properly working.
Print any pages necessary to verify that the repair resolved the issue and did not create any new issues.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
● Main parts
● Finishers
● Inner finisher
ENWW 791
For additional service and support information
HP service personnel, go to the Service Access Work Bench (SAW) at http://h41302.www4.hp.com/km/saw/
home.do.
● Printer specifications
● Service advisories
or
partsurfer.hp.com
Order through service or support providers Contact an HP-authorized service or support provider.
Order using the HP Embedded Web Server (EWS) To access, in a supported Web browser on your computer, enter the printer IP
address or host name in the address/URL field. The EWS contains a link to the HP
SureSupply Web site, which provides options for purchasing Original HP supplies.
Orderable parts
Not all of the parts shown in the diagrams in this chapter can be ordered. Refer to the table following the
diagram or the parts lists at the end of this chapter to determine if a part is orderable.
NOTE: In this manual, the abbreviation “PCA” stands for “printed circuit-board assembly.” Components
described as a PCA might consist of a single circuit board or a circuit board plus other parts, such as cables and
sensors.
1 Cassette SAM-JC90-01610A 1
2 Cassette SAM-JC90-01611A 1
3 Cover SAM-JC95-02098A 1
5 HVPS SAM-JC44-00241A 1
7 HDD SAM-JC59-00036A 1
18 Output SAM-JC90–01369A 1
37 Reservoir SAM-JC93-01071A 1
0 Cassette SAM-JC90-01610A 1
0 Cassette SAM-JC90-01611A 1
25 Cover SAM-JC95-02106A 1
1 MP SAM-JC90-01352B 1
14 Spring, ts SAM-JC61-07372A 1
1 MP sub-tray SAM-JC90-01357B 1
2 Photo-interrupter SAM-0604-001393 1
3 Spring, ts SAM-6107-001737 1
6 Spring, cs SAM-6107-001731 4
6 Photo-interrupter SAM-0604–001393 1
17 Fan, dc SAM-JC31-00168A 1
21 Fan SAM-JC31-00146A 1
4 Photo-interrupter SAM-0604-001393 1
6 Spring, cs SAM-6107-002599 1
14 Caster SAM-6109-001138 4
4 E-ring SAM-6044-000125 6
17 Photo-interrupter SAM-0604-001381 1
20 Bush-6, dl SAM-JC61-00884A 2
3 Photo-interrupter SAM-0604-001393 4
7 Caster SAM-6109-001138 4
6 Photo-interrupter SAM-0604-001381 1
16 Bush-6, dl SAM-JC61-00884A 1
28 Belt SAM-JC66-04281A 1
9 Actuator SAM-JC66-04290A 1
2 Photo-interrupter SAM-0604-001490 1
17 Bush-6, dl SAM-JC61-00884A 2
25 Photo-interrupter SAM-0604–001393 2
13 Rail SAM-6102-003369 2
14 Photo-interrupter SAM-0604-001415 1
6 Spring, es SAM-JC61-07414A 2
33 Photo-interrupter SAM-0604-001415 1
43 Solenoid SAM-JC90-01675A 1
44 Motor SAM-JC90-01673A 1
14 Photo-interrupter SAM-0604-001415 1
15 Photo-interrupter SAM-0604-001415 1
10 Spring, ts SAM-JC61-07432A 1
24 E-ring SAM-6044-000125 2
27 Photo-interrupter SAM-0604-001415 1
1 Photo-interrupter SAM-0604-001415 2
Actuator lever, fuser out SAM-JC66-04406A Right door output and takeaway
on page 823
Drive motor, step SAM-JC93-01155A Drive buffer, top lower, and top
jam on page 897
Finisher sub-3 fold mtr SAM-JC90-01396A Three fold motor, curl pawl
motor, curl pawl, and three fold
output on page 889
Finisher sub-3 fold output SAM-JC90-01399A Three fold motor, curl pawl
motor, curl pawl, and three fold
output on page 889
Finisher sub-bkt main blade SAM-JC90-01435A FD stopper unit, jam clear, and
BKT main blade on page 899
Finisher sub-cover f bm SAM-JC90-01478B PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and
paddle on page 917
Finisher sub-fd stopper unit SAM-JC90-01432A FD stopper unit, jam clear, and
BKT main blade on page 899
Finisher sub-guide three fold SAM-JC90-01394A Three fold blade on page 903
Finisher sub-idle fold SAM-JC90-01479A PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and
paddle on page 917
Finisher sub-main blade SAM-JC90-01437A Fold roller, main blade, and top
frame on page 901
Finisher sub-paddle SAM-JC90-01480A PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and
paddle on page 917
Finisher sub-paddle, mid SAM-JC90-01462A PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and
paddle on page 917
Finisher sub-paddle, wing SAM-JC90-01463A PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and
paddle on page 917
Finisher sub-pcb bm SAM-JC90-01477A PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and
paddle on page 917
Finisher sub-top cover SAM-JC90-01446B Door, top door, top cover, and
registration guide on page 905
Finisher sub-top door SAM-JC90-01445B Door, top door, top cover, and
registration guide on page 905
Finisher sub-top frame SAM-JC90-01440A Fold roller, main blade, and top
frame on page 901
Finisher sub-top jam SAM-JC90-01455A Drive buffer, top lower, and top
jam on page 897
Finisher sub-top lower SAM-JC90-01454A Drive buffer, top lower, and top
jam on page 897
Flow ADF cover, open SAM-JC97-04869A Flow ADF open cover on page 829
Flow ADF cover, open lower SAM-JC97-04696B Flow ADF open cover on page 829
Flow ADF pickup, sub SAM-JC97-04650A Flow ADF pickup roller assembly
on page 831
Flow ADF, feed drive motor SAM-JC97-04680A Flow ADF main on page 835
Flow ADF, housing separation roller SAM-JC97-04661A Flow ADF main on page 835
Flow ADF, lift drive SAM-JC97-04679A Flow ADF main on page 835
Flow ADF, main frame sGX (dn models only) SAM-JC97-04882A Flow ADF on page 827
Flow ADF, PCA high SAM-JC92-02964A Flow ADF main on page 835
Flow ADF, pickup release drive SAM-JC97-04681A Flow ADF main on page 835
Flow ADF, release drive scan SAM-JC97-04682A Flow ADF main on page 835
Flow ADF, scan in lower SAM-JC97-04656B Flow ADF main on page 835
Flow ADF, scan out SAM-JC97-04830A Flow ADF main on page 835
Flow ADF, separation cover SAM-JC97-04652A Flow ADF main on page 835
Flow ADF, white simplex roller SAM-JC97-04687A Flow ADF main on page 835
Frame latch, rear sensor assembly SAM-JC93-01124A sHCI frame on page 873
Frame main, pickup roller SAM-JC93-01092A Frame main pickup on page 813
Frame, left cst rail assembly SAM-JC93-01044A DCF frame on page 845
Frame, main pickup roller SAM-JC93-01092A DCF second pickup on page 851
Frame, main pickup roller SAM-JC93-01092A Pickup cover unit on page 871
Frame, right cst rail assembly SAM-JC93-01045A DCF frame on page 845
Guide, top jam SAM-JC61-07196A Drive buffer, top lower, and top
jam on page 897
Harness, 3k finisher output path SAM-JC39-02322A Drive buffer, top lower, and top
jam on page 897
Harness, 3k finisher top cover SAM-JC39-02310A Fold roller, main blade, and top
frame on page 901
Idle holder, one way SAM-JC61-01288A Pickup cover unit on page 871
Main frame rear auto-size holder SAM-JC93-00018A DCF rear frame on page 847
PCA, paper size sensor SAM-JC92-02622A DCF rear frame on page 847
Spring, etc torsion doc (cc2-f) SAM-JC61-00076A HCI cassette on page 857
SAM-JC39-02310A Harness, 3k finisher top cover Fold roller, main blade, and top
frame on page 901
SAM-JC39-02322A Harness, 3k finisher output path Drive buffer, top lower, and top
jam on page 897
SAM-JC61-00076A Spring, etc torsion doc (cc2-f) HCI cassette on page 857
SAM-JC61-01288A Idle holder, one way Pickup cover unit on page 871
SAM-JC61-07196A Guide, top jam Drive buffer, top lower, and top
jam on page 897
SAM-JC66-04406A Actuator lever, fuser out Right door output and takeaway
on page 823
SAM-JC90-01394A Finisher sub-guide three fold Three fold blade on page 903
SAM-JC90-01396A Finisher sub-3 fold mtr Three fold motor, curl pawl
motor, curl pawl, and three fold
output on page 889
SAM-JC90-01399A Finisher sub-3 fold output Three fold motor, curl pawl
motor, curl pawl, and three fold
output on page 889
SAM-JC90-01432A Finisher sub-fd stopper unit FD stopper unit, jam clear, and
BKT main blade on page 899
SAM-JC90-01435A Finisher sub-bkt main blade FD stopper unit, jam clear, and
BKT main blade on page 899
SAM-JC90-01437A Finisher sub-main blade Fold roller, main blade, and top
frame on page 901
SAM-JC90-01440A Finisher sub-top frame Fold roller, main blade, and top
frame on page 901
SAM-JC90-01445B Finisher sub-top door Door, top door, top cover, and
registration guide on page 905
SAM-JC90-01446B Finisher sub-top cover Door, top door, top cover, and
registration guide on page 905
SAM-JC90-01454A Finisher sub-top lower Drive buffer, top lower, and top
jam on page 897
SAM-JC90-01455A Finisher sub-top jam Drive buffer, top lower, and top
jam on page 897
SAM-JC90-01462A Finisher sub-paddle, mid PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and
paddle on page 917
SAM-JC90-01463A Finisher sub-paddle, wing PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and
paddle on page 917
SAM-JC90-01477A Finisher sub-pcb bm PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and
paddle on page 917
SAM-JC90-01478B Finisher sub-cover f bm PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and
paddle on page 917
SAM-JC90-01479A Finisher sub-idle fold PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and
paddle on page 917
SAM-JC90-01480A Finisher sub-paddle PCB bm, cover f bm, idle fold, and
paddle on page 917
SAM-JC92-02622A PCA, paper size sensor DCF rear frame on page 847
SAM-JC92-02964A Flow ADF, PCA high Flow ADF main on page 835
SAM-JC93-00018A Main frame rear auto-size holder DCF rear frame on page 847
SAM-JC93-01044A Frame, left cst rail assembly DCF frame on page 845
SAM-JC93-01045A Frame, right cst rail assembly DCF frame on page 845
SAM-JC93-01092A Frame main, pickup roller Frame main pickup on page 813
SAM-JC93-01092A Frame, main pickup roller DCF second pickup on page 851
SAM-JC93-01092A Frame, main pickup roller Pickup cover unit on page 871
SAM-JC93-01124A Frame latch, rear sensor assembly sHCI frame on page 873
SAM-JC93-01155A Drive motor, step Drive buffer, top lower, and top
jam on page 897
SAM-JC97-04650A Flow ADF pickup, sub Flow ADF pickup roller assembly
on page 831
SAM-JC97-04652A Flow ADF, separation cover Flow ADF main on page 835
SAM-JC97-04656B Flow ADF, scan in lower Flow ADF main on page 835
SAM-JC97-04661A Flow ADF, housing separation roller Flow ADF main on page 835
SAM-JC97-04679A Flow ADF, lift drive Flow ADF main on page 835
SAM-JC97-04680A Flow ADF, feed drive motor Flow ADF main on page 835
SAM-JC97-04681A Flow ADF, pickup release drive Flow ADF main on page 835
SAM-JC97-04682A Flow ADF, release drive scan Flow ADF main on page 835
SAM-JC97-04687A Flow ADF, white simplex roller Flow ADF main on page 835
SAM-JC97-04696B Flow ADF cover, open lower Flow ADF open cover on page 829
SAM-JC97-04830A Flow ADF, scan out Flow ADF main on page 835
SAM-JC97-04869A Flow ADF cover, open Flow ADF open cover on page 829
SAM-JC97-04882A Flow ADF, main frame sGX (dn models only) Flow ADF on page 827
● Troubleshooting process
ENWW 973
Troubleshooting process
Determine the problem source
When the printer malfunctions or encounters an unexpected situation, the printer control panel alerts you to the
situation. This section contains a pre-troubleshooting checklist to filter out many possible causes of the problem.
A troubleshooting flowchart helps you diagnose the root cause of the problem. The remainder of this chapter
provides steps for correcting problems.
● Use the troubleshooting flowchart to pinpoint the root cause of hardware malfunctions. The flowchart
guides you to the section of this chapter that contains steps for correcting the malfunction.
NOTE: The customer or service provider is responsible for checking supplies and for using supplies that are in
good condition.
Power subsystem
Power-on checks
The basic printer functions should start up when the printer is connected into an electrical outlet and the power
switch is pushed to the on position. If the printer does not start, use the information in this section to isolate and
solve the problem.
If the control-panel display remains blank, random patterns display, or asterisks remain on the control-panel
display, perform power-on checks to find the cause of the problem.
During normal operation, a cooling fan begins to spin briefly after the printer power is turned on. Place your hand
over the vents at the rear of the printer, next to the formatter, or on the on the rear of the scanner. If the fan is
operating, you will feel air passing out of the printer. You can lean close to the printer and hear the fan operating.
A fan begins to blow on the right door (fuser), and then the control panel goes through a series of set up
functions. The main motor turns on (unless the left door or cartridge access door is open, a jam condition is
sensed, or the paper-path sensors are damaged). You might be able to visually and audibly determine if the
main motor is turned on.
If the fan and main motor are operating correctly, the next troubleshooting step is to isolate print engine,
formatter, and control panel problems.
If the control panel is blank 1 minute after turning on the printer, check the following items:
1. Make sure that the printer is connected directly into an active electrical outlet (not a power strip) that
delivers the correct voltage.
2. Make sure that the power switch is in the on position, and then verify that the LED is on.
3. Make sure that the fan runs briefly, which indicates that the power supply is operational.
6. Remove any external solutions, and then try to turn the printer on again.
Customers usually report that the control-panel display is not showing anything. It is very important to collect as
much information as possible from the customer about the issue to help resolve it.
● The control Panel is blank (LEDs are on or flashing) and the back light is on (but no text visible).
● The formatter connector(s) are not fully seated into the connector(s) on the DC controller, or the
connectors are not fully seated on the formatter.
● A faulty component is installed on the formatter (for example a memory DIMM, fax PCA, network PCA, USB
device, or other component).
● The control panel connector is not fully seated, or the control panel is defective.
● Was the printer newly install or has the printer been properly functioning?
– For a new install, investigate to see if there was any shipping damage to the printer.
– Did the customer notice any damage to the shipping box or any visible damage to the printer?
– Did the customer recently add a memory DIMM or install a third-party component?
– Is the control-panel display completely blank (might be faint text and no back light)?
– Has a print job been sent to the printer? The customer might report that their print jobs seemed to
print but when they go to the printer the control-panel display is blank.
If the control-panel display is completely blank (no LEDs illuminated or no back light) check to see if the printer is
getting power. Listen for fans or any printer initialization sounds when the power is turned on.
1. Make sure that the printer is plugged directly into an active electrical outlet (not a power strip or
interruptible power supply) that delivers the correct voltage.
2. Turn the printer power on, and make sure that the fan(s) run briefly (this indicates that the power supply is
operational).
3. Check if the yellow LED on formatter is flashing. If so, there is a communication issue between the
formatter and the control panel.
5. Make sure that the control-panel display wire harness (and/or flat cable) is properly connected (and fully
seated), and then turn the printer power on again.
6. Check control panel diagnostics by pressing the button on the back of the control panel to run different
diagnostic tests.
7. Verify the status LEDs are illuminated, but the control-panel display is blank. If applicable: Check if the
contrast setting is adjusted to very low. If so, try turning the contrast knob to see if the control-panel
display becomes visible.
NOTE: If the print job correctly prints, then the problem is most likely to a defective control panel.
9. Turn the printer power off, and then make sure that the memory DIMM is installed in the correct slot and is
fully seated.
NOTE: For some printers, there may be more than one memory DIMM installed. Some printers have third-
party solutions/applications or fonts that use memory.
10. Remove all of the components/accessories installed on the formatter (for example, hard drive, solid-state
drive, memory DIMM(s), fax PCA, network PCA, USB devices, or other devices).
IMPORTANT: This is important because the formatter or a component on the formatter might be
defective or shorted, which causes the printer to lose power.
11. Reinstall the formatter. Make sure that it makes a good connection and is fully seated.
Make sure that all of the connectors on the formatter are correctly connected and fully seated.
12. Turn the printer power on, and then check the control-panel display.
13. If the printer control panel is properly working, replace each removed component (one at a time) to
determine which one is causing the problem.
14. If the control-panel display is still blank after performing the above troubleshooting steps, and the control
panel diagnostics do not function, replace the control panel. If the control panel diagnostics are
functioning, then replace the formatter.
Use the flowcharts in this section to troubleshoot the following control panel problems.
NOTE: To open the diagnostic function, press the button on the back of the control panel.
Replace the
control panel.
NOTE: To open the diagnostic function, press the button on the back of the control panel.
Open the
diagnostic function.
Perform the
touch test.
Y
Turn the product
power off,
and then
on again.
NOTE: To open the diagnostic function, press the button on the back of the control panel.
Control panel
has no
sound
Can sounds
be heard?
N
Y
Open the
diagnostic function.
Perform the sound test.
Can sounds
be heard?
Y
N
Do not replace the
control panel.
Turn the product power off.
Remove the control panel.
Check the cables to the speaker.
Replace the control panel. N Reseat the cables to the speaker.
Turn the product power on.
Can sounds be heard?
NOTE: To open the diagnostic function, press the button on the back of the control panel.
Open the
diagnostic function.
Perform the Home
button test.
Open the
diagnostic function.
Perform the
Home button test.
Figure 5-5 Hardware integration pocket (HIP) is not functioning (control panel functional)
Hardware integration
pocket (HIP)
not functional
(control panel
functional)
LED, engine, and individual diagnostics can identify and troubleshoot printer problems.
Three LEDs on the formatter indicate that the printer is functioning correctly.
1 Heartbeat LED
2 HP Jetdirect LEDs
The embedded HP Jetdirect print server has two LEDs. The yellow LED indicates network activity, and the green
LED indicates the link status. A blinking yellow LED indicates network traffic. If the green LED is off, a link has
failed.
For link failures, check all the network cable connections. In addition, try to manually configure the link settings
on the embedded print server by using the printer control-panel menus.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, select Settings.
● Networking
● Ethernet
● Link Speed
The printer contains extensive internal engine diagnostics that help in troubleshooting print quality, paper path,
noise, assembly, and timing issues.
Defeating interlocks
Different tests can be used to isolate different types of issues. For assembly or noise isolation, run the diagnostic
test when the toner cartridge door or right door is open.
Defeating the door interlocks allows observation of the paper pick operation (and view the page enter
registration).
WARNING! Be careful when performing printer diagnostics to avoid risk of injury. Only trained service personnel
should open and run the diagnostics with a door open. Never touch any of the power supplies when the printer is
turned on.
TIP: Fold a stiff piece of paper, for example a business card or index card, into two 10 mm (.375 in) strips,
and insert the strips into the slot for the cartridge door logic switches.
TIP: Fold a stiff piece of paper, for example a business card or index card, into two 10 mm (.375 in) strips,
and insert the strips into the slot for the front door logic switches.
Use the procedure below to test various printer mechanical and electromechanical assemblies.
NOTE: The cartridge door interlocks must be defeated to run the component tests.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Support Tools button.
● Continuous Scan
● Step 8: Test the Plug and Print USB Drive printing functionality
● Make sure that the power cable is connected to the printer and the outlet.
● Check the power source by connecting the power cable to a different outlet.
2. If the printer motors do not rotate, make sure that the toner cartridges are installed and that the doors are
all closed. The control panel displays messages to indicate these problems.
Print a supplies status page to ensure that the supplies are not at or over end of life.
NOTE: HP long-life consumable and maintenance kit life specifications are estimations. Actual individual life or
yield during normal use will vary depending on usage, environment, media, and other factors. Estimated life is
not an implied warranty.
2. Open the Reports menu, touch the Configuration/Status Pages menu, select the Configuration Page item,
and then touch the Print button to print the report.
3. If the report does not print, make sure that paper is loaded in the tray, and check the control panel to see if
paper is jammed inside the printer.
NOTE: Make sure that the paper in the tray meets specifications for this printer.
2. Place the configuration page onto the scanner glass and make a copy.
3. If the print quality on the copied pages is not acceptable, clean the scanner glass and the small glass strip.
2. Open the Troubleshooting menu, and then open the Diagnostics Tools menu. Touch the Run Fax Test
button to test the fax functionality.
3. Touch the Fax on the printer control panel, and then touch the Start Fax button.
2. Touch the Troubleshooting menu, and then open the Diagnostics Tests menu. Touch the Run Fax Test
button to test the fax functionality.
2. If the job does not print, make sure that you selected the correct printer driver.
Step 8: Test the Plug and Print USB Drive printing functionality
1. Load a .PDF document or .JPEG photo onto a USB flash drive, and insert it in the USB port near the control
panel.
2. The USB Flash Drive menu opens. Try printing the document or photo.
● The software program that you are using and its settings
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Reports button.
TIP: Multiple report pages can be selected, and then printed together.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Reports button.
TIP: Multiple report pages can be selected, and then printed together.
Print the event log from the Reports menu from a touchscreen control panel
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Support Tools button.
● Troubleshooting
● Event Log
3. The event log displays on the screen. To print it, touch the Print button.
Print the event log from the Service menu from a touchscreen control panel
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Support Tools button.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Support Tools button.
3. On the sign-in screen, select the Service Access Code option from the drop-down list.
CAUTION: The Format Disk option (printers with a hard-disk drive only) performs a disk initialization for the
entire disk. The operating system, firmware files, and third party files (among other files) will be completely lost.
HP does not recommend this action.
TIP: The Pre-boot menu can be remotely accessed by using a telnet network protocol to establish an
administration connection to the printer. See Remote Admin on page 1002.
1. Touch the middle of the control-panel display when you see the 1/8 under the logo.
1 2
Not used.
Cold reset using the Pre-boot menu from a touchscreen control panel
CAUTION: This procedure resets all printer configurations and settings to factory defaults (customer
configurations and settings are lost).
1. Touch the middle of the control-panel display when you see the 1/8 under the logo.
1 2
2. Use the button to highlight the +3:Administrator item, and then touch the OK button.
3. Use the button to highlight the +8:Startup Options item, and then touch the OK button.
4. Use the button to highlight the 2 Cold Reset item, and then touch the OK button to select it.
5. Touch the Home button to return to the main Pre-boot menu and highlight the 1:Continue item, and then
touch the OK button.
NOTE: Some of the pre-boot options in the following tables are not supported by the current version of the
printer firmware and are included for information only. Future versions of firmware will support these options.
Continue Selecting the Continue item exits the Pre-boot menu and
continues the normal boot process.
USB Thumbdrive
Format Disk This item reinitializes the disk and cleans all disk partitions.
Partial Clean This item reinitializes the disk (removing all data except the
firmware repository where the master firmware bundle is
downloaded and saved).
Change Password Select this item to set or change the administrator password.
Clear Password Select the Clear Password item to remove a password from
the Administrator menu. Before the password is actually
cleared, a message will be shown asking to confirm that the
password should be cleared. Press the OK button to confirm
the action.
Administrator Manage Disk Clear disk Select the Clear disk item to enable using an external device
for job storage. Job storage is normally enabled only for the
(continued) Boot device. This will be grayed out unless the 99.09.68 error
is displayed.
Lock Disk Select the Lock Disk item to lock (mate) a new secure disk to
this printer.
The data stored on the secure disk locked to this printer always
remains accessible to this printer.
Leave Unlocked Select the Leave Unlocked item to use a new secure disk in an
unlocked mode for a single service event. The secure disk that
is already locked to this printer will remain accessible to this
printer and uses the old disk's encryption password with the
new disk.
Clear Disk Pwd Select the Clear Disk Pwd item to continue using the non-
secure disk and clear the password associated with the yet-to-
be installed secure disk.
Retain Password Select the Retain Password item to use the non-secure disk for
this session only, and then search for the missing secure disk
in future sessions.
Boot Device Secure Erase Select the Secure Erase item to erase all of the data on the disk
and unlock it if required.
NOTE: The system will be unusable until the system files are
reinstalled. The ATA secure-erase command is a one-pass
overwrite, which erases the entire disk including firmware. The
disk remains an encrypted disk.
NOTE: The system will be unusable until the system files are
reinstalled. It erases the encryption key. The encryption key is
erased, so the disk becomes a non-encrypted disk.
Get Status This item provides disk status information if any is available.
Administrator Manage Disk Internal Device Select the Internal Device item to erase the internal device or
get a status about the internal device.
(continued) (continued)
Secure Erase Select the Secure Erase item to erase all of the data on the
disk and unlock it if required.
NOTE: The system will be unusable until the system files are
reinstalled. The ATA secure-erase command erases the entire
disk, including firmware. The disk remains an encrypted disk.
NOTE: The system will be unusable until the system files are
reinstalled. The HP High Performance Secure Hard Disk is
erased.
Get Status This item provides disk status information if any is available.
External Device Select the External Device item to erase the external device or
get status about the external device.
Secure Erase Select the Secure Erase item to erase all of the data on the
disk and unlock it if required.
NOTE: The system will be unusable until the system files are
reinstalled.
NOTE: The system will be unusable until the system files are
reinstalled. The encryption key is erased, so the disk becomes
a non-encrypted disk.
Get Status This item provides disk status information if any is available.
Administrator Configure LAN IP Mode [DHCP] The network can be configured to obtain the network
settings from a DHCP server or as static.
(continued) NOTE: This
configuration is only Use this item for automatic IP address acquisition from the
active when the Pre- DHCP server.
boot menu is open.
IP Mode [STATIC] Use this item to manually assign the network addresses.
Subnet Mask Use this item to manually enter the subnet mask.
Default Gateway Use this item to manually enter the default gateway.
Administrator Startup Options Select the Startup Options item to specify options that can
be set for the next time the printer is turned on and
(continued) initializes to the Ready state.
Show Revision Not currently functional: Select the Show Revision item to
allow the printer to initialize and show the firmware version
when the printer reaches the Ready state.
Once the printer power is turned on the next time, the Show
Revision item is unchecked so that the firmware revision is
not shown.
Cold Reset Select the Cold Reset item to clear the IP address and all
customer settings. (This item also returns all settings to
factory defaults.)
Skip Disk Load Select the Skip Disk Load item to disable installed third-
party applications.
Skip Cal Select the Skip Cal item to skip the printer calibration for the
very next power-initialization cycle only.
Lock Service CAUTION: Select the Lock Service item to lock the Service
menu access (both in the Pre-boot menu and the Device
Maintenance menu).
Administrator Startup Options First Power Not currently functional: This item allows the printer to
initialize as if it is the first time it has been turned on.
(continued) (continued)
For example, the user is prompted to configure first-time
settings like date/time, language, and other settings.
Select this item so that it is enabled for the next time the
printer power is turned on.
When the printer power is turned on the next time, this item
is unchecked so that the pre-configured settings are used
during configuration, and the first-time setting prompt is not
used.
Embedded Jetdirect Select the Embedded Jetdirect Off item to disable the
Off embedded HP Jetdirect.
WiFi Accessory Select the WiFi Accessory item to enable the wireless
accessory.
Memory Do Not Run Use the Do Not Run item to exclude the
Memory diagnostic when executing multiple
diagnostics.
Disk Do Not Run Use the Do Not Run item to exclude the Disk
diagnostic when executing multiple
diagnostics.
Administrator Remote Admin Start Telnet The Remote Admin item allows a service technician to
access to the printer Pre-boot menu remotely, and to
(continued) navigate the menu selections from a remote location.
Stop Telnet
Refresh IP
System Triage Copy Logs If the device will not boot to the Ready state, or the
diagnostic log feature found in the Troubleshooting menu
is not accessible, then use the System Triage item to copy
the diagnostic logs to a USB flash drive at the next printer
start up.
Change Svc PWD Use this item to change the Service menu personal
identification number (PIN).
Reset Svc PWD If the Service menu personal identification number (PIN)
has been changed. Use this item to reset it to the original
PIN.
Service Tools Reset Password Use this item to reset the Pre-boot administrator
password.
IMPORTANT: While the Remote Admin function allows remote access the Pre-boot menu, for security reasons
the Remote Admin connection must be initiated by a person that is physically present at the printer.
Before using the Remote Admin feature, make sure that the telnet network protocol is installed, and enabled, on
the remote telnet client computer.
NOTE: This section describes enabling and configuring the telnet feature for computers using a Windows®
operating system.
HP recommends that the telnet client computer be a Windows based system, however, there are other
operating systems that support the telnet network protocol. For information about enabling and configuring the
telnet network protocol for other operating systems, see the owner's manual for that operating system.
All computers using the Windows operating system have the telnet client installed, however, the telnet client
function might not be enabled by default.
NOTE: The figures and menus in this section are for the Windows 7 Enterprise® operating system. Screens and
menu selections might vary slightly for other operating systems.
1. Use the Start menu to open the Control Panel, and then click the Programs item to select it.
TIP: If the check box is already checked then the telnet client function is already enabled. Click the Cancel
button.
Network connection
The remote telnet client computer must have direct network access to the printer for the Remote Admin
function to operate. This means that the telnet client computer must be on the same network as the printer. The
Remote Admin function cannot be accessed through a network firewall or other remote access network security
programs.
If a private network is not accessible, ask the network administrator to set up a virtual private network (VPN)
connection to the network.
For security reasons the Remote Admin feature must be initiated by a person that is physically present at the
printer. The following steps must be performed by a person that is physically present at the printer.
NOTE: This person might need to sign in with an administrator or service password depending on how the
printer is configured.
2. The HP logo displays on the printer control panel. When a "1/8" with an underscore displays, touch the
middle of the screen to open the Pre-boot menu.
4. Use the arrow buttons on the touchscreen to scroll down and highlight the +A:Remote Admin item, and
then touch the OK button to select it.
5. Use the arrow buttons on the touchscreen to scroll down and highlight the 1:Start Telnet item, and then
touch the OK button to select it.
● If an error message displays, use the steps below to identify the problem.
○ The printer should be configured to use a static IP address, but is configured to use DHCP
instead.
○ The printer is configured to use a static IP address, but the IP address is incorrect.
c. The printer is correctly configured to use DHCP, but the DHCP server is not turned on or is
malfunctioning.
7. When the printer telnet server function is initialized, the following screen appears. Use the information on
this screen to connect the remote telnet client computer to the printer.
NOTE: The printer is now ready to receive remote telnet client commands.
The following steps establish a Remote Admin connection from a remote computer to the printer.
1. From the Start menu click Run to open a dialog box, type cmd in the Open field, and then click the OK
button to open a Windows command window.
2. From any displayed directory, type telnet at the prompt, and then press the Enter key.
3. Type o <IP ADDRESS> at the telnet prompt, and then press the Enter key.
NOTE: For <IP ADDRESS>, substitute the IP address that was displayed in step 7 in Start the telnet
server function at the printer on page 1004.
TIP: If the telnet connection fails to establish a connection, the printer is probably behind a firewall or on a
different network that the remote telnet client computer. See Network connection on page 1004.
IMPORTANT: Make sure to type the PIN correctly. After five incorrect PIN entries, the printer terminates
the Remote Admin connection. The Remote Admin feature must be re-initiated at the printer. See Start the
telnet server function at the printer on page 1004.
5. The following screen displays when the correct PIN is entered and the Remote Admin connection is
successful. For information about the Pre-boot menu and options, see Pre-boot menu options
on page 993.
NOTE: Because a Remote Admin connection is an unsecure telnet network protocol connection, the
following Pre-boot menu items are disabled for the remote telnet client computer.
The Remote Admin connection can be terminated from the printer control panel or the remote telnet client
computer.
NOTE: The following procedure describes terminating a Remote Admin connection from the remote telnet
client computer.
2. Use the arrow buttons on the keyboard to scroll down to the +A:Remote Admin item, and then press the
Enter key.
3. Use the arrow buttons on the keyboard to scroll down to the 2:Stop Telnet item, and then press the Enter
key. The Remote Admin connection between the printer and the remote telnet client computer terminates.
IMPORTANT: The printer remains in the Pre-boot menu. Have the person that is physically present at the
printer do the following:
● Touch the Home button to return to the main Pre-boot menu and highlight the 1:Continue item, and
then touch the OK button. The printer will continue to initialize.
● Reports menu
● Settings menu
● Print menu
● Supplies menu
● Trays menu
● Troubleshooting menu
● Maintenance menu
Reports menu
To display: At the printer control panel, select Reports.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
Configuration/Status Pages Settings Menu Map Print Shows a map of the entire control
panel system and the selected
View values for each setting.
Web Services Status Page Print Shows the detected Web Services
for the printer.
View
Color Usage Job Log Print Shows color jobs completed by the
printer.
View
Fax Reports (MFP fax models only) Fax Activity Log Print Contains a list of the faxes that have
been sent from or received by this
View printer.
Speed Dial List Print Shows the speed dials that have
been set up for this printer.
View
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
General Date/Time Date/Time Format Date Format DD/MMM/YYYY Use the Date/Time
Settings Settings menu to
MMM/DD/YYYY specify the date
and time and to
YYYY/MMM/DD configure date/
time settings.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Sleep Settings Auto Off After Range: 1 to 110 Set the number of
Sleep minutes minutes after
which the printer
Sleep After Default = 0 minutes enters Sleep or
Inactivity Auto Off mode.
Touch the existing
HP Auto Off/Auto number to open
On the virtual keypad,
and then increase
Shut Down or decrease the
number of
minutes.
Display Settings Display Brightness Automatic* The Manual setting Use to specify the
uses a slider to intensity of the LCD
Manual manually control the control panel
display brightness. display.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
NOTE: When
using this option, if
the printer runs out
of paper and the
job is being printed
on both sides,
some pages can be
lost.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Manage Stored Job Sort Order Job Name* This option allows
Jobs you list the jobs
Date either
alphabetically or
chronologically.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
The Temporary
Stored Job
Retention feature
specifies the
number of
temporary jobs
that can be stored
on the printer. The
maximum allowed
value is 300.
The Temporary
Stored Job
Retention feature
specifies the
number of
standard jobs that
can be stored on
the printer. The
maximum allowed
value is 300.
Default = 14
inches
Disabled
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Top right
Standard bin
Upper bin
Middle bin
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Standard: Tray
numbering is based
on newer HP
LaserJet models.
Classic: Tray
numbering is based
on HP LaserJet 4
and older models.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Midtones
Shadows
Cyan
Magenta
Yellow
Black
Tray 3
Tray 4
Tray 5
Depends upon
number of trays
installed
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Sense transparency
ony
Sense transparency
only
Heavy paper
Envelope control
Tray 1
Background
Background 1
Uniformity Control
Tracking Control
Registration
Transfer Control
Moisture Control
Reset Optimize
Light
Normal
Maximum
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Exclusively: The
printer never
selects a different
tray when the user
has indicated that a
specific tray should
be used, even if
that tray is empty.
Always: A prompt
always displays
before using the
multipurpose tray.
Unless loaded: A
message displays
only if the
multipurpose tray
is empty.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Do not display:
Prevents the tray
configuration
message from
automatically
appearing.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Auto: Enables
Smart Duplexing,
which instructs the
printer not to
process blank
pages.
Yes: Disables
Smart Duplexing
and forces the
duplexer to flip the
sheet of paper
even if it is printed
on only one side.
This might be
preferable for
certain jobs that
use paper types
such as letterhead
or prepunched
paper.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Require preview
Previews are
required for all
users.
Disable preview:
Previews are
disabled for all
users.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
JPEG is a good
choice for most
graphics. Most
computers have a
browser that can
view .JPEG files.
This file type
produces one file
per page.
TIFF is a standard
file format that
many graphics
programs support.
This file type
produces one file
per page.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Manually Adjust:
Use to manually
optimize the
setting for text or
for pictures.
Text: Use to
optimize the text
portion of the copy
when text and/or
pictures are on the
original.
Photograph: Best
suited for making
copies of printed
pictures.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Black/Gray Automatically
detect:
Black Automatically
scans documents
in color if at least
one page has color.
Color: Scans
documents in color.
Black/Gray: Scans
documents in
grayscale.
Black: Scans
documents in black
and white with a
compressed file
size.
Print: Select to
print the
notification at this
printer.
E-mail: Select to
receive the
notification to an
email account.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Adjust the
Darkness setting to
increase or
decrease the
amount of white
and black in the
colors.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Pulse
Default = 5 minutes
Medium
Slow
Dialing Prefix
Default = 2
Default = 3
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Fax Receive Fax Receive Setup Ringer Volume Off Use to configure
Settings settings for
Low* receiving faxes.
High
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Default = 1
Medium
Slow
Default = 600 ms
Default = 68hz
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Add blocked
numbers: Enter a
fax number into
the Fax Number to
Block field, and
then touch the
arrow button to
add a new number
to the blocked fax
list.
To remove blocked
numbers: Select a
number and touch
the Delete button
to delete it from
the blocked fax list.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Standard bin
Upper bin
Middle bin
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Manage Supplies Low Warning Black Cartridge 1-100% Set the estimated
Thresholds percentage at
Cyan Cartridge Default = 5% which the printer
notifies you when a
Magenta toner cartridge is
Cartridge very low.
Yellow Cartridge
Fuser Kit
Document Feeder
Kit
Staples Stop
Prompt to continue
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Function Separator
Job Offset On
Off
No: A security
settings page is not
printed.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
DHCP (Dynamic
Host Configuration
Protocol): Use for
automatic
configuration from
a DHCPv4 server. If
selected and a
DHCP lease exists,
the DHCP Release
menu and the
DHCP Renew menu
are available to set
DHCP lease
options.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
NOTE: This
feature assigns a
static IP address
that might
interfere with a
managed network.
Legacy: The
address
192.0.0.192 is set,
consistent with
older HP Jetdirect
printers.
Off: IPv6 is
disabled.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
Router Unavailable:
If a router is not
available, the print
server should
attempt to obtain
its stateful
configuration from
a DHCPv6 server.
Always: Whether a
router is available,
the print server
always attempts to
obtain its stateful
configuration from
a DHCPv6 server.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Fifth level Values Description
To specify a proxy
server, enter its
IPv4 address or
fully-qualified
domain name. The
name can be up to
255 octets.
For some
networks, you
might need to
contact your
Internet Service
Provider (ISP) for
the proxy server
address.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
Save
2-sided
2-sided
Original Size Select from a list of sizes Describes the page size of
that the printer supports. the original document.
Paper Selection Paper Size For the best color and image
quality, select the
Paper Type appropriate paper type from
the control panel menu or
Paper Tray from the print driver.
Optimize Text/Picture Manually Adjust* Optimize For: Optimizes the output for a
particular type of content.
Text You can optimize the output
for text, printed pictures, or
Mixed a mixture.
Erase Edges Front Side Use inches Use this menu item to
remove blemishes, such as
Apply same width to all dark borders or staple
edges marks, by cleaning the
specified edges of the
Top edge scanned image. In each of
the text boxes enter the
Bottom edge measurements, in
millimeters or inches, for
Left edge how much of the top edge,
bottom edge, left edge, and
Right edge
right edge to clean.
Top edge
Bottom edge
Left edge
Right edge
Standard bin
Upper bin
Middle bin
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
Scan to Email
Color: Scans
documents in color.
Black/Gray: Scans
documents in
grayscale.
Black: Scans
documents in black
and white with a
compressed file size.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Optimize Text/Picture
Automatically
Straighten
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
E-mail: Select to
receive the notification
to an email account.
Job Name
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Color: Scans
documents in color.
Black/Gray: Scans
documents in
grayscale.
Black: Scans
documents in black
and white with a
compressed file size.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Photograph: Best
suited for making
copies of printed
pictures.
Automatically
Straighten
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
E-mail: Select to
receive the notification
to an email account.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Job Name
Scan to SharePoint
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
Dialing Prefix
Fax Recipients
Original Size Select from a list of sizes Use to describe the page
that the printer supports. size of the original
document.
Optimize Text/Picture Manually Adjust* Optimize For: Optimizes the output for a
particular type of content.
Text You can optimize the output
for text, printed pictures, or
Printed picture a mixture.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
Print from Job Storage Stored Job to Print Untitled Print a job stored on the printer.
Stored Faxes
Print from USB Drive Stored Job to Print Choose file to print on USB drive. Print a job stored on a USB drive.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
Supplies Summary
Fuser Kit
Stapler 1
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
Tray 1 Size Select paper size from a list of Choose the paper size for the tray
supported sizes.
Tray 2–x
Type Select paper type from a list of Choose the paper type for the tray.
supported types.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
● Configuration
Page
● How to
Connect Page
● Supplies
Status Page
● sage Page
● File Directory
Page
● Web Services
Status Page
● Color Usage
Job Log
Reports
● RGB Samples
● CMYK Samples
● PS Font List
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Fax (Fax is optional) Fax T.30 Trace Print T.30 Report Print Use to print or
configure the fax T.
30 trace report. T.30
is the standard that
specifies
handshaking,
protocols, and error
correction between
fax machines.
Print Quality Pages Print Fuser Test Print Use to print pages
Page that help you
resolve problems
with print quality.
Diagnostic Tests
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Maintenance menu
Backup/Restore menu
To display: At the product control panel, select Support Tools and then Maintenance, and then select the Backup/
Restore menu.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
Backup Now
Calibration/Cleaning menu
To display: At the product control panel, select the Maintenance menu, and then select the Calibrate/Cleaning
menu.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
To display: At the product control panel, select the Maintenance menu, and then select the USB Firmware
Upgrade menu.
Insert a USB storage device with a firmware upgrade bundle into the USB port, and follow the on-screen
instructions.
CAUTION: To avoid tearing the document, remove the jammed original slowly and gently.
NOTE: To prevent document jams, use the scanner glass for thick, thin, or mixed paper-type originals.
6. Close the Flow ADF cover and the Flow ADF input tray.
CAUTION: The fuser area is hot. Use caution when removing paper from the printer.
NOTE: To avoid tearing the paper, pull the jammed paper out slowly and gently. The following steps
describe how to clear the jam.
3. Remove Tray 2 or 3.
5. Insert Tray 2 or 3 back into the machine until it is firmly seated. Printing automatically resumes.
Close the dual cassette feeder right bottom door. If there is no paper in this area, go to step 3.
3. Remove Tray 4 or 5.
5. Insert Tray 4 or 5 back into the machine until it is firmly seated. Printing automatically resumes.
1. If the paper is not feeding properly, pull the paper out of the machine.
CAUTION: The fuser area is hot. Use caution when removing paper from the machine.
CAUTION: The fuser area is hot. Use caution when removing paper from the machine.
CAUTION: The fuser area is hot. Use caution when removing paper from the machine.
2. Open the fuser cover. Remove the jammed paper by gently pulling it straight out.
If the paper jam persists, make sure the bin full sensor is unfolded. The bin full sensor is located in front of
the output tray.
1. From the control panel, select Support tools and then Service.
▲ ID: 04082517
TCU
Fuser
Tray x rollers
Finisher Version
Scanner Version
Tray 2 Version
Tray 3 Version
Tray 4 Version
Tray 5 Version
Tray 6 Version
EP Version
Fuser Version
TR Version
Toner Version
Fuser
Tray x rollers
Manual Adjustment
Manual Adjustment
Details
90 degrees
180 degrees
Information
General
Supply status
Customer replacement unit (CRU)
In this menu, there are five columns: Item, Threshold, Status, Count, and Maximum Life.
● Status: This column shows the current status of the selected item.
– OK: The current count is smaller than the default warning value.
– Check: The current count is bigger than the default warning value.
● Count: This column shows the current count of the selected item.
● Maximum Life: This column shows the maximum capacity of the selected item.
The technician can edit the default warning value within the given threshold.
Selecting some items will enable the reset button to reset the current count to zero after replacing the unit.
Software version
This menu displays reports that can be printed from the system. The following reports are available to print:
● Supplies Information
This report shows a history of execution of the TRC control. The TRC control preserves color consistency against
changes in supplies resulting from long-time use and environmental change. The purpose of the history report is
to check if the TRC control is working normally.
● If the TRC control performs normally, Pass count must be a non-zero value and Fail count must be zero.
Maintenance counts
Part replacement count
Operation procedure When the main NVM Read/Write window displays, users can navigate through the list of
codes with descriptions and saved values.
Users can also input a code through the text box to find a configuration value directly.
After selecting one value, press the Edit button to open an interface for user input.
Operation procedure When the main Engine Test Routines window displays, users can navigate through the
list of routines and descriptions that display. Users can directly input an EDC code
through the text box to search for a routine. A maximum of three routines can be
selected at the same time.
After selecting one or more routines, press the OK button to open the test window. The
selected routines will display and users can start/start the selected test routine.
Verification N/A
Specification N/A
Reference N/A
100-0049 K OPC Motor Ready Detects if black OPC BLDC motor is running at
normal speed
100-0141 Duplex Motor Forward Slow Duplex motor forward slow on/off
100-0142 Duplex Motor Forward Slowest Duplex motor forward slowest on/off
100-0180 Duplex Fan 1 Run Ready Detects if duplex fan 1 is running at normal speed
100-0200 Transfer Assembly Elevating Motor Transfer assembly elevate motor on/off
100-0251 PTB TCU Full Sensor Detect level of a PTB TCU bottle
100-0270 LVPS Fan Run Ready Detects if LVPS fan is running at normal speed
100-0491 Duplex 2 Motor Forward Slow Duplex motor forward slow is on/off
100-0492 Duplex 2 Motor Forward Slowest Duplex motor forward slowest is on/off
100-0601 Return Motor Forward Slow Return motor forward slow is on/off
100-0602 Return Motor Forward Slowest Return motor forward slowest is on/off
100-0604 Return Motor Reverse Slow Return motor reverse slow is on/off
100-0605 Return Motor Reverse Slowest Return motor reverse slowest is on/off
101-0101 Tray 4 Shift Gate Solenoid Tray 4 shift gate solenoid on/off
101-0151 Tray 5 Feed Motor Slow Tray 5 feed motor slow on/off
101-0152 Tray 5 Feed Motor Slowest Tray 5 feed motor slowest on/off
101-0161 Tray 6 Feed Motor Slow Tray 6 feed motor slow on/off
101-0162 Tray 6 Feed Motor Slowest Tray 6 feed motor slowest on/off
101-0190 Output Bin Full Sensor Detects when paper is at output bin full sensor
101-0191 Output Bin 2 Full Sensor Detects when paper is at output bin 2 full sensor
101-0206 Developer Suction Fan Run Start/stop developer suction fan run
101-0207 Developer Suction Fan Run Ready Detects if developer suction fan runs at normal
speed
102-0010 Transfer Assembly Paper Empty Sensor Detects when paper is in Tray 2
102-0041 Transfer Assembly Paper Size Read Detects paper Tray 2 size.
102-0050 Transfer Assembly Stack Height Sensor Detects if paper in Tray 2 is elevated to the sensor
102-0120 Tray 3 Stack Height Sensor Detects if paper in Tray 3 is elevated to the sensor
102-0190 Tray 4 Stack Height Sensor Detects if paper in Tray 4 is elevated to the sensor
102–0201 Tray 4 Level Sensor 1 Detects when the stack height of Tray 4 level
sensor 1
102–0202 Tray 4 Level Sensor 2 Detects when the stack height of Tray 4 level
sensor 2
102-0260 Tray 5 Stack Height Sensor Detects if paper in Tray 5 is elevated to the sensor
102–0271 Tray 5 Level Sensor 1 Detects when the stack height of Tray 5 level
sensor 1
102–0272 Tray 5 Level Sensor 2 Detects when the stack height of Tray 5 level
sensor 2
102-0280 Bypass Paper Empty Sensor Detects when paper is in Bypass Tray (Tray 1)
102-0300 Tray 3 Feed Sensor (or Door Open) Detects when paper is at Tray 3 feed sensor
(optional)
102-0320 Tray 4 Feed Sensor (or Door Open) Detects when paper is at Tray 4 feed sensor
(optional)
102-0361 Fuser Out Sensor Detects when paper is at the fuser out sensor.
102-0380 Duplex Jam 1 Sensor Detects when paper is at duplex jam 1 sensor.
102-0390 Duplex Jam 2 Sensor Detects when paper is at duplex jam 2 sensor.
102-0520 Tray 6 Stack Height Sensor Detects if paper in Tray 6 is elevated to the sensor
102-0531 Tray 6 Level Sensor 1 Detects when the stack height of Tray 6 level
sensor 1
102-0532 Tray 6 Level Sensor 2 Detects when the stack height of Tray 6 level
sensor 2
102-0730 Tray 4 Knock Up Home Sensor Detect when Tray 4 knock up home sensor
102-0731 Tray 4 Shift Tray Paper Empty Sensor Detect when paper is in Tray 4 shift tray
102-0732 Tray 4 Shift Tray Level Sensor 1 Detects when the stack height of Tray 4 shift tray
level sensor 1
102-0733 Tray 4 Shift Tray Level Sensor 2 Detects when the stack height of Tray 4 shift tray
level sensor 2
102-0734 Tray 4 Shift Plate Home Sensor Detect when Tray 4 shift plate home sensor
102-0735 Tray 4 Shift Plate End Sensor Detect when Tray 4 shift plate end sensor
102-0736 Tray 4 Gate Solenoid Home Sensor Detect when Tray 4 gate solenoid home sensor
105-0030 Black MHV Bias Black MHV bias voltage on at normal drive level
106-0030 Black Developer Bias Black developer bias voltage on at normal drive
level
106-0031 Black Developer AC Bias Black developer bias AC voltage on at normal drive
level
107-0033 THV(-) Bias THV minus bias voltage on at normal drive level
109-0020 Fuser Fan Run Ready Detects if fuser fan motor runs at normal speed
109-0022 Output 2 Fan Run Ready Detects if output 2 fan runs at normal speed
109-0024 Output 3 Fan Run Ready Detects if output 3 fan runs at normal speed
109-0034 Fuser Motor Ready Detects if fuser motor runs at each speed
109-0047 Output Fan Run Ready Detects if fuser fan runs at normal speed
109-0140 Fuser Gap Home Sensor Detects if the fuser press is located home position
110-0000 Laser Scanner Assembly Motor 1 Run Ready Detects if laser scanner assembly motor 1 runs at
normal speed
110-0060 Laser Scanner Assembly Motor 1 Run Laser scanner assembly motor 1 on/off
110-0110 Laser Scanner Assembly LD Power 4 Laser scanner assembly LD 4 power on/off (black)
110-0170 Laser Scanner Assembly HSync 4 Detects laser scanner assembly HSync 4 (black)
111-0030 Toner Dispense Motor Black Toner dispense (supply) motor on/off
113-0361 Finisher Compile Paper Sensor Detect when a paper is at compile sensor
113-0380 Finisher Left Tamper Home Sensor Detects lift tamper home position
113-0390 Finisher Right Tamper Home Sensor Detects right tamper home position
113-0410 Finisher Stapler Door Sensor Detects if stapler door cover is closed
113-0420 Finisher Jam Cover Sensor Detects if jam door cover is closed
113-0470 Finisher Main Tray Home Sensor Detects main tray home position
113-0471 Finisher Main Tray Beam Sensor Detect main tray beam sensor
113-0472 Finisher Main Tray Low Limit Sensor Detect main tray low limit sensor
113-0473 Finisher Main Tray Encoder Sensor Detect main tray encoder sensor
113-0481 Finisher Paper Support Sensor Detect paper support home sensor
113-0491 Finisher Traverse Front Sensor Detect traverse front home sensor
113-0492 Finisher Traverse Rear Sensor Detect traverse rear home sensor
113-0520 Finisher Left Tamper Motor Finisher left tamper motor on/off
113-0530 Finisher Right Tamper Motor Finisher right tamper motor on/off
113-0550 Finisher Staple Unit Motor Finisher staple unit motor on/off
113-0563 Finisher Ejector 2 Reverse Motor Finisher ejector 2 reverse direction on/off
113-0570 Finisher Main Tray Motor Finisher main tray motor on/off
113-0571 Finisher Paper Support Motor Finisher paper support motor on/off
113-0581 Finisher Traverse Motor Finisher staple unit traverse motor on/off
113-0610 Finisher Punch Encoder Sensor Detect finisher punch encoder sensor
113-0611 Finisher Punch Position Sensor Detect finisher punch position sensor
113-0612 Finisher Punch Home Sensor Detect finisher punch home sensor
113-0620 Finisher output bin Install Sensor Detect finisher punch output bin install sensor
113-0621 Finisher output bin Full Sensor Detect finisher punch output bin full sensor
113-2000 2 Bin Finisher Buffer Lift Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher buffer lift sensor
113-2010 2 Bin Finisher Clamp Home Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher clamp home sensor
113-2020 2 Bin Finisher Diverter Home Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher diverter home sensor
113-2030 2 Bin Finisher Eject 1 Away Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher eject 1 away sensor
113-2031 2 Bin Finisher Eject 1 Home Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher eject 1 home sensor
113-2032 2 Bin Finisher Eject 1 Encoder Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher eject 1 encoder sensor
113-2040 2 Bin Finisher Eject 2 Home Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher eject 2 home sensor
113-2041 2 Bin Finisher Eject 2 Encoder Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher eject 2 encoder sensor
113-2050 2 Bin Finisher End Stopper Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher end stopper sensor
113-2060 2 Bin Finisher Paddle Home Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher paddle home sensor
113-2070 2 Bin Finisher IPTU Entrance Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher IPTU entrance sensor
113-2071 2 Bin Finisher IPTU Middle Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher IPTU middle sensor
113-2080 2 Bin Finisher Entrance Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher entrance sensor
113-2090 2 Bin Finisher Main Output Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher main output sensor
113-2091 2 Bin Finisher Sub Output Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher sub output sensor
113-2100 2 Bin Finisher Buffer Output Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher buffer output sensor
113-2110 2 Bin Finisher Stapler Home Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher stapler home sensor
113-2111 2 Bin Finisher Stapler Rear Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher stapler rear sensor
113-2112 2 Bin Finisher Stapler Front Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher stapler front sensor
113-2113 2 Bin Finisher Stapler Manual Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher stapler manual sensor
113-2114 2 Bin Finisher Stapler Head Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher stapler head sensor
113-2115 2 Bin Finisher Stapler Low Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher stapler low sensor
113-2116 2 Bin Finisher Stapler Ready Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher stapler ready sensor
113-2120 2 Bin Finisher Front Tamper Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher front tamper sensor
113-2130 2 Bin Finisher Rear Tamper Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher rear tamper sensor
113-2140 2 Bin Finisher Main Beam Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher main beam sensor
113-2141 2 Bin Finisher Main Front Level Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher main front level sensor
113-2142 2 Bin Finisher Main Rear Level Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher main rear level sensor
113-2143 2 Bin Finisher Main Encoder Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher main encoder sensor
113-2144 2 Bin Finisher Main Full Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher main full sensor
113-2145 2 Bin Finisher Sub Full Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher sub full sensor
113-2150 2 Bin Finisher Booklet Paper Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher booklet paper sensor
113-2160 2 Bin Finisher Staple Paper Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher staple paper sensor
113-2161 2 Bin Finisher Staple Button Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher staple button sensor
113-2170 2 Bin Finisher Compile Paper Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher compile paper sensor
113-2180 2 Bin Finisher IPTU Cover Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher IPTU cover sensor
113-2181 2 Bin Finisher Top Cover Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher top cover sensor
113-2182 2 Bin Finisher Front Door Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher front door sensor
113-2190 2 Bin Finisher Stack Top Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher stack top sensor
113-2200 2 Bin Finisher IPTU Detect Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher IPTU detect sensor
113-2201 2 Bin Finisher Punch Detect Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher punch detect sensor
113-2202 2 Bin Finisher Booklet Detect Sensor Detect 2 bin finisher booklet detect sensor
113-2500 2 Bin Finisher Buffer Lift Motor 2 bin finisher buffer lift motor on/off
113-2510 2 Bin Finisher Clamp Motor 2 bin finisher camp motor on/off
113-2520 2 Bin Finisher Diverter Motor 2 bin finisher dverter motor on/off
113-2530 2 Bin Finisher Eject 1 Motor 2 bin finisher eject 1 motor on/off
113-2540 2 Bin Finisher Eject 2 Motor 2 bin finisher eject 2 motor on/off
113-2560 2 Bin Finisher IPTU Feed Motor 2 bin finisher IPTU feed motor on/off
113-2570 2 Bin Finisher Entrance Motor 2 bin finisher entrance motor on/off
113-2580 2 Bin Finisher Output Feed Motor 2 bin finisher output feed motor on/off
113-2590 2 Bin Finisher End Stopper Motor 2 bin finisher end stopper motor on/off
113-2600 2 Bin Finisher Paddle Motor 2 bin finisher paddle motor on/off
113-2610 2 Bin Finisher Main Tray Motor 2 bin finisher main tray motor on/off
113-2620 2 Bin Finisher Staple Move Motor 2 bin finisher staple move motor on/off
113-2621 2 Bin Finisher Staple Head Motor 2 bin finisher staple head motor on/off
113-2630 2 Bin Finisher Front Tamper Motor 2 bin finisher front tamper motor on/off
113-2640 2 Bin Finisher Rear Tamper Motor 2 bin finisher rear tamper motor on/off
113-2650 2 Bin Finisher Manual Blue LED 2 bin finisher manual blue LED on/off
113-2651 2 Bin Finisher Manual Red LED 2 bin finisher Manual red LED on/off
113-3000 Booklet Stopper Home Sensor Detect booklet Stopper home sensor
113-3010 Booklet Staple Home Sensor Detect booklet staple home sensor
113-3020 Booklet Front Staple Empty Sensor Detect booklet front staple empty sensor
113-3030 Booklet Rear Staple Empty Sensor Detect booklet rear staple empty sensor
113-3040 Booklet Knife Home Sensor Detect booklet knife home sensor
113-3050 Booklet Guide Home Sensor Detect booklet guide home sensor
113-3060 Booklet Diverter Home Sensor Detect booklet Diverter home Sensor
113-3080 Booklet Tamper Home Sensor Detect booklet tamper home sensor
113-3090 Booklet Paddle Home Sensor Detect booklet paddle home sensor
113-3100 Booklet Entrance Paper Sensor Detect booklet entrance paper sensor
113-3110 Booklet Tray Paper Sensor Detect booklet fold output paper sensor
113-3120 Booklet Fold Output Paper Sensor Detect booklet fold output paper sensor
113-3130 Booklet Press Home Sensor Detect booklet press home sensor
113-4000 Punch Scan Home Sensor Detect punch scan home sensor
113-4010 Punch Scan Edge 1 Sensor Detect punch scan edge 1 sensor
113-4011 Punch Scan Edge 2 Sensor Detect punch scan edge 2 sensor
113-4012 Punch Scan Edge 3 Sensor Detect punch scan edge 3 sensor
113-4013 Punch Scan Edge 4 Sensor Detect punch scan edge 4 sensor
113-4050 Punch Output Bin Full Sensor Detect punch output bin full sensor
113-4060 Punch Type 1 Detect Sensor Detect punch type 1 detect sensor
113-4061 Punch Type 2 Detect Sensor Detect punch type 2 detect sensor
Fax diagnostics
Operation procedure When the main NVM Read/Write window displays, users can navigate through the list
of configuration values and descriptions that display.
Users can input a code through the text box to search for a configuration value.
After selecting a value, press the Edit button to open an interface for user input.
Verification N/A
Specification N/A
Reference N/A
20-200 Pause dial time Pause time (value * 1000 ms) Country value 0-200
1=
OPTION_DP_40
2=
OPTION_DP_37
3=
OPTION_DP_50
20-220 Auto dial start pause time Pause time before auto-dialing 1 0-10
(second)
20-310 Ring off time Ring off time (ms) 560 90-800
20-320 Ring detection frequency Sets the call indication frequency 1 1 = 12-80 hz
range that will be detected by LIU.
2 = 16-55 hz
3 = 20-55 hz
4 = 22-55 hz
20-330 Ring on max time Ring on max time (ms) 5100 3000-12000
20-340 Ring off max time Ring off max time (ms) 11100 9000-22000
20-400 DTMF high-frequency level DTMF high-frequency level (dBm) Country value 0-15
20-410 DTMF low-frequency level DTMF low-frequency level (dBm) Country value 0-15
3 = 70/150
4 = 60/60
5 = 80/100
6 = 150/50
7 = 150/240
8 = 100/100
9 = 100/80
1=
OPTION_PULSE
_MODE
1=
OPTION_RATE_
5
2=
OPTION_RATE_
10
3=
OPTION_RATE_
20
20-530 Dial tone detect Detect dial tone prior to sending Country value 0 = OPTION_OFF
1 = OPTION_ON
20-540 Loop current detect Detect if loop current is present Country value 0 = OPTION_OFF
prior to sending
1 = OPTION_ON
20-550 Busy signal detect Detect busy signal to allow redials Country value 0 = OPTION_OFF
1 = OPTION_ON
20-810 Fax transmission level Adjust fax transmission level (dBm) Country value Country value
20-830 Auto dial timeout Adjust auto dial timeout (second) Country value 30-150
20-920 CNG detection count CNG tone detection check count 2 1-15
during ANS/FAX mode
21-999 Fax line setting Fax test line setting (dual fax) 0 0 = Line 1
1 = Line 2
21-800 Modem speed line 2 Select modem start speed for line 24
2. This item will display only when
a dual line fax kit is installed
Operation procedure When the main Fax Test Routines window displays, users can navigate through the list
of routines and descriptions that display. Users can input a code through the text box
to search for a routine.
After selecting a routine, press OK to open the test window that lists the selected
routine. Users can start/stop the selected test routine.
20-012 Single tone 1100Hz Ln1 Emits single tone 1100Hz on line 1 On/Off
20-014 Single tone 1650Hz Ln1 Emits single tone 1650Hz on line 1 On/Off
20-015 Single tone 1850Hz Ln1 Emits single tone 1850Hz on line 1 On/Off
20-016 Single tone 2100Hz Ln1 Emits single tone 2100Hz on line 1 On/Off
20-040 V.21 300 bps Line1 Emits V.21 300 bps Line 1 On/Off
20-041 V.27ter 2400 bps Line1 Emits V.27ter 2400 bps Line1 On/Off
20-042 V.27ter 4800 bps Line1 Emits V.27ter 4800 bps Line1 On/Off
20-043 V.29 7200 bps Line1 Emits V.29 7200 bps Line1 On/Off
20-044 V.29 9600 bps Line1 Emits V.29 9600 bps Line1 On/Off
20-045 V.17 7200 bps Line1 Emits V.17 7200 bps Line1 On/Off
20-046 V.17 9600 bps Line1 Emits V.17 9600 bps Line1 On/Off
20-047 V.17 12000 bps Line1 Emits V.17 12000 bps Line1 On/Off
20-048 V.17 14400 bps Line1 Emits V.17 14400 bps Line1 On/Off
20-049 V.34 2400 bps Line1 Emits V.34 2400 bps Line1 On/Off
20-050 V.34 4800 bps Line1 Emits V.34 4800 bps Line1 On/Off
20-051 V.34 7200 bps Line1 Emits V.34 7200 bps Line1 On/Off
20-052 V.34 9600 bps Line1 Emits V.34 9600 bps Line1 On/Off
20-053 V.34 12000 bps Line1 Emits V.34 12000 bps Line1 On/Off
20-054 V.34 14400 bps Line1 Emits V.34 14400 bps Line1 On/Off
20-055 V.34 16800 bps Line1 Emits V.34 16800 bps Line1 On/Off
20-056 V.34 19200 bps Line1 Emits V.34 19200 bps Line1 On/Off
20-057 V.34 21600 bps Line1 Emits V.34 21600 bps Line1 On/Off
20-058 V.34 24000 bps Line1 Emits V.34 24000 bps Line1 On/Off
20-059 V.34 26400 bps Line1 Emits V.34 26400 bps Line1 On/Off
20-060 V.34 28800 bps Line1 Emits V.34 28800 bps Line1 On/Off
20-061 V.34 31200 bps Line1 Emits V.34 31200 bps Line1 On/Off
20-062 V.34 33600 bps Line1 Emits V.34 33600 bps Line1 On/Off
21-012 Single tone 1100Hz Ln2 Emits single tone 1100Hz on line 2 On/Off
21-014 Single tone 1650Hz Ln2 Emits single tone 1650Hz on line 2 On/Off
21-015 Single tone 1850Hz Ln2 Emits single tone 1850Hz on line 2 On/Off
21-016 Single tone 2100Hz Ln2 Emits single tone 2100Hz on line 2 On/Off
21-040 V.21 300 bps Line2 Emits V.21 300 bps Line2 On/Off
21-041 V.27ter 2400 bps Line2 Emits V.27ter 2400 bps Line2 On/Off
21-042 V.27ter 4800 bps Line2 Emits V.27ter 4800 bps Line2 On/Off
21-043 V.29 7200 bps Line2 Emits V.29 7200 bps Line2 On/Off
21-044 V.29 9600 bps Line2 Emits V.29 9600 bps Line2 On/Off
21-045 V.17 7200 bps Line2 Emits V.17 7200 bps Line2 On/Off
21-046 V.17 9600 bps Line2 Emits V.17 9600 bps Line2 On/Off
21-047 V.17 12000 bps Line2 Emits V.17 12000 bps Line2 On/Off
21-048 V.17 14400 bps Line2 Emits V.17 14400 bps Line2 On/Off
21-049 V.34 2400 bps Line2 Emits V.34 2400 bps Line2 On/Off
21-050 V.34 4800 bps Line2 Emits V.34 4800 bps Line2 On/Off
21-051 V.34 7200 bps Line2 Emits V.34 7200 bps Line2 On/Off
21-052 V.34 9600 bps Line2 Emits V.34 9600 bps Line2 On/Off
21-053 V.34 12000 bps Line2 Emits V.34 12000 bps Line2 On/Off
21-054 V.34 14400 bps Line2 Emits V.34 14400 bps Line2 On/Off
21-055 V.34 16800 bps Line2 Emits V.34 16800 bps Line2 On/Off
21-056 V.34 19200 bps Line2 Emits V.34 19200 bps Line2 On/Off
21-057 V.34 21600 bps Line2 Emits V.34 21600 bps Line2 On/Off
21-058 V.34 24000 bps Line2 Emits V.34 24000 bps Line2 On/Off
21-059 V.34 26400 bps Line2 Emits V.34 26400 bps Line2 On/Off
21-060 V.34 28800 bps Line2 Emits V.34 28800 bps Line2 On/Off
21-061 V.34 31200 bps Line2 Emits V.34 31200 bps Line2 On/Off
21-062 V.34 33600 bps Line2 Emits V.34 33600 bps Line2 On/Off
Scanner diagnostics
Shading test
● Diagnostics > Scanner Diagnostics > Shading Test
Purpose – To check the quality of scanned images, especially if there might be defects in optical devices
such as the lens, mirror, or lamp.
Press Shade and Print report to see if the current shading value is correct. Mono, red, green, and
blue gray shading values will be shown on the printed report. When the previous shading value is
needed, press “Print Last Shade Report”.
Diagnostics > Scanner Diagnostics > Shading Test > Shade and Print Report (Flow ADF)
Press Print Last Shade Report (ADF) for the previous shading value report.
NOTE:
– When executing Flow ADF shading, use only the shading sheet (JC63–05055A).
– A Shading Test for the Flow ADF unit must be completed after replacing the Flow ADF unit or
main board.
Verification
Purpose To read and/or write values in the scanner and Flow ADF memory.
Operation procedure When the main NVM Read/Write window displays, users can navigate through the list
of codes with descriptions and saved values. Users can also directly input a code
through the text box to search for an NVM.
After selecting a code, the Edit button will be enabled only if the code is writable.
If the selected code is writable and the Edit button is enabled, press the button to
configure the desired value for the code.
Verification N/A
Specification N/A
Reference N/A
Purpose To perform test routines for the scanner and Flow ADF.
Operation procedure When the main Scanner/Flow ADF Test Routines window displays, users can navigation
through the list of routines and descriptions that display. Users can input a code
through the text box to search for a routine.
After selecting a routine, press OK to open the test window that lists the selected
routine. Users can start/stop the selected test routine.
Verification N/A
Specification N/A
Adjustment
Print adjustment
● Diagnostics > Adjustment > Print Adjustment > Image Position
Purpose Manually adjust the position of the printed image on the paper in the print engine.
2. Change the adjustment value using the + or - buttons, then press the OK button
to save the changes.
NOTE:
3. Print out the test pattern and check if the image is adjusted. If not, repeat Step 2.
● Diagnostics > Adjustment > Print Adjustment > Print Test Patterns
Purpose Manually adjust the position of the copied image on the paper in the copy engine.
– Make sure that the initial values of margin adjustment are the same as the
values of the print adjustment.
– Perform an adjustment for each tray. Do not choose All for tray selection, as this
can confuse the adjustment.
NOTE:
2. Change the adjustment value using the + or - button, and then press OK to save
the changes.
3. Print out the test pattern and check if the image has moved. It not, repeat Step 2.
Purpose To correct the image position and magnification of scanned images automatically.
Operation procedure 1. Locate the Scanner A/S chart at the scanner glass.
2. Press OK. A scan begins and the system will automatically calculate the proper value based on
the scanning result of the chart.
4. Scan the Scanner A/S Chart and send it to a PC. The chart must be scanned from the scanner
glass.
5. To check the image position, compare the position of the scale marks (a, b) from the chart to
the scanned image.
6. To check the magnification, compare the length of line c from the chart to the scanned image.
NOTE: Specifications:
○ a, b: 10, ± 1.5 mm
○ c: 190, ± 1.5 mm
● Diagnostics > Adjustment > Scan Area Adjustment > Manual Adjustment
Operation procedure 1. Choose one item from the table. There are three items to choose from:
○ Image Position — Leading Edge (Unit: mm, Scale: 0.1, Min/Max: -6/+6)
○ Image Position — Side Edge (Unit: mm, Scale: 0.1, Min/Max: -6/+6)
4. Image position (a, b): If the current value is smaller than the specification, press
+, otherwise press -.
5. Magnification (c): If the current value is smaller than the specification, press -,
otherwise, press +.
7. Scan the Scanner A/S Chart and send it to a PC. The chart must be scanned from
the scanner glass.
8. To check the image position, compare the position of the scale marks (a, b) from
the chart to the scanned image.
9. To check the magnification, compare the length of line c from the chart to the
scanned image.
NOTE: Specifications:
○ a, b: 10, ± 1.5 mm
○ c: 190, ± 1.5 mm
Operation procedure 1. Locate the Scanner A/S chart at the scanner glass.
2. Press OK. A scan begins and the system will automatically calculate the proper
value based on the scanning result of the chart.
4. Scan the Scanner A/S Chart and send it to a PC. The chart must be scanned from
the Flow ADF.
5. To check the image position, compare the position of the scale marks (a, b) from
the chart to the scanned image.
6. To check the magnification, compare the length of line c from the chart to the
scanned image.
NOTE: Specifications:
○ a, b: 10, ± 1.5 mm
○ c: 190, ± 1.5 mm
NOTE: After executing the Flow ADF adjustment, perform a shading test. Refer
to Scanner Diagnostics.
● Diagnostics > Adjustment > Flow ADF Adjustment > Manual Adjustment
Operation procedure 1. Choose one item from the table. There are three items to choose from:
○ Image Position — Side Edge (Unit: mm, Scale: 0.1, Min/Max: -6/+6)
4. Image position (a, b): If the current value is smaller than the specification, press
+, otherwise press -.
5. Magnification (c): If the current value is smaller than the specification, press -,
otherwise, press +.
○ a, b: 10, ± 1.5 mm
○ c: 190, ± 1.5 mm
7. Scan the Scanner A/S Chart and send it to a PC. The chart must be scanned from
the Flow ADF.
8. To check the image position, compare the position of the scale marks (a, b) from
the chart to the scanned image.
9. To check the magnification, compare the length of line c from the chart to the
scanned image.
10. If Auto Skew Correction during job box is checked, skewed image is corrected by
digitally rotating the scanned images.
NOTE: After executing the Flow ADF adjustment, perform a shading test. Refer to
Scanner Diagnostics.
Purpose To correct image quality when density of the image is poor. Normal TRC Control is
recommended after changing a unit, such as a toner cartridge, imaging unit, and ITB,
or after restarting the printer.
○ On: Normal TRC Control will execute during the determined conditions,
○ Page Count: The system executes Normal TRC Control based on the count
of printed pages since the last execution.
○ Time Left Alone: The system executes Normal TRC Control when the
system returns from a power save mode and the rest time exceeds the
configured value.
Verification Print out a test job and make sure the image quality has recovered.
● Diagnostics > Image Management > Auto Tone Adjustment Activation > Full
Purpose To correct image quality when any OPC drum is replaced, the life of the OPC drum is
changed, the density of the image is poor, or the temperature and/or humidity in the
room changes suddenly.
○ On: Full TRC Control will execute during the determined conditions,
○ Page Count: The system executes Full TRC Control based on the count of
printed pages since the last execution.
○ Time Left Alone: The system executes Full TRC Control when the system
returns from a power save mode and the rest time exceeds the configured
value.
Verification Print out a test job and make sure the image quality has recovered.
To clear the main memory, select the country/region where the system is located, and restart the printer.
Debug log
– Job Status: This option only enables the logging of user created jobs.
– Details: This option enables all the logging options of the running tasks of the system. This option
might effect the performance of certain system operations. Use this option when the system
performs abnormally and engineers need to investigate the problem.
Capture log
2. Tap the Service Mode app. When the pop-up displays, press the area below the pop-up until the
password window appears. Enter 1934 and press the OK button.
3. Go to Service Functions > Debug Log and change the debug log level to DETAILS.
5. Select All or Period. If selecting Period, enter the start and end date.
7. Once the log is completed, a completion message will display. Restore the debug log level to JOB
STATUS.
NOTE: If the system log size becomes very large, it will take longer to copy to the USB flash drive.
8. Check that the Log File has been saved to the USB flash drive.
Verification Print a test job and make sure the transfer problem has been resolved.
Specification N/A
Reference N/A
Envelope rotate
NOTE: If the paper source is Auto, the device will feed from the Tray 1 because the LEF envelope can only
be loaded in the Tray 1 according to paper specification.
If the length of envelope is over the maximum size of the custom width, the device will not rotate the
image and determine that the direction of the envelope is SEF. For example, the A4 model supports custom
sizes like W 98–216 ~ L148–356. This model does not support C5 Env (162x229) DL Env (110x220), No 9
Env (98x225), No 10 Env (105x241) rotation.
First, generate prints using printable pages using laser paper. Use paper from an unopened ream that has been
acclimated to room temperature. Make sure that genuine HP toner is installed in the printer.
[4] Note area For recording the date, conditions, and so on.
[H] Gradation pattern For checking tone reproduction of seven colors (C, M, Y, K, R, G, B/
10~100%)
[I] Color/Mono text For checking the reproduction of color, mono text
[K] White gap pattern For checking color to color, color to mono white gap
TIP: Depending on the remaining life of the part, the cause of the defect can vary. Check the remaining life of
the part.
1 Check the OPC for scratches or contamination in a vertical Replace the drum unit.
direction.
2 Scanner unit is contaminated (Flow ADF glass/mirror/CCD Wipe the surface of the contaminated parts with a soft
sensor) cloth.
1 A foreign substance is between the magnetic roller and Remove the foreign substance.
the blade.
Put the hook into the gap between magnetic roller and
blade.
2 The developer in the developer unit is empty or the ● Check the life remaining of the developer unit on the
developer unit life has expired. supplies information report.
3 The laser beam path is blocked. Clean the laser scanner assembly window.
1 Horizontal periodic band or dot (CR 38 mm). Clean the contaminated surface on the charge roller with a
soft cloth.
Check if the surface of the charge roller is contaminated or
scratched. If the surface is scratched, replace the drum unit.
2 Horizontal periodic band or dot (OPC 188 mm). Clean the contaminated surface on the OPC drum with a
soft cloth.
Check if the surface of the OPC drum is contaminated or
scratched. If the surface is scratched, replace the drum unit.
3 Check if the charge roller contact plate had debris or is Clean the charge roller contact plate.
contaminated.
If the problem persists, replace the drum unit.
1 Horizontal periodic bands (OPC, 188 mm) This problem is likely to resolve itself over time.
● OPC was exposed for too long. If the problem persists, replace the drum unit.
2 Horizontal periodic bands (magnetic roller, 35.7 mm) Replace developer unit.
Blurred image
Figure 5-66 Typical faulty images
1 High humidity and/or the quality of the paper. Use new, high quality paper.
3 Connection between HVPS and THV is incorrect. Check if the connection between THV high voltage
terminal and HVPS THV terminal is correct.
Foggy image
Figure 5-67 Typical faulty images
Replace HVPS.
1 Under 3 mm periodic jitters or horizontal bands have Remove foreign substance from the drive gears.
occurred.
Grease the drive gears.
● Toner cartridge
● Drum unit
2 Under 1 mm periodic jitter or horizontal bands have Check if the laser scanner assembly is assembled
occurred. correctly. If not, replace the screws.
3 Are the paper guides properly set? Adjust the paper guides.
4 Is the surface of the pickup/reverse/feed roller dirty? Clean or replace the contaminated roller.
5 Is the Flow ADF installed and adjusted properly? Reinstall the Flow ADF unit.
1 Check the paper type. Check that the paper type displayed on the control panel is
the same type of paper being used for the print job.
Depending on what type of paper is used, print speed
varies.
3 Check the surface of the fuser belt and pressure roller for Replace the fuser unit.
scratches.
4 Check the temperature control system for problems. Check the non-contact thermistor sensor
5 Check if the pressure control system operates properly. Check the pressure control system.
6 Paper is wrapped on the heating roller. Remove the wrapped paper and print a test page.
1 Is the transfer roller dirty or worn out? Clean or replace the transfer roller assembly.
2 Is the fuser belt or pressure roller dirty? Clean the fuser belt and pressure roller.
3 Check the pressure roller surface for damage or scratches. Replace the fuser unit.
Purpose
● To adjust the color tone to the standard set by the manufacturer.
Procedure
3. Log in as Admin.
NOTE: When the machine is installed for the first time, Cancel Setting Standard Tone does not need to be
executed.
Purpose
● Cancel the setting standard tone
● Return to the customized tone set by the user after setting the standard tone
Procedure
1. Select Adjustment > Tone Adjustment > Cancel Setting Standard Tone.
3. Select Full TRC : Adjustment > Tone Adjustment > Auto Tone Adjustment > *Full + Execute Now
Check items
● Check the scanned ID chart for correct placement.
NOTE: If the problem persists after executing the setting standard tone procedure, look for other causes.
Symptom
● Toner cartridge is installed, but Not Installed message displays.
Cause
● Toner cartridge is not properly installed.
● Bad connection between the main board and the e-label Joint PCA.
Troubleshooting
● Toner cartridge installation problem:
– If the cartridge comes out automatically, check the cartridge fixing hook.
– If the cartridge fixing hook is damaged, replace the cartridge cap or cartridge.
If the modular jack has moved into the toner cartridge, remove it.
– Make sure that the e-label connection (modular connector) is correctly installed.
– If the modular connector is not installed correctly, open the rear cover and reinstall.
– If the e-label Joint PCA, modular jack pin, or main board interface connector are damaged, replace the
PCA (see the previous step).
● Bad connection between the main board and the e-label Joint PCA:
– Check the connection between the main board and the e-label Joint PCA. If the connection is bad,
replace the harness, the e-label Joint PCA, or the main board.
Symptom
● Image (front/back side of paper) is contaminated with toner
Cause
● Toner is contaminated on the surface of pressure roller with low coverage, mainly simplex, and low duty
jobs.
Troubleshooting
If the previous setting used is On mode, that pre-existing setting value will be kept as before. Otherwise, it
will be changed to Auto.
4. Repeat step 3 up to six times until you cannot find any contamination on the fuser cleaning sheet.
If the contamination on the fuser cleaning sheet still exists, clean the pressure-roller with soft brush or
scraper with care.
– Open the fuser jam cover. Remove three screws, and then remove the brush.
– Check the surface of pressure roller and remove the toner contamination while carefully rotating the
pressure roller one cycle.
● Symptom: Acoustic noise from the fuser assembly in the early stages of printing.
Troubleshooting
● Symptom: Image at the leading edge of the paper is duplicated after 110 mm.
Troubleshooting
▲ Lower the fusing temperature in SVC mode until the problem disappears. The default value is 10, and it is
recommended to change the value up to 8.
● Cause: Harness for EEPROM signal is damaged by the sharp edge of the fuser frame.
If so, replace the fuser unit (from 2015.08.11 the new part was applied) or insulate the damaged spot of
harness by wrapping each harness up.
NOTE: The pre-existing AT tape might need to be removed, and then re-apply the insulation for each
damaged harness.
NOTE: New design was applied from 2015.08.11 which doesn’t have the sharp edge on the harness path
1 Noise of Flow ADF hinge/Crack of Flow ADF hinge/Flow ADF will not stay
open
3 During copy or scan job, the original paper JAM and U3–3213 error occur.
Noise of Flow ADF hinge/crack of Flow ADF/Flow ADF does not stay open
● When the Flow ADF is opened to access the scanner glass, the unit should remain at a 50° angle (±10°).
The Flow ADF does not remain open as expected.
Troubleshooting
4. Remove four screws from the hinge unit. Remove and replace the hinge unit.
Symptom
● The Flow ADF installation is not recognized.
Cause
● The Flow ADF power cable fails.
Troubleshooting
1. Reassemble the Flow ADF power cable. If the problem is not resolved, replace the power cable.
During copy or scan job, the original paper JAM and U3–3213 error occurs.
Symptom
● During copy or scan job, the original paper JAM and U3–3213 error occurs.
Troubleshooting
b. Remove the linker by pressing its upper side from an inner direction. Then remove the front cover.
Symptom
● Machine makes noise during a print job.
Cause
● The gear train needs to be greased.
Troubleshooting
Service Mode > Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines > Fuser Motor Forward
3. Remove the fuser unit and execute the fuser motor test again.
4. If the printer still makes a noise during a print job, replace the fuser drive output assembly.
3 Envelope wrinkle
Symptom
● Tray 1, Tray 2, and Tray 3 cannot pick up paper.
Cause
● Bad harness connection on the main board.
Troubleshooting
1. Check the harness connection. Reconnect the harness if it is not connected correctly.
If the connector has a problem with the soldering, replace the main board.
Symptom
● The printer cannot feed paper from Tray 2 or Tray 3.
Cause
● Feed motor problem
Troubleshooting
● Check the feed motor operation.
– Open the right door and push the cover switch forcibly.
EDC Mode > Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routine > Feed motor > On/Off
– If the feed rollers cannot rotate, open the rear cover and check the motor and gears.
● Check the connection between the main board and the feed motor.
Envelope wrinkle
Symptom
● Envelope is wrinkled when printed from the MP Tray.
Symptom
● The laser scanner assembly motor makes a loud noise while in printing mode.
Cause
● The laser scanner assembly motor is defective.
Troubleshooting
1. Enter service mode and execute the laser scanner assembly motor test.
2. If the laser scanner assembly motor running sound is loud, replace the laser scanner assembly.
3. If the laser scanner assembly motor running sound is not loud, check the other unit.
Symptom
● An error message occurs on the control panel (C3–1312, S3–3121, M1–4111, M1–4211).
Cause
● 24V channel output voltage drops to under 21.6V and 5V channel output is normal.
1. Check all 24V output channels (24VS1, 24VS2, 24VS3, 24VS4) to determine if 24V voltage comes out.
2. If 24V voltage does not come out, check 24V on/off signal pin on the main board.
a. The voltage at 24V on/off signal pin is 0V. → Main board and signal is normal.
b. The voltage at signal pin is 4~5.3V → Main board and signal is abnormal
3. If Main board and signal is normal and all 24V output channels are nearly 0V, check other parts (such as the
fuser, motor, scanner harness, and so on) driven by 24V voltage before replacing the LVPS.
4. If Main board and signal is normal and just one or two or three 24V output channels are nearly 0V, inspect
some harness from abnormal 24V output channel before replacing the LVPS.
5. If Main board and signal is abnormal and all 24V output channels are nearly 0V, inspect the harness,
connector and main board.
Symptom
● The Hard disk drive (HDD) makes a loud noise.
Cause
● The HDD has defects.
Troubleshooting
● Replace the HDD.
Symptom
● Network is not functioning.
Cause
● Network line itself is not working properly.
Troubleshooting
2. Complete a ping test after connecting the network line to the SET. If the connection is working, check the
network configuration which might have been set incorrectly.
3. If the ping test does not have a result, open the rear cover and check the main board for visible defects on
the network related components such as the connector (CN16), capacitor (C192), and other close
components. Surge voltage from the outside can cause defects.
4. If any of the components have visible defects, then replace the main board.
Symptom
● When touching a button, another button is pressed.
Cause
● Touch IC is influenced by the interference between TX frequency and power noise frequency.
Troubleshooting
1. If the power cable is connected to the multi-tap, unplug and plug it into an independent outlet.
– Select Utilities.
Symptom
● Home screen icon is missing or the control panel screen is broken.
Cause
● UI software error.
Troubleshooting
● Enter service mode.
● Execute Main Memory Clear (Service Functions > Main Memory Clear)
2. Adjust the position of the Flow ADF hinge according to the skew status.
ENWW 1169
Connection Diagram (FUSER/EXIT/DUPLEX/TONER)
HDD
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
SATA SIGNA L
SATA PO W ER
CN 22-SATA PO W ER
CN 19-SATA SIGN AL
SATA_RX_N
SATA_RX_P
SATA_TX_P
SATA_TX_N
5V2_SATA
DGND
DGND
DGND
DGND
DGND
DGND
DGND
DGND
EXIT/DU PLEX
I.5m m / 14*2P
Color
CN 33 EXIT/DU PLEX
4 1 14 1 A_DU P_RET TO NER CRUM
DU P_RET 3 2 13 2 nA_DUP_RET 1.5mm / 17*1P
M OT STEP 2 3 12 3 nB_DU P_RET CN 50 TB CRU M JC39-02261A JC39-02214A
1 4 11 4 B_DU P_RET 3.3V_CRUM 1 5 1 4 1 4
SDA_CRUM_ TB_K 2 4 2 3 2 3
5 10 5 A_DU PLEX1 3 3 3 2 3 2 TB CRU M K
4 SCL_CRUM_ TB_K
3 6 9 6 nA_DUPLEX1 DGN D 4 2 4 1 4 1
DUP1 M O T STEP 2 7 8 7 nB_DU PLEX1 1 5
1 8 7 8 B_DU PLEX1
JC39-02214A
3.3V_CRUM 5 5 1 4 1 4
3 9 6 9 R_5V_PS SDA_CRUM_ TB_C 6 4 2 3 2 3
D up RETU RN 10 5 10 DGND 7 3 3 2 3 2 TB CRU M C
2 SCL_CRUM_ TB_C
SEN 11 4 11 nSEN SE_P_DUP_RETU RN DGN D 8 2 4 1 4 1
1
1 5
2 12 3 12 DGND
EXIT TEM P
1 13 2 13 ADC_EXIT_TEMP 9
JC39-02214A 4 1 4
3.3V_CRUM 5 1
SDA_CRUM_ TB_M 10 4 2 3 2 3
14 1 14 NC SCL_CRUM_ TB_M 11 3 2 3 2 TB CRU M M
JC39-02189A JC39-02188A 3
DGN D 12 2 4 1 4 1
3 1 14 15 R_5V_PS 1 5
BIN FU LL1 2 2 13 16 DGND
1 3 12 17 nSEN SE_P_BIN FU LL_EXIT1 3.3V_CRUM 13 1
JC39-02214A
5 4 1 4
SDA_CRUM_ TB_Y 14 4 2 3 2 3
3 1 5 4 11 18 R_5V_PS SCL_CRUM_ TB_Y 15 3 3 2 3 2 TB CRU M Y
BIN FU LL2 2 2 4 5 10 19 DGND DGN D 16 2 4 1 4 1
1 3 3 6 9 20 nSEN SE_P_BIN FU LL_EXIT2 1 5
NC 17
JC39-02190A
7 8 21 R_5V_PS
4 2 8 7 22 DGND
5 1 9 6 23 nDETECT_JOB_SEP
Mono
TO NER CRUM
3 10 5 24 24V4 1.5mm / 17*1P
EXIT GATE
SO L
3.3V_CRUM 5 5 1 4 1 4
SDA_CRUM_ TB_C 6 4 2 3 2 3
FU SER DRIVE 3 2 3 2 DEVE CRU M
SCL_CRUM_ TB_C 7 3
1.5mm / 16*2P 8 2 4 1 4 1
DGN D
1 5
JC39-02195A CN 30 FU SER DRIVE
10 1 R_DGND 3.3V_CRUM 9
9 2 CLK_BLDC_FUSER 5V_PS 10 2 1 ERASER LED
8 3 nREADY_BLDC_FU SER M_ O N _ERASER 11 1 2
7 4 nEN_BLDC_FU SER
FU SER BLDC
6 12
BLDC 5
5 NC
6 R_DGND
DGN D
3.3V_CRUM 13
4 7 DG ND SDA_CRUM_ TB_Y 14
3 8 DG ND SCL_CRUM_ TB_Y 15
2 9 24V2_SW DGN D 16
1 10 24V2_SW NC 17
3 11 FAN_FUSER_O UT
FUSER OU T 2 12 FB_OUT_FAN _FUSER_OUT
FAN 1 13 DG ND
SIDE CO M 1 3 14 DG ND
Color
2 2 TO N ER RESERVOIR
COVER OPEN N .O . 15 CO VER_O PEN _SIDE
3 1 I.5mm / 11*2P
N .C. 16 nCO VER_O PEN_SIDE
CN 27 Toner M otor/L
o ck JC39-02257A
4 17 A_FUSER_REL A_TNR_SU P_KC 1 4
TO N ER
3 18 nA_FUSER_REL nA_TNR_SUP_KC 2 3
FU SER REL M O T STEP 2 19 nB_FU SER_REL nB_TN R_SU P_KC 3 2
SU PP
M O T_KC
1 20 B_FU SER_REL B_TN R_SU P_KC 4 1
3 3
1 9 21 FAN_EXIT1 R_5V_PS 5 TN R LO CK
2 2
EXIT FAN 1 2 8 22 FB_O U T_FAN_EXIT1 DGN D 6 SEN S_KC
1 1
3 7 23 DG ND nSEN SE_TN R_LO CK_KC 7
3 4 6 24 FAN_EXIT2 A_RES_KC 8 4
EXIT FAN 2 2 5 5 25 FB_O U T_FAN_EXIT2 nA_RES_KC 9 3 RESERVO IR
1 6 4 26 DG ND nB_RES_KC 10 2 M O T_KC
JC39-02191A B_RES_KC 11 1
3 7 3 27 FAN_EXIT3
EXIT FAN 3 2 8 2 28 FB_O U T_FAN_EXIT3 A_TNR_SU P_M Y 12 4
29 DG ND TO N ER
1 9 1 nA_TNR_SUP_M Y 13 3
SU PP
nB_TN R_SU P_MY 14 2
30 R_5V_PS M O T_M Y
3 3 B_TN R_SU P_M Y 15 1
Fuser 2 31 DG ND
2
POSI 1 32 nSENS_FU SER_PO S1 R_5V_PS 16 3
1 RES LO CK
DGN D 17 2
nSEN SE_TN R_LO CK_MY 18 1 SEN S_M Y
FU SER DRAWE R
A_RES_MY 19 4
I.5m m / 9*2P
JC39-02218A JC39-02217A nA_RES_M Y 20 3 RESERVO IR
CN 40 FUSER DRAW ER nB_RES_M Y 21 2 M O T_M Y
1 11 1 DGND B_RES_M Y 22 1
FU SER N C TH ERM
CEN TER
3
2
1
2
3
4
10
9
8
2
3
4
DGND
N C_C_TD
N C_C_TC
Mono
TO N ER RESERVOIR
I.5mm / 11*2P
3 5 7 5 DGN D CN 27 Toner M otor/L
o ck
N C TH ERM JC39-02242A
2 6 6 6 N C_S_TD A_TNR_SU P_KC 1 4
SIDE TO NER
1 7 5 7 N C_S_TC nA_TNR_SUP_KC 2 3
SU PP
nB_TN R_SU P_KC 3 2
M OT
8 4 8 nDETECT_FU SER B_TN R_SU P_KC 4 1
9 3 5 3
R_5V_PS TN R LO CK
10 2 6 2
DGN D SEN S
11 1 1
21P-RW ZV-K4GG -P4
JST
nA_RES_KC 9 6 2 3 RESERVO IR
6 1 10 9 R_5V_PS 10
nB_RES_KC 5 3 2 M OT
5 2 9 10 3.3V_CRUM 11
B_RES_KC 4 4 1
4 3 8 11 ADC_CU RL_TEST
3 7 3 5 3
4 12 DGND RES FU LL
FUSER 2 6 2 6 2
5 13 SDA2_FU SER SEN S
EEPRO M 1 5 1 7 1
6 14 SCL2_FU SER
7 4 15 THERM_ REAR1
8 3 16 THERM_ REAR2
JC39-02244A 4
DGN D 12 4 1
M_ TC_VIN _K 13 3 2 3 TC
9 2 17 THERM_ FRO N T1 14 2 3 2 SENSO R
24V1_TC
10 1 18 THERM_ FRO N T2 15 1 4 1
M_ TN R_VCON _K
R_5V_PS 16
DGN D 17
nSEN SE_RES_FULL 18
A_RES_MY 19
nA_RES_M Y 20
nB_RES_M Y 21
To FDB B_RES_M Y 22
CN 55 ???
1 3.3V_MICOM
2 PA30|SWCLK
3 PA31|SWDIO
4 DGND
5 nRST_XMEGA
CN 42 D SDF
M S1_STEP_SCAN 1
CUR_STEP_SCAN 2
DIR_STEP_SCAN 3
nEN _STEP_SCAN 4
PLS_STEP_SCAN 5
PW M _W LED 6
nCO VER_O PEN _PLATEN 2 7
nCO VER_O PEN _PLATEN 1 8
??? nSEN SE_SCAN _HO M E 9
-1.5mm / 6*1P nSEN SE_APS2 10
nSEN SE_APS1 11
CN 51 ??? nDETECT_RSDF 12
6 1 6 1 DG N D nSENSE_PAPER_RADF 13
5 2 5 2 nSEN SE_P_REG I_R1 nSENSE_SCAN_PO S_1 14
4 3 4 3 5V_PS TXD_DSDF 15
3 4 3 4 DG N D RXD_DSDF 16
2 5 2 5 nSEN SE_P_REG I_R2 nRST_RSDF 17
1 6 1 6 5V_PS nSENSE_SCAN_PO S_2 18
DGN D 19
DGN D 20
DGN D 21
DGN D 22
3.3V_SCAN 23
DGN D 24
5V_W KUP 25
DGN D 26
5V_SCAN 27
5V_SCAN 28
DGN D 29
24V_SCAN 30
24V_SCAN 31
24V_SCAN 32
24V_SCAN 33
M S2_STEP_SCAN 34
DCIS
40P FFC
CN 43 DCIS
CLK_M AIN _DCIS_P 1
CLK_M AIN _DCIS_N 2
DGN D 3
LVDO _DCIS_4_P 4
LVDO _DCIS_4_N 5
DGN D 6
LVDO _DCIS_3_P 7
LVDO _DCIS_3_N 8
DGN D 9
LVDO _DCIS_2_P 10
LVDO _DCIS_2_N 11
DGN D 12
RX_CLK_DCIS_P 13
RX_CLK_DCIS_N 14
DGN D 15
LVDO _DCIS_1_P 16
DCIS
LVDO _DCIS_1_N 17
DSDF
DGN D 18
LVDO _DCIS_0_P 19
LVDO _DCIS_0_N 20
DGN D 21
DGN D 22
SDI_DCIS 23
SCLK_DCIS 24
Scanner Unit
SDO _DCIS 25
SLO AD_DCIS 26
DGN D 27
DGN D 28
PI_SH_DCIS 29
DGN D 30
3.3V_SCAN 31
3.3V_SCAN 32
3.3V_SCAN 33
3.3V_SCAN 34
3.3V_SCAN 35
3.3V_SCAN 36
3.3V_SCAN 37
3.3V_SCAN 38
DGN D 39
DGN D 40
CCDM
BBP 50P FFC
50P
CN 41 BBP CN 44 CCDM
1 5V DGN D 1
2 N EN_STEP_DU PLEX1 CLK_M AIN _CCDM_ P 2
3 EN _M P_CLU TCH CLK_M AIN _CCDM_ N 3
4 N EN_STEP_FU SER_REL DGN D 4
5 CO VER_OPEN _SIDE SLO AD_CCDM 5
6 N EN_STEP_TNR_SU P_KC SCLK_CCDM 6
7 DIR_STEP_TNR_SUP_KC SDI_CCDM 7
8 EN _EXIT_SO L DGN D 8
9 N EN_STEP_DUP_RET PITG_CCDM 9
10 NSENSE_T1_PO S nRST_AFE 10
11 N EN_STEP_TNR_SU P_KC SDO _CCDM 11
12 PW M _M P_SO L DGN D 12
13 CLK_BLDC_FU SER LVDO _CCDM _4_N 13
14 N EN_BLDC_FUSER LVDO _CCDM _4_P 14
15 CO VER_OPEN _FRO N T DGN D 15
16 N SEN SE_P_EM PTY2 LVDO _CCDM _3_N 16
17 PLS_STEP_T1 LVDO _CCDM _3_P 17
18 N EN_STEP_T1 DGN D 18
19 nEN_STEP_FEED RX_CLK_CCDM _N 19
20 NSENSE_FUSER_PO S1 RX_CLK_CCDM _P 20
21 nEN_STEP_REGI DGN D 21
22 PLS_STEP_DU PLEX1 LVDO _CCDM _2_N 22
23 nSEN SE_CU RL1 LVDO _CCDM _2_P 23
24 N SEN SE_P_BIN FU LL_EXIT1 DGN D 24
25 DIR_STEP_TNR_SUP_M Y LVDO _CCDM _1_N 25
26 N EN_STEP_DU PLEX2 LVDO _CCDM _1_P 26
27 PLS_STEP_DU P_RET DGN D 27
28 N SENSE_JAM_ DUPLEX1 LVDO _CCDM _0_N 28
29 N SEN SE_P_DUP_RETU RN LVDO _CCDM _0_P 29
30 N SEN SE_P_REGI DGN D 30
31 PLS_STEP_DU PLEX2 3.3V_SCAN 31
32 PLS_STEP_FEED 3.3V_SCAN 32
33 PLS_STEP_PICKU P1 3.3V_SCAN 33
34 PLS_STEP_PICKU P2 3.3V_SCAN 34
35 PLS_STEP_REG I 3.3V_SCAN 35
36 nSEN SE_CU RL2 3.3V_SCAN 36
37 N SEN SE_P_PRE_FEED1 3.3V_SCAN 37
38 N SEN SE_P_PRE_FEED2 3.3V_SCAN 38
39 N SEN SE_P_FEED DGN D 39
40 N SEN SE_P_FU SER_O UT DGN D 40
41 N SENSE_JAM_ DUPLEX2 5V_SCAN 41
42 N EN_STEP_PICKU P1 5V_SCAN 42
43 N EN_STEP_PICKU P2 5V_SCAN 43
44 ADC_FB_FR 5V_SCAN 44
45 ADC_FB_REGI DGN D 45
46 ADC_FB_FEED DGN D 46
47 FB_DU P2 10V_CCD 47
48 FB_PU1 10V_CCD 48
49 FB_PU2 10V_CCD 49
50 DGN D 10V_CCD 50
BBP
16P
CN 54 BBP
1 5V
2 N EN_BLDC_O PC_K
3 N READY_BLDC_O PC_K
4 N EN_BLDC_O PC_C
5 N READY_BLDC_O PC_C
6 N EN_BLDC_O PC_M
7 N READY_BLDC_O PC_M
8 N EN_BLDC_O PC_Y
9 N READY_BLDC_O PC_Y
10 NSEN SE_SHUT_ACR
11 NREADY_BLDC_FU SER
12 N EN_STEP_RES_KC
13 DIR_STEP_RES_KC
14 N EN_STEP_RES_M Y
15 DIR_STEP_RES_M Y
16 DGN D
HUB
FDIJOINT
-1.5m m / 11P
N/W RJ45
CN1 NETW ORK 1
TD+ 2
TD- 3
RD+ 4
TERM1
Color Only LSU SIGNAL M Y 5
TERM2 6
50FFC RD- 7
CN25 LSU SIGNAL TERM3 8
MY TERM4 9
1 DGND GREEN- 10
2 PW M _LD_POW ER_M GREEN+ 11 NTWORK
3 DGND YELLOW - 12
4 nHSYNC_M _DP YELLOW +
5 nHSYNC_M _DN
6 DGND
7 nVDO_M _B1_DP
USB
8 nVDO_M _B1_DN
9 DGND CN14 USB 1
10 nSH_M1 USB3D_VBUS 2
11 nSH_M2 USB3D_DN 3
12 DGND USB3D_DP 4
13 VDO_M _B2_DP DGND 5
14 nVDO_M _B2_DN USB3D_PXN 6
15 DGND USB3D_PXP 7
16 nVDO_M _B3_DP DGND 8
17 nVDO_M _B3_DN USB3D_RXN 9
18 DGND USB3D_RXP
19 nSH_M3
20 nSH_M4
21 DGND PC
22 nVDO_M _B4_DP
23 nVDO_M _B4_DN USB HOST Ch2
24 DGND
25 CN17 USB HOST Ch2 1
nLDON_LSU_M
26 USB3H_VBUS_REAR2 2
nLDON_LSU_Y
27 USB3H_REAR2_DN 3
DGND
28 USB3H_REAR2_DP 4
nHSYNC_Y_DP
29 DGND 5
nHSYNC_Y_DN
30 USB3H_REAR2_RXN 6
DGND
31 USB3H_REAR2_RXP 7
nVDO_Y_B1_DP
32 DGND 8
VDO_Y_B1_DN
33 USB3H_REAR2_TXN 9
DGND
34 USB3H_REAR2_TXP
nSH_Y1
35 nSH_Y2
36 DGND
EXT.DRIVE
37 nVDO_Y_B2_DP
38 nVDO_Y_B2_DN USB HOST Ch1
39 DGND
40 nVDO_Y_B3_DP CN16 USB HOST Ch1 1
41 nVDO_Y_B3_DN USB3H_VBUS_REAR1 2
42 DGND USB3H_REAR1_DN 3
43 nSH_Y3 USB3H_REAR1_DP 4
44 nSH_Y4 DGND 5
45 DGND USB3H_REAR1_RXN 6
46 nVDO_Y_B4_DP USB3H_REAR1_RXP 7
47 nVDO_Y_B4_DN DGND 8
48 DGND USB3H_REAR1_TXN 9
LASER SCANNER 49
50
PW M _LD_POW ER_Y
DGND
USB3H_REAR1_TXP
Mono Only
5 DGND
6 DGND LSU
7 DGND 40FFC
8 DGND
9 DGND CN28 LSU
10 PW M _LD_POW ER_C DGND 1
11 DGND NC 2
12 nVDO_C_B4_DN 24V3 3
13 nVDO_C_B4_DP 24V3 4
14 DGND NC 5
15 nSH_C4 DGND 6
16 nSH_C3 nSTART_LSU_M OT 7
17 DGND nREADY_LSU 8
18 nVDO_C_B3_DN CLK_LSU_M OT 9
19 nVDO_C_B3_DP 5V_LSU 10
20 DGND 5V_LSU 11
21 nVDO_C_B2_DN DGND 12
22
23
nVDO_C_B2_DP
DGND
PW M _LD_POW ER_K
DGND
13
14 LASER SCANNER
ASSEMBLY
24 nSH_C2 nHSYNC_K_DP 15
25 nSH_C1 nHSYNC_K_DN 16
26 17
(MONO)
DGND DGND
27 nVDO_C_B1_DN nVDO_K_B1_DP 18
28 nVDO_C_B1_DP nVDO_K_B1_DN 19
29 DGND DGND 20
30 nHSYNC_C_DN nSH_K1 21
31 nHSYNC_C_DP nSH_K2 22
32 DGND DGND 23
33 nLDON_LSU_C nVDO_K_B2_DP 24
34 nLDON_LSU_K nVDO_K_B2_DN 25
35 DGND DGND 26
36 nVDO_K_B4_DN nVDO_K_B3_DP 27
37 nVDO_K_B4_DP nVDO_K_B3_DN 28
38 DGND DGND 29
39 nSH_K4 nSH_K3 30
40 nSH_K3 nSH_K4 31
41 DGND DGND 32
42 nVDO_K_B3_DN nVDO_K_B4_DP 33
43 nVDO_K_B3_DP nVDO_K_B4_DN 34
44 DGND DGND 35
45 nVDO_K_B2_DN nLDON_LSU_K 36
46 nVDO_K_B2_DP DGND 37
47 DGND DGND 38
48 nSH_K2 DGND 39
49 nSH_K1 CON_DETECT_LSU 40
50 DGND
51 nVDO_K_B1_DN
52 nVDO_K_B1_DP
53 DGND
54 nHSYNC_K_DN
55 nHSYNC_K_DP
56 DGND
57 PW M _LD_POW ER_K
58 DGND
59 ADC_LSU_TEMP
Mono
4 14 2 14 ADC_CTD_CENTER_S TB CRUM
5 15 1 15 PW M _ACR_LED_CENTER 1.5m m /8*1P
CN48 TB CRUM
ACR SHUTTER 2 1 5 16 DGND ADC_CTD_CENTER_P 1 JC39-02236A 7 1 JC39-02235A 1
M OT DC 1 2 4 17 OUT_DC_ACR_SHUT1 6 2
5VA 2 2
JC39-02220A DGND 3 5 3 3 CTD SENSOR
3 3 3 18 R_5V_PS 4 4
ACR SHUTTER ADC_CTD_CENTER_S 4 4
2 4 2 19 DGND 3 5
SENS PW M _ACR_LED_CENTER 5 5
1 5 1 20 nSENSE_SHUT_ACR
DGND 6 2 6 2 INNER
ADC_INNER_TEM P 7 1 7 1 TEM P
PICKUP 8
DGND 3 1 3
9 PAPER REGI
nSENSE_P_REGI 2 2 2
10 SENSOR
CN49 PICKUP 5V_PS 1 3 1
JC39-02234A 1 JC39-02204A
3 1 9 R_5V_PS
PAPER_EM PTY1 2 2 8 2 DGND
1 3 7 3 nSENSE_P_EM PTY1
JC39-02201A 4 m icroSD SOCKET
3 4 6 R_5V_PS
2 5 5 5 DGND
PAPER_LIFT1 CN12 microSD SOCKET
1 6 4 6 nSENSE_C_LIFT1 1
DATA2_SD
2
3 7 3 7 DGND DATA3_SD
3
FEED1 2 8 2 8 nSENSE_P_PRE_FEED1 CM D_SD
4
1 9 1 9 5V_PS 3.3V
5
CLK_SD
6
4 10 A_PICKUP1 DGND
7
3 11 nA_PICKUP1 DATA0_SD
PICKUP1 8
M OT STEP 2 12 nB_PICKUP1 DATA1_SD
9
1 13 B_PICKUP1 DGND
10
DGND
11
3 14 R_5V_PS DGND
1 10 12
2 15 DGND DGND
PAPER_EM PTY2 2 9 13
1 16 nSENSE_P_EM PTY2 DGND
3 8 14
DGND
3
JC39-02202A 17 R_5V_PS
4 7
2 5 6 18 DGND M SOK
PAPER_LIFT2
1 6 5 19 nSENSE_C_LIFT2
CN21 M SOK
20 DGND 1
3 7 4 DGND
FEED2 21 nSENSE_P_PRE_FEED2 2
2 8 3 SCK_M SOK
22 5V_PS 3
1 9 2 DGND
4
10 1 M SOI_M SOK
5
DGND
4 23 A_PICKUP2 6
nSS_M SOK
PICKUP2 3 24 nA_PICKUP2 7
M OT STEP 2 25 nB_PICKUP2
DGND
M SIO_M SOK
8
1 26 B_PICKUP2 9
3_3V_PS
10
SCL0_M SOK
11
3_3V_PS
FEED_REGI 12
SDA0_M SOK
DEBUGGER M AIN
CN53 FEED_REGI
JC39-02336A -2.0mm /4*1P
1 6 1 A_FEED
2 5 2 24V4 CN8 DEBUGGER M AIN
FEED M OT
STEP 3 4 3 nA_FEED 3.3V 1
4 3 4 nB_FEED RXD_M CB 2
HYBRID
5 2 5 24V4 TXD_M CB 3
6 1 6 B_FEED DGND 4
Mono
2 9 2 RXD_M ODEM2 22
1 10 1 nRI_MOD EM _1 23
nRI_MOD EM _2 24
nINT_M ODEM _1 25
nINT_M ODEM _2 26
nDCD_M ODEM _1 27
PTB 4 1 7 27 DGND nDCD_M ODEM _2 28
7 14
W ASTE 3 2 6 28 ADC_PTB_W TB_FULL nRST_M ODEM _2 29
8 13
FULL 2 3 5 29 EN_PTB_W TB_LED DGND 30
9 12
1 4 4 30 R_5V_PS
10 11
11 10 31 3.3V_CRUM
JC39-02207A 12 9 32 SCL2_PTB
13 8 33 SDA2_PTB
14 7 34 DGND
3 5 3 15 6 35 R_5V_PS
DUPLEX 6 2
2 16 5 36 DGND
JAM 2 7 1
1 17 4 37 nSENSE_JAM _DUPLEX2
3 1 3 18 3 38 R_5V_PS
P FUSER 39 DGND
2 2 2 19 2
OUT 40 nSENSE_P_FUSER_OUT
1 3 1 20 1
JC39-02209A
3 1 3
FAN
2 2 2
SIDE
1 3 1
To FDB
2-292246-2/
JC39-02338A JC39-02341A TYCO
3 1 6 1
CURL1 2 2 5 2
1 3 4 3
2-292249-2/
3 4 3 4 TYCO
CURL2 2 5 2 5
1 6 1 6
7
8 DCF
Color 9
10
LC T HCF
R_5V_PS 7 3
JC39-02256A DGND 8 2
1 1 6 1 6 7 5V_PS 9 1
nSENSE_OPC_HOM E_M
2 2 5 2 5 8 ON_ERASER_C
3 3 4 3 R_5V_PS 10 3
4 4 3 4 4 9 3.3V_CRUM 11 2
DGND
3 10 SDA_CRUM _OPC_C 12 1
nSENSE_OPC_HOM E_Y
2 5 2 5 2 11 SCL_CRUM _OPC_C
1 6 1 6 1 12 DGND
2 13 ADC_INNER_TEMP
1 14 DGND OPC K
15 NC
16 NC CN29 OPC K JC39-02239A
JC39-02256A 1 10
DIR_BLDC_OPC_K 9
1 1 6 1 6 17 5V_PS 2
CLK_BLDC_OPC_K 8
2 2 5 2 5 18 ON_ERASER_M 3
nREADY_BLDC_OPC_K 7
3 3 4 3 4
nEN_BLDC_OPC_K 6
5
4 4 3 4 4
3
19
20
3.3V_CRUM
SDA_CRUM _OPC_M
NC
6 5 BLDC
2 BRK_BLDC_OPC_K 4
5 2 5 2 21 SCL_CRUM _OPC_M 7
1 DGND 3
6 1 6 1 22 DGND 8
DGND 2
9
DGND 1
10
DGND
11
JC39-02256A NC
12
1 1 6 1 6 23 5V_PS
2 2 5 2 5 24 ON_ERASER_Y
3 3 4 3
4 4 3 4 4 25 3.3V_CRUM
3 26 SDA_CRUM _OPC_Y
2 5 2 5 2 27 SCL_CRUM _OPC_Y T/C SENSOR
1 6 1 6 1 28 DGND -1.5m m /15*2P
CN34 T/C SENSOR
1 4 29 A_T1 DGND 1 JC39-02260A JC39-02259A
2 3 30 nA_T1 4 1 4
TC_VIN_K 2 3 2 3
3 2 31 nB_T1 3
24V1_TC 2 3 2
4 1 32 B_T1 4
TNR_VCON_K 1 4 1
DGND 5 4 1
JC39-02259A 4
TC_VIN_C 6 3 2 3
24V1_TC 7 2 3 2
TNR_VCON_C 8 1 4 1
R_5V_PS 9
12 1 3
DGND 10
11 2 2
nSENSE_FULL_RES_K 11
10 3 1
R_5V_PS 12
9 4 3
DGND 13
BLDC OPC KCMY 8 5 2
nSENSE_FULL_RES_C 14
7 6 1
JC39-02342A
CN47 BLDC OPC NC 15
6 7 3
JC39-02232A KCM Y 5 8 2
10 1 DIR_BLDC_OPC_K 4 9 1
9 2 CLK_BLDC_OPC_K
8 3 nREADY_BLDC_OPC_K 3 10 3
7 4 nEN_BLDC_OPC_K 2 11 2
6 5 NC
BLDC 5 6 BRAKE_BLDC_OPC_K
1 12 1
4 7 DGND DGND 16
4 1
JC39-02259A 4
3 8 DGND TC_VIN_M 17
3 2 3
2 9 24V1_SW 24V1_TC 18
2 3 2
1 10 24V1_SW TNR_VCON_M 19
1 4 1
10 11 DIR_BLDC_OPC_C DGND 20
4 1
JC39-02259A 4
9 12 CLK_BLDC_OPC_C TC_VIN_Y 21
3 2 3
8 13 nREADY_BLDC_OPC_C 24V1_TC 22
2 3 2
7 14 nEN_BLDC_OPC_C TNR_VCON_Y 23
1 4 1
6 15 NC
BLDC 5 16 BREAK_BLDC_OPC_C R_5V_PS 24
4 17 DGND DGND 25
3 18 DGND nSENSE_FULL_RES_M 26
2 19 24V7
1 20 24V7 R_5V_PS 27
DGND 28
10 21 DIR_BLDC_OPC_M nSENSE_FULL_RES_Y 29
9 22 CLK_BLDC_OPC_M
8 23 nREADY_BLDC_OPC_M NC 30
7 24 nEN_BLDC_OPC_M
6 25 NC
BLDC 5 26 BREAK_BLDC_OPC_M
4 27 DGND
3 28 DGND
2 29 24V7
1 30 24V7 HVPS2 /SKEW MO TOR
-1.5mm /12*2P
10 31 DIR_BLDC_OPC_Y CN4 HVPS2 / SKEW CN2
9 32 CLK_BLDC_OPC_Y M O TOR
33 nREADY_BLDC_OPC_Y
JC39-02228A 12 nEN_DEVE_AC_K
8 nEN_DEVE_AC_K 1 12
7 34 nEN_BLDC_OPC_Y nEN_DEVE_AC_C 2 11 11 nEN_DEVE_AC_C
6 35 NC 10 10 nEN_DEVE_AC_M
BLDC 5 36 BRK_BLDC_OPC_Y
nEN_DEVE_AC_M
nEN_DEVE_AC_Y
3
4 9 9 nEN_DEVE_AC_Y
4 37 DGND ADC_READ_HVPS_24V 5 8 8 ADC_READ_HVPS_24V
3 38 DGND DGND 6 7 7 GND
2 39 24V5 DGND 7 6 6 GND
1 40 24V5 DGND 8 5 5 GND
3.3V_PS 9 4 4 3.3V
24V2_SW 10 3 3 24V
24V2_SW 11 2 2 24V
24V2_SW 12 1 1 24V
A_SKEW _Y 13 12
nA_SKEW _Y 14 11
B_SKEW _Y 15 10
nB_SKEW _Y 16 9
A_SKEW _M 17 8
nA_SKEW _M 18 7
B_SKEW _M 19 6
nB_SKEW _M 20 5
A_SKEW _C 21 4
nA_SKEW _C 22 3
B_SKEW _C 23 2
nB_SKEW _C 24 1
W TB/CST LOCK/FAN_LSU
CN38 W TB/CST
LOCK/FAN_LSU JC39-02337A
FAN_LSU 1 3
FB_OUT_ FAN_LSU 2 2
DGND 3 1
A_W TB 4 4
nA_W TB 5 3
nB_W TB 6 2
B_W TB 7 1
DGND 8 3 1 COM
COVER_OPEN_FRONT 9 2 2 N.O.
nCOVER_OPEN_FRONT 10 1 3 N.C.
DGND 11 4 1 4
ADC_W TB_FULL 12 3 2 3
EN_W TB_LED 13 2 3 2
5V_PS 14 1 4 1
R_5V_PS 15 3
DGND 16 2
nDETECT_W TB 17 1
OUT_DC_CST_LOCK1_2 18 10 1 2 1
OUT_DC_CST_LOCK1_1 19 9 2 1 2
R_5V_PS 20 8 3 3
DGND 21 7 4 2
nSENSE_CST_LOCK1 22 6 5 1
JC39-02186A
OUT_DC_CST_LOCK2_2 23 5 6 2 1
OUT_DC_CST_LOCK2_1 24 4 7 1 2
R_5V_PS 25 3 8 3
DGND 26 2 9 2
nSENSE_CST_LOCK2 27 1 10 1
NC 28
M ono Only
HVPS(MONO)
HVPS
HEATER SW ITCH
24FFC
M AIN SW ITCH
CN31 HVPS
nDETECT_HVPS 1 1 nDETECT_HVPS
24V2_SW 2 2 24V
24V2_SW 3 3 24V
ADC_HVPS_24V 4 4 ADC_HVPS_24V
24V2_SW 5 5 24V
GND 6 6 GND
GND 7 7 GND
3.3V 8 8 3.3V
GND 9 9 GND
NC 10 10 NC
JC39-02197A
11 11 ADC_READ_M HV
AC
ADC_READ_M HV
PW M _THV+_CV_hybrid 12 12 PW M _THV+_CV_hybrid
JC39-02203A
PW M _M HV 13 13 PW M _M HV
PW M _THV+_CV_SELECT_hybrid 14 14 PW M _THV+_CV_SELECT_hybrid
9
3
C
J
1
2
0
-
A
7
ToFUSER
PW M _SAW 15 15 PW M _SAW
ADC_READ_THV 16 16 ADC_READ_THV
INLET
PW M _THV_N 17 17 PW M _THV_N
nEN_DEVE 18 18 nEN_DEVE
PW M _FUSER_BIAS 19 19 PW M _FUSER_BIAS
PW M _DEVE_DC 20 20 PW M _DEVE_DC
GND
PW M _THV_P 21 21 PW M _THV_P
PW M _DEVE_VPP 22 22 PW M _DEVE_VPP
JC39-02199A
PW M _DEVE_AC 23 23 PW M _DEVE_AC
GND 24 24 GND
JC39-02248A
4
3
2
1
HEATER SW ITCH
4
3
2
1
2
1
3
2
1
M AIN SW ITCH
LIVE
LIVE
NEUTRAL
NEUTRAL
CN10
LIVE
LIVE
NEUTRAL
NEUTRAL
CN5
NEUTRAL
LIVE
CN1
COM M ON
LAM P2
LAM P1
CN6
FUSER
INLET
DEVE HV M 2
JC39-02249A
To INPUT OPTION
THV M
JC39-02247A
SAW /M HV
CN2 1
1 LIVE
2 NEUTRAL 2
M ono :SM PS TYPE3R
Color SM
TYPE5 3
(OPTI
INPUT OPTION
CN7 (Blue)
1 LIVE CN3
JC39-02246A
2 NEUTRAL 1 LIVE
O N/SCAN)
1
: PS TYPE4
FDB
2 NEUTRAL FUSER HV M 2
TYPE3R TYPE3R
JC39-02193A
DCF
CON1 CN8(Red)
LIVE 1 1 LIVE CN4
NEUTRAL 2 2 NEUTRAL 1 LIVE
2 NEUTRAL JC39-02196A
9
3
C
J
1
2
0
-
A
6
JC39-02192A
ColorOnly
220V Only
HVPS
35FFC
HVPS(COLOR)
CN11
CN3 HVPS
ON_FUSER_CENTER 1
1
REACTOR
ON_FUSER_RELAY 5
ON_SM PS_RELAY 7
nDETECT_HVPS 1 1 nDETECT_HVPS
FUSER_ON
24VS
RELAY_ON
24V_ON/OFF
GND
CON4
+24V3
GND
+24V2
GND
+24V1
GND
+5V
CON3
ON_FUSER_SIDE 2
2
PW M _D_AC_FREQ 2 2 PW M _D_AC_FREQ
TYPE3R S
ZERO_CROSS 10
SM PS TYPE 3R
M AIN IF
PW M _D_AC_VPP_Y 3 3 PW M _D_AC_VPP_Y
AC_SENSE 9
+24VS1 4
PW M _D_DC_Y 5 5 PW M _D_DC_Y
GND 8
GND 3
CN12
CN9
IGNAL
NC 6 6 NC
1
PW M _DC_AC_VPP_M 7 7 PW M _DC_AC_VPP_M
2
5
4
3
2
1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
PW M _THV+_CC_SEL 8 8 PW M _THV+_CC_SEL
PW M _D_DC_M 9 9 PW M _D_DC_M
JC27-00009A PW M _THV+CC_Hyb 10 10 PW M _THV+CC_Hyb
2
C
J
0
-
7
A
9 PW M _D_AC_VPP_C 11 11 PW M _D_AC_VPP_C
PW M _M HV_K 12 12 PW M _M HV_K
SM PS TYPE5 6*2P PW M _D_DC_C 13 13 PW M _D_DC_C
CN5 SM PS TYPE5 PW M _M HV_C 14 14 PW M _M HV_C
1 5V1 PW M _D_AC_VPP_K 15 15 PW M _D_AC_VPP_K
2 5V2 PW M _M HV_M 16 16 PW M _M HV_M
SM PS TYPE 5 PW M _D_DC_K 17 17 PW M _D_DC_K
TYPE5 3 24V1
4 24V2 PW M _M HV_Y 18 18 PW M _M HV_Y
CN3 JC39-02213A(C) 19 19 ADC_R_THV2
1 5 ADC_R_THV2
CN1 +24V1 1 9
3
C
J
2
0
-
(
A
4
) M)
M
JC39-02344A( 6
24V3
ADC_R_M HV_C 20 20 ADC_R_M HV_C
1 LIVE 24V4 HV_OPC_Y
JC39-02225A
GND 2 21 21 PW M _THV_2
2 NEUTRAL 7 DGND PW M _THV_2
+24V2 3 22 22 ADC_R_M HV_M
8 DGND ADC_R_M HV_M HV_OPC_M
GND 4 23 23 PW M _THV2_CLEAN
9 DGND PW M _THV2_CLEAN
+24V3 5 ADC_R_M HV_Y 24 24 ADC_R_M HV_Y
10 DGND HV_OPC_C
GND 6 25 25 PW M _SAW
11 DGND PW M _SAW
+24V4 7 26 26 ADC_R_ITHV_Y
12 DGND ADC_R_ITHV_Y
(M ain SYSTEM )
GND 8 HV_OPC_K
PW M _FUSER_BIAS 27 27 PW M _FUSER_BIAS
SM PS TYPE5
JC39-02223A
CN4 5V_OPT HV_DEVE_Y
GND 1 1
3
C
J
2
0
-
9
A
4
) M)
M
(
JC39-02343A( 7 2 24V5 PW M _ITHV_M 32 32 PW M _ITHV_M
+24V_ON/OFF 2 6 3 PW M _ITHV_K 33 33 PW M _ITHV_K
24V6 HV_DEVE_M
GND 3 5 4 PW M _ITHV_C 34 34 PW M _ITHV_C
24V7
4 5 GND 35 35 GND
DGND HV_DEVE_C
3 6 DGND
SM PS TYPE 5 2 7 DGND
1 HV_DEVE_K
8 DGND
CN2
+5V1 1
GND 2
JC39-02226A
HV_T1_Y 1
+5V2 3 AC CTRL./FDB /PAPER 2
GND 4
DET 1.5m m /17*2P HV_T1_M 3
JC39-02221A(C) CN39 AC CTRL./ 4
1
J
-
9
3
C
2
0
M
(
A
) M)
JC39-02233A( FDB / PAPER DET HV_T1_C 5
JC39-02196A
9
3
C
J
1
2
0
-
A
6 6
17 1 ZEROCROSS
10 1 HV_T1_K 7
16 2 AC_SENS
9 2
15 3 DGND
8 3
14 4 ON_SM PS_RREAY
7 4
JC39-02227A
13 5 24V3
6 5
12 6 ON_FUSER_RELAY T2 HV
5 6
11 7 24VS_FUSER
4 7
10 8 DGND
3 8
9 9 ON_FUSER_SIDE
2 9
8 10 ON_FUSER_CENTER
1 10 1
3
2 11 11 EN_24V_ENGINE 2
7
JC39-02224A
1 12 6 12 DGND HV_SAW
3
5
4
3
2 13 5 13 EN_24V_OPTION
1 14 4 14 DGND
3 15 3 15 FAN_SM PS
SM PS
FAN
2 16 2 16 FB_OUT_FAN_SM PS
1 17 1 17 DGND
18 nDETECT_CST1
PAPER SIZE1 PAPER SIZE2
4
3 19 DGND
2 20 ADC_P_SIZE1
1 21 DGND
4 22 nDETECT_CST2
3 23 DGND
2 24 ADC_P_SIZE2
1 25 1.8V_PS
26 FAN_DEVE
DEVE / OPC
3
2 27 FB_OUT_FAN_DEVE
FAN
1 28 DGND
4 29 ADC_OUT_TEM P
3 30 DGND
2 31 ADC_OUT_HUM I
1 32 3.3V_PS
OU T TEM P
/HUM ID
33 NC
34 NC
● Precautions
● Service approach
● Problem solving
ENWW 1177
Precautions
Caution for safety
Electric shock and fire safety precautions
Failure to follow these instructions could result in electric shock or cause a fire.
1. Use the correct voltage. Failure to do so could damage the printer and cause fire or electric shock.
2. Use the power cable supplied with the printer. Use of an incorrectly specified cable could cause overheating
and fire.
3. Do not overload the power socket. This could lead to overheating of the cables inside the wall and cause
fire.
4. Keep water and other liquids, paper clips, pins, and other foreign objects away from the printer. Contact
with liquids or these objects might cause electric shock or fire.
5. Do not touch the plugs on the ends of the power cable with wet hands. When servicing the printer, remove
the power plug from the wall socket.
7. Take care of the power cable. Do not allow the power cable to become twisted or sharply bent around
corners as this will cause damage. Do not place objects on top of the power cable. Damage to the power
cable might cause overheating and fire. Exposed cables might cause electric shock. Replace damaged
power cable immediately. Do not reuse or repair a damaged power cable. Certain chemicals can damage
the coating on the power cable, weakening the coating or exposing cables which might cause electric shock
or fire.
8. Make sure that the power outlet and plugs are not cracked or broken. Repair these defects as soon as
possible. Be careful to not cut or damage the power cable or plugs when moving the printer.
10. Do not place the printer in damp or dusty areas. Install the printer in a clean, well-ventilated location. Do
not position the printer near a humidifier or in front of an air conditioner. Moisture and dust build up inside
the printer can lead to overheating and cause fire or rust.
11. Do not place the printer in direct sunlight. Direct sunlight can cause the temperature inside the printer to
rise causing failure to work properly, and in extreme conditions, might lead to fire.
12. Do not insert metal objects into the printer through the ventilator fan or other parts of the casing. Doing so
could lead to the metal object making contact with the high voltage conductor inside the printer, causing
electric shock.
13. Wait 5 minutes after unplugging the power cable before replacing the LVPS board to avoid electric shock.
Handling precautions
The following instructions are for the user’s personal safety, to avoid injury, and to avoid damage to the printer.
1. Make sure the printer is placed on a level surface capable of supporting the weight of the printer. Failure to
do so could cause the printer to tip or fall.
2. The printer contains rollers, gears, and fans. Make sure to not catch fingers, hair, or clothing in any these
rotating devices.
3. Do not place any small metal objects, or containers of water, chemicals, or other liquids close to the printer.
If spilled, these objects or liquids could get into the printer and cause damage, or cause electric shock or
fire.
4. Do not place the printer in damp or dusty areas, near an open window, or close to a humidifier or heater.
These conditions can cause damage to the printer.
6. Make sure that the printer is installed and operated in an area that meets temperature and humidity
specifications.
– The printer cannot be used immediately after being stored at below zero Celsius for long periods of
time. Doing so could cause malfunction. Place the printer in an area where it can reach room
temperature before operation.
2. Make sure that the power cable is disconnected before servicing or replacing any electrical parts.
4. Use approved replacement parts. Make sure that the part number, printer name, voltage, and current or
temperature ratings are correct.
5. Do not excessive force to remove or refit parts, especially when fitting screws into plastic.
6. Make sure not to drop any small parts into the printer.
– The OPC Drum can be permanently damaged if exposed to light. Be careful not to expose the OPC
Drum to direct sunlight, fluorescent light, or incandescent room lighting. Exposure for as little as 5
minutes can damage the surface of the photoconductive properties and will result in print quality
degradation. Be careful when servicing the printer. Remove the OPC Drum and store it in a black bag
or other lightproof container. Be careful when working with the printer if the covers, especially the top
cover, are open, as light is admitted to the OPC area and can damage the OPC Drum.
– Make sure not to scratch the green surface of the OPC Drum Unit. If the green surface of the Drum
Cartridge is scratched or touched, the print quality will be compromised.
The fuser unit operates at high temperatures. Wait for the fuser unit to cool down before disassembly.
To avoid injury, do not put fingers, hair, or clothes near moving parts such as the paper feeding entrance,
motor, and fan.
The printer is heavy. To avoid injury, use the lifting handles located on each side of the printer and lift
carefully.
Make sure the printer is placed on a level surface that is capable of supporting the weight of the printer.
Failure to do so could cause the printer to tip or fall, possibly causing personal injury or damage to the
printer.
5. Do not install the printer on a sloping or unstable surface. After installation, make sure that the printer is
stable.
ESD precautions
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Look for the ESD reminder when
removing printer parts. Always perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD
workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an
ESD-sensitive assembly.
Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
Sensor location
Roller location
7 TB Middle Roller
Item Name
Punch unit
3 Feed unit Transports the paper to the compile and eject unit.
7 Booklet unit Folds paper, completes stapling jobs, and transports paper to
the tray.
8 IPTU Transports the paper from the main machine to the finisher
entrance.
Finisher PCA
Switch PCA
CN No. Connection
CN No. Connection
CN3 Log
CN6 Blade Home Sensor/Booklet Tamper Home Sensor/ Booklet Compile Paper Sensor
Service approach
CAUTION: When working on the product, do not pick up the unit by the output tray, which will detach under the
weight of the product.
● Do not make unauthorized changes or additions to the printer. Unauthorized changes might cause the
printer to malfunction and create electric shock or fire hazards.
● Use caution when dismantling the unit. Take note of the location of each screw or other part. This printer
contains 19 different screws. Using the wrong screw might lead to system failure, short circuit or electric
shock.
● Do not disassemble the laser scanner assembly. Once the laser scanner assembly is disassembled, dust
might enter the mirror chamber and will seriously degrade print quality. There are no serviceable parts
inside the laser scanner assembly.
● Regularly check the condition of the power cable, plug and socket. Bad contacts might lead to overheating
and fire. Damaged cables might lead to electric shock or unit malfunction.
– Do not touch any soldered connections, connector terminals, or other electronic parts when handling
insulated parts.
– Touch a grounded area of the printer chassis to discharge static electric charge before touching a PCA.
– Do not touch a PCA with bare hands or metal objects. Doing so might create a short circuit or cause
electric shock. Use caution when handling a PCA with moving parts such as sensors, motors, or
lamps, as they might become very hot.
– Use caution when fitting and removing screws. Watch for hidden screens. Make sure that the correct
screw is used and make sure that when toothed washers are removed, they are refitted in their
original positions.
– Place the product on an ESD workstation or mat, or use an ESD strap (if one is available). If an ESD
workstation, mat, or strap is not available, ground yourself by touching the sheet-metal chassis
before touching an ESD-sensitive part.
● Place the product on an ESD workstation or mat, or use an ESD strap (if one is available). If an ESD
workstation, mat, or strap is not available, ground yourself by touching the sheet-metal chassis before
touching an ESD-sensitive part.
● Verify the functions of the printer that might have been impacted by service procedures. Make sure the
printer is in complete working order.
Post-service test
Perform the following tests to verify that the repair or replacement was successful:
Print-quality test
1. Verify that you have completed the necessary reassembly steps.
3. Attach the power cord and interface cable or interface cables, and then turn on the product.
5. Print a print quality page, and then verify that there are no lines, streaks, banding, or other print quality
defects.
6. Send a print job from the host computer, and then verify that the output meets expectations.
or
partsurfer.hp.com
Order through service or support providers Contact an HP-authorized service or support provider.
Order using the HP Embedded Web Server (EWS) To access, in a supported Web browser on your computer, enter the printer IP
address or host name in the address/URL field. The EWS contains a link to the HP
SureSupply Web site, which provides options for purchasing Original HP supplies.
Orderable parts
Not all of the parts shown in the diagrams in this chapter can be ordered. Refer to the table following the
diagram or the parts lists at the end of this chapter to determine if a part is orderable.
● Top cover
● Front door
● Rear cover
● Front cover
● Booklet tray
● Caster cover
● Controller PCA
● Stapler unit
● Ejector unit
● Booklet finisher
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1199
Top output bin
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the top output bin on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● No special tools are needed to remove or install this assembly.
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1201
Right top cover
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the right top cover of the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-14 Remove six screws and the right top cover
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1203
NOTE: HP recommends responsible disposal of the defective part.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the top cover of the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1205
Post service test
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-15 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1207
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the front door for the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1209
○ Connect the printer power cable.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-19 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1211
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
3. Use a small, flat-blade screwdriver to release the lower hinge pin from the retainer, and then rotate it away
from the finisher.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1213
4. Support the door with one hand, and then pull the lower hinge pin straight up to remove it.
5. Support the door with one hand, and then remove one screw (callout 1) to release the strap. Remove the
front door
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1215
Rear cover
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the rear cover for the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-28 Remove six screws and the right top cover
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1217
Figure 7-29 Remove six screws
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1219
2. Remove one screw cap and four machine screws (callout 1) Remove the rear cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the front cover for the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1221
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-34 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1223
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
3. Use a small, flat-blade screwdriver to release the lower hinge pin from the retainer, and then rotate it away
from the finisher.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1225
4. Support the door with one hand, and then pull the lower hinge pin straight up to remove it.
5. Support the door with one hand, and then remove one screw (callout 1) to release the strap. Remove the
front door
2. If the punch unit is installed, remove the punch waste bin (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1227
4. Remove five machine screws (callout 1), and then remove the front cover.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the front lower cover for the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1229
After performing service
○ Connect the cable from the finisher to the printer.
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-46 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1231
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
3. Use a small, flat-blade screwdriver to release the lower hinge pin from the retainer, and then rotate it away
from the finisher.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1233
4. Support the door with one hand, and then pull the lower hinge pin straight up to remove it.
5. Support the door with one hand, and then remove one screw (callout 1) to release the strap. Remove the
front door
2. If the punch unit is installed, remove the punch waste bin (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1235
4. Remove five machine screws (callout 1), and then remove the front cover.
Figure 7-58 Remove three screws and the front lower cover
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1237
Booklet tray
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the booklet tray on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
2. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1239
Step 2: Unpack the replacement assembly
1. Dispose of the defective part.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the caster cover on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1241
Post service test
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
2. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
2. Rotate the left edge of the cover away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide the cover to the left
(callout 2) to remove it.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that two tabs (callout 3) are positioned under the front lower cover when
reinstalling the caster cover.
3
1 2
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1243
Step 3: Unpack the replacement assembly
1. Dispose of the defective part.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the lower shield assembly on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1245
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-65 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1247
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
3. Use a small, flat-blade screwdriver to release the lower hinge pin from the retainer, and then rotate it away
from the finisher.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1249
4. Support the door with one hand, and then pull the lower hinge pin straight up to remove it.
5. Support the door with one hand, and then remove one screw (callout 1) to release the strap. Remove the
front door
2. If the punch unit is installed, remove the punch waste bin (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1251
4. Remove five machine screws (callout 1), and then remove the front cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
2. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1253
Special installation instructions: Booklet tray
▲ Position the tabs (callout 1) on the tray into the slots (callout 2) on the finisher.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that two tabs (callout 3) are positioned under the front lower cover when
reinstalling the caster cover.
3
1 2
NOTE: Raise the lower output tray as needed to access the screws.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1255
2. Slide the shield down (callout 1) to release it from four tabs (callout 2), and then rotate it away from the
finisher (callout 3).
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the four tabs (callout 2) when reinstalling it.
2 1
3. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove the shield.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1257
Upper shield assembly
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the upper shield assembly on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-87 Remove six screws and the right top cover
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1259
Figure 7-88 Remove six screws
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1261
2. Pull the top hinge pin up to remove it.
3. Use a small, flat-blade screwdriver to release the lower hinge pin from the retainer, and then rotate it away
from the finisher.
5. Support the door with one hand, and then remove one screw (callout 1) to release the strap. Remove the
front door
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1263
Figure 7-96 Remove the jam-access knob
2. If the punch unit is installed, remove the punch waste bin (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1265
2. Remove one screw cap and four machine screws (callout 1) Remove the rear cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
2. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1267
2. Rotate the left edge of the cover away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide the cover to the left
(callout 2) to remove it.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that two tabs (callout 3) are positioned under the front lower cover when
reinstalling the caster cover.
3
1 2
NOTE: Raise the lower output tray as needed to access the screws.
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the four tabs (callout 2) when reinstalling it.
2 1
3. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove the shield.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1269
4. If you are replacing the lower shield assembly, locate three sensors (callout 1) on the back of the lower
shield. Remove these sensors and transfer them to the replacement part.
3. Rotate the lower edge of the shield away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide the shield down
(callout 2) to release it from two tabs (callout 3).
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the two tabs (callout 3) when reinstalling it.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1271
4. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then remove the upper shield assembly.
5. If you are replacing the upper shield assembly, locate three sensors (callout 1) on the back of the upper
shield. Remove these sensors and transfer them to the replacement part.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1273
Controller PCA
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the controller PCA on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-114 Remove six screws and the right top cover
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1275
Figure 7-115 Remove six screws
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1277
2. Remove one screw cap and four machine screws (callout 1) Remove the rear cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
Reinstallation tip: Refer to the figure below for correct positioning and connection of the cables.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1279
Stapler unit
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the staple unit on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-121 Remove six screws and the right top cover
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1281
Figure 7-122 Remove six screws
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1283
2. Pull the top hinge pin up to remove it.
3. Use a small, flat-blade screwdriver to release the lower hinge pin from the retainer, and then rotate it away
from the finisher.
5. Support the door with one hand, and then remove one screw (callout 1) to release the strap. Remove the
front door
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1285
Figure 7-130 Remove the jam-access knob
2. If the punch unit is installed, remove the punch waste bin (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1287
2. Remove one screw cap and four machine screws (callout 1) Remove the rear cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
3. At the back of the finisher, release one retainer (callout 1), disconnect two connectors (callout 2), and then
remove two screws (callout 3).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1289
4. At the front of the finisher, disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then remove two screws (callout 2).
5. Lift up, and then slide the staple unit to the front of the finisher to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1291
Dummy feed guide
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the dummy feed guide on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-140 Remove six screws and the right top cover
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1293
Figure 7-141 Remove six screws
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1295
2. Remove one screw cap and four machine screws (callout 1) Remove the rear cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1297
Top jam access cover
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the top jam access cover for the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-147 Remove six screws and the right top cover
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1299
Figure 7-148 Remove six screws
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1301
2. Pull the top hinge pin up to remove it.
3. Use a small, flat-blade screwdriver to release the lower hinge pin from the retainer, and then rotate it away
from the finisher.
5. Support the door with one hand, and then remove one screw (callout 1) to release the strap. Remove the
front door
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1303
Figure 7-156 Remove the jam-access knob
2. If the punch unit is installed, remove the punch waste bin (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1305
2. Remove one screw cap and four machine screws (callout 1) Remove the rear cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that the belt (callout 4) is positioned on the gear behind the motor when
reinstalling the motor.
4
3
1
2
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1307
NOTE: HP recommends responsible disposal of the defective part.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the top lower feed assembly for the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1309
After performing service
○ Connect the cable from the finisher to the printer.
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-164 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1311
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
3. Use a small, flat-blade screwdriver to release the lower hinge pin from the retainer, and then rotate it away
from the finisher.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1313
4. Support the door with one hand, and then pull the lower hinge pin straight up to remove it.
5. Support the door with one hand, and then remove one screw (callout 1) to release the strap. Remove the
front door
2. If the punch unit is installed, remove the punch waste bin (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1315
4. Remove five machine screws (callout 1), and then remove the front cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that the belt (callout 4) is positioned on the gear behind the motor when
reinstalling the motor.
4
3
1
2
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1317
Step 7: Remove the top jam access cover
1. At the rear of the finisher, remove two screws (callout 1).
2. At the front of the finisher, remove three self-tapping screws (callout 1), and then disconnect one
connector (callout 2).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1319
3. At the rear of the finisher, remove three machine screws (callout 1).
4. At the top of the finisher, lift the feed assembly straight up to disengage two tabs on the bottom and
remove the assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1321
Ejector unit
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the ejector unit on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-186 Remove six screws and the right top cover
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1323
Figure 7-187 Remove six screws
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1325
2. Pull the top hinge pin up to remove it.
3. Use a small, flat-blade screwdriver to release the lower hinge pin from the retainer, and then rotate it away
from the finisher.
5. Support the door with one hand, and then remove one screw (callout 1) to release the strap. Remove the
front door
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1327
Figure 7-195 Remove the jam-access knob
2. If the punch unit is installed, remove the punch waste bin (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1329
2. Remove one screw cap and four machine screws (callout 1) Remove the rear cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
2. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1331
2. Rotate the left edge of the cover away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide the cover to the left
(callout 2) to remove it.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that two tabs (callout 3) are positioned under the front lower cover when
reinstalling the caster cover.
3
1 2
NOTE: Raise the lower output tray as needed to access the screws.
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the four tabs (callout 2) when reinstalling it.
2 1
3. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove the shield.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1333
4. If you are replacing the lower shield assembly, locate three sensors (callout 1) on the back of the lower
shield. Remove these sensors and transfer them to the replacement part.
3. Rotate the lower edge of the shield away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide the shield down
(callout 2) to release it from two tabs (callout 3).
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the two tabs (callout 3) when reinstalling it.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1335
4. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then remove the upper shield assembly.
5. If you are replacing the upper shield assembly, locate three sensors (callout 1) on the back of the upper
shield. Remove these sensors and transfer them to the replacement part.
2. Release one retainer (callout 1), and then disconnect three connectors (callout 2).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1337
3. Remove two screws (callout 1).
4. At the left side of the finisher, remove one screw (callout 1).
1
3
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1339
7. Look inside the finisher through the stapler opening in the front and pull down to release and remove one
shaft (callout 1) on the front tamper unit.
8. At the rear of the finisher, disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove three screws (callout 2).
10. Look inside the finisher through the stapler opening in the rear and pull down to release and remove one
shaft (callout 1) on the rear tamper unit.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1341
11. At the left side of the finisher, disconnect one connector (callout 1).
12. At the rear of the finisher, disconnect one connector (callout 1).
14. At the front of the finisher, remove two screws (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1343
15. Lift the inside edges of the front and rear tampers up.
16. Rotate the rear edge of the ejector unit away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide it toward the rear
of the finisher (callout 2) to remove it. Make sure that the PCA (callout 3) stays clear of the sheet metal
frame.
1 2
3
17. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
a. When the front tamper shaft is removed, the retainer arm that held the one end of the shaft will drop
down. When reinstalling the shaft, raise the retainer arm and position the end of the shaft in the
notch (callout 1).
b. When the rear tamper shaft is removed, the retainer arm that held the one end of the shaft will drop
down. When reinstalling the shaft, raise the retainer arm and position the end of the shaft in the
notch (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1345
NOTE: HP recommends responsible disposal of the defective part.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the front tamper unit on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1347
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-231 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1349
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
3. Use a small, flat-blade screwdriver to release the lower hinge pin from the retainer, and then rotate it away
from the finisher.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1351
4. Support the door with one hand, and then pull the lower hinge pin straight up to remove it.
5. Support the door with one hand, and then remove one screw (callout 1) to release the strap. Remove the
front door
2. If the punch unit is installed, remove the punch waste bin (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1353
4. Remove five machine screws (callout 1), and then remove the front cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
2. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1355
Special installation instructions: Booklet tray
▲ Position the tabs (callout 1) on the tray into the slots (callout 2) on the finisher.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that two tabs (callout 3) are positioned under the front lower cover when
reinstalling the caster cover.
3
1 2
NOTE: Raise the lower output tray as needed to access the screws.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1357
2. Slide the shield down (callout 1) to release it from four tabs (callout 2), and then rotate it away from the
finisher (callout 3).
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the four tabs (callout 2) when reinstalling it.
2 1
3. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove the shield.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1359
2. Remove six machine screws (callout 1).
3. Rotate the lower edge of the shield away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide the shield down
(callout 2) to release it from two tabs (callout 3).
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the two tabs (callout 3) when reinstalling it.
5. If you are replacing the upper shield assembly, locate three sensors (callout 1) on the back of the upper
shield. Remove these sensors and transfer them to the replacement part.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1361
Figure 7-258 Move the staple unit to the center
2. Release one retainer (callout 1), and then disconnect three connectors (callout 2).
4. At the left side of the finisher, remove one screw (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1363
5. Press up on the hinge (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then rotate the sensor away from the
finisher (callout 3).
1
3
8. At the rear of the finisher, disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove three screws (callout 2).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1365
9. At the left side of the finisher, remove one screw (callout 1).
10. Look inside the finisher through the stapler opening in the rear and pull down to release and remove one
shaft (callout 1) on the rear tamper unit.
12. At the rear of the finisher, disconnect one connector (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1367
13. At the rear of the finisher, press the wire retainer to the right to access and remove two screws (callout 1).
14. At the front of the finisher, remove two screws (callout 1).
16. Rotate the rear edge of the ejector unit away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide it toward the rear
of the finisher (callout 2) to remove it. Make sure that the PCA (callout 3) stays clear of the sheet metal
frame.
1 2
3
17. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
a. When the front tamper shaft is removed, the retainer arm that held the one end of the shaft will drop
down. When reinstalling the shaft, raise the retainer arm and position the end of the shaft in the
notch (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1369
Figure 7-274 Reinstall the front tamper shaft
b. When the rear tamper shaft is removed, the retainer arm that held the one end of the shaft will drop
down. When reinstalling the shaft, raise the retainer arm and position the end of the shaft in the
notch (callout 1).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1371
Rear tamper unit
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the rear tamper unit on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-277 Remove six screws and the right top cover
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1373
Figure 7-278 Remove six screws
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1375
2. Pull the top hinge pin up to remove it.
3. Use a small, flat-blade screwdriver to release the lower hinge pin from the retainer, and then rotate it away
from the finisher.
5. Support the door with one hand, and then remove one screw (callout 1) to release the strap. Remove the
front door
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1377
Figure 7-286 Remove the jam-access knob
2. If the punch unit is installed, remove the punch waste bin (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1379
2. Remove one screw cap and four machine screws (callout 1) Remove the rear cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
2. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1381
2. Rotate the left edge of the cover away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide the cover to the left
(callout 2) to remove it.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that two tabs (callout 3) are positioned under the front lower cover when
reinstalling the caster cover.
3
1 2
NOTE: Raise the lower output tray as needed to access the screws.
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the four tabs (callout 2) when reinstalling it.
2 1
3. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove the shield.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1383
4. If you are replacing the lower shield assembly, locate three sensors (callout 1) on the back of the lower
shield. Remove these sensors and transfer them to the replacement part.
3. Rotate the lower edge of the shield away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide the shield down
(callout 2) to release it from two tabs (callout 3).
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the two tabs (callout 3) when reinstalling it.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1385
4. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then remove the upper shield assembly.
5. If you are replacing the upper shield assembly, locate three sensors (callout 1) on the back of the upper
shield. Remove these sensors and transfer them to the replacement part.
2. Release one retainer (callout 1), and then disconnect three connectors (callout 2).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1387
3. Remove two screws (callout 1).
4. At the left side of the finisher, remove one screw (callout 1).
1
3
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1389
7. Look inside the finisher through the stapler opening in the front and pull down to release and remove one
shaft (callout 1) on the front tamper unit.
8. At the rear of the finisher, disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove three screws (callout 2).
10. Look inside the finisher through the stapler opening in the rear and pull down to release and remove one
shaft (callout 1) on the rear tamper unit.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1391
11. At the left side of the finisher, disconnect one connector (callout 1).
12. At the rear of the finisher, disconnect one connector (callout 1).
14. At the front of the finisher, remove two screws (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1393
15. Lift the inside edges of the front and rear tampers up.
16. Rotate the rear edge of the ejector unit away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide it toward the rear
of the finisher (callout 2) to remove it. Make sure that the PCA (callout 3) stays clear of the sheet metal
frame.
1 2
3
17. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
a. When the front tamper shaft is removed, the retainer arm that held the one end of the shaft will drop
down. When reinstalling the shaft, raise the retainer arm and position the end of the shaft in the
notch (callout 1).
b. When the rear tamper shaft is removed, the retainer arm that held the one end of the shaft will drop
down. When reinstalling the shaft, raise the retainer arm and position the end of the shaft in the
notch (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1395
Figure 7-322 Remove the rear tamper
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the feed entrance motor on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1397
○ Connect the printer power cable.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-323 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1399
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that the belt (callout 4) is positioned on the gear behind the motor when
reinstalling the motor.
3 4
1
2
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1401
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly
1. Dispose of the defective part.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the feed exit motor on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1403
○ Connect the printer power cable.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-330 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1405
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that the belt (callout 4) is positioned on the gear behind the motor when
reinstalling the motor.
4
3
1
2
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1407
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly
1. Dispose of the defective part.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the buffer motor, gear, and sensor on the
finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1409
○ Connect the printer power cable.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-337 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1411
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
2. If the punch unit is installed, remove the punch waste bin (callout 1).
4. Remove five machine screws (callout 1), and then remove the front cover.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1413
Figure 7-344 Disconnect two connectors and remove two screws
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1415
b. Lower the motor (callout 1) and then pull it away from the housing (callout 2) to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the front tamper motor on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1417
Front tamper motor (M6) part number
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-349 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1419
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
3. Use a small, flat-blade screwdriver to release the lower hinge pin from the retainer, and then rotate it away
from the finisher.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1421
4. Support the door with one hand, and then pull the lower hinge pin straight up to remove it.
5. Support the door with one hand, and then remove one screw (callout 1) to release the strap. Remove the
front door
2. If the punch unit is installed, remove the punch waste bin (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1423
4. Remove five machine screws (callout 1), and then remove the front cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
2. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1425
Special installation instructions: Booklet tray
▲ Position the tabs (callout 1) on the tray into the slots (callout 2) on the finisher.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that two tabs (callout 3) are positioned under the front lower cover when
reinstalling the caster cover.
3
1 2
NOTE: Raise the lower output tray as needed to access the screws.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1427
2. Slide the shield down (callout 1) to release it from four tabs (callout 2), and then rotate it away from the
finisher (callout 3).
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the four tabs (callout 2) when reinstalling it.
2 1
3. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove the shield.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1429
2. Remove six machine screws (callout 1).
3. Rotate the lower edge of the shield away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide the shield down
(callout 2) to release it from two tabs (callout 3).
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the two tabs (callout 3) when reinstalling it.
5. If you are replacing the upper shield assembly, locate three sensors (callout 1) on the back of the upper
shield. Remove these sensors and transfer them to the replacement part.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1431
Figure 7-376 Move the staple unit to the center
2. Release one retainer (callout 1), and then disconnect three connectors (callout 2).
4. At the left side of the finisher, remove one screw (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1433
5. Press up on the hinge (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then rotate the sensor away from the
finisher (callout 3).
1
3
8. At the rear of the finisher, disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove three screws (callout 2).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1435
9. At the left side of the finisher, remove one screw (callout 1).
10. Look inside the finisher through the stapler opening in the rear and pull down to release and remove one
shaft (callout 1) on the rear tamper unit.
12. At the rear of the finisher, disconnect one connector (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1437
13. At the rear of the finisher, press the wire retainer to the right to access and remove two screws (callout 1).
14. At the front of the finisher, remove two screws (callout 1).
16. Rotate the rear edge of the ejector unit away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide it toward the rear
of the finisher (callout 2) to remove it. Make sure that the PCA (callout 3) stays clear of the sheet metal
frame.
1 2
3
17. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
a. When the front tamper shaft is removed, the retainer arm that held the one end of the shaft will drop
down. When reinstalling the shaft, raise the retainer arm and position the end of the shaft in the
notch (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1439
Figure 7-392 Reinstall the front tamper shaft
b. When the rear tamper shaft is removed, the retainer arm that held the one end of the shaft will drop
down. When reinstalling the shaft, raise the retainer arm and position the end of the shaft in the
notch (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1441
2. Release the belt (callout 1), and then remove the front tamper motor.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that the belt is routed correctly when reinstalling the motor.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the rear tamper motor on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1443
Rear tamper motor (M7) part number
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-397 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1445
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
3. Use a small, flat-blade screwdriver to release the lower hinge pin from the retainer, and then rotate it away
from the finisher.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1447
4. Support the door with one hand, and then pull the lower hinge pin straight up to remove it.
5. Support the door with one hand, and then remove one screw (callout 1) to release the strap. Remove the
front door
2. If the punch unit is installed, remove the punch waste bin (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1449
4. Remove five machine screws (callout 1), and then remove the front cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
2. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1451
Special installation instructions: Booklet tray
▲ Position the tabs (callout 1) on the tray into the slots (callout 2) on the finisher.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that two tabs (callout 3) are positioned under the front lower cover when
reinstalling the caster cover.
3
1 2
NOTE: Raise the lower output tray as needed to access the screws.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1453
2. Slide the shield down (callout 1) to release it from four tabs (callout 2), and then rotate it away from the
finisher (callout 3).
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the four tabs (callout 2) when reinstalling it.
2 1
3. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove the shield.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1455
2. Remove six machine screws (callout 1).
3. Rotate the lower edge of the shield away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide the shield down
(callout 2) to release it from two tabs (callout 3).
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the two tabs (callout 3) when reinstalling it.
5. If you are replacing the upper shield assembly, locate three sensors (callout 1) on the back of the upper
shield. Remove these sensors and transfer them to the replacement part.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1457
Figure 7-424 Move the staple unit to the center
2. Release one retainer (callout 1), and then disconnect three connectors (callout 2).
4. At the left side of the finisher, remove one screw (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1459
5. Press up on the hinge (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then rotate the sensor away from the
finisher (callout 3).
1
3
8. At the rear of the finisher, disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove three screws (callout 2).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1461
9. At the left side of the finisher, remove one screw (callout 1).
10. Look inside the finisher through the stapler opening in the rear and pull down to release and remove one
shaft (callout 1) on the rear tamper unit.
12. At the rear of the finisher, disconnect one connector (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1463
13. At the rear of the finisher, press the wire retainer to the right to access and remove two screws (callout 1).
14. At the front of the finisher, remove two screws (callout 1).
16. Rotate the rear edge of the ejector unit away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide it toward the rear
of the finisher (callout 2) to remove it. Make sure that the PCA (callout 3) stays clear of the sheet metal
frame.
1 2
3
17. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
a. When the front tamper shaft is removed, the retainer arm that held the one end of the shaft will drop
down. When reinstalling the shaft, raise the retainer arm and position the end of the shaft in the
notch (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1465
Figure 7-440 Reinstall the front tamper shaft
b. When the rear tamper shaft is removed, the retainer arm that held the one end of the shaft will drop
down. When reinstalling the shaft, raise the retainer arm and position the end of the shaft in the
notch (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1467
2. Release the belt (callout 1), and then remove the rear tamper motor.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that the belt is routed correctly when reinstalling the motor.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the SCU motor on the finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1469
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-445 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1471
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
3. Use a small, flat-blade screwdriver to release the lower hinge pin from the retainer, and then rotate it away
from the finisher.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1473
4. Support the door with one hand, and then pull the lower hinge pin straight up to remove it.
5. Support the door with one hand, and then remove one screw (callout 1) to release the strap. Remove the
front door
2. If the punch unit is installed, remove the punch waste bin (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1475
4. Remove five machine screws (callout 1), and then remove the front cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
2. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1477
Special installation instructions: Booklet tray
▲ Position the tabs (callout 1) on the tray into the slots (callout 2) on the finisher.
Reinstallation tip: Make sure that two tabs (callout 3) are positioned under the front lower cover when
reinstalling the caster cover.
3
1 2
NOTE: Raise the lower output tray as needed to access the screws.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1479
2. Slide the shield down (callout 1) to release it from four tabs (callout 2), and then rotate it away from the
finisher (callout 3).
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the four tabs (callout 2) when reinstalling it.
2 1
3. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove the shield.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1481
2. Remove six machine screws (callout 1).
3. Rotate the lower edge of the shield away from the finisher (callout 1), and then slide the shield down
(callout 2) to release it from two tabs (callout 3).
CAUTION: The shield is still attached to the finisher. Do not attempt to completely remove the shield.
Reinstallation tip: Position the shield under the two tabs (callout 3) when reinstalling it.
5. If you are replacing the upper shield assembly, locate three sensors (callout 1) on the back of the upper
shield. Remove these sensors and transfer them to the replacement part.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1483
Figure 7-472 Disconnect one connector
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the motor and bracket.
4. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1485
NOTE: HP recommends responsible disposal of the defective part.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the main tray moving motor (M11) on the
finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
SAM-JC90-01415A Motor
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1487
○ Connect the printer power cable.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-476 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1489
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1491
2. Open two retainers (callout 1), and then release the green wires (callout 2).
1
2
5. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the motor assembly.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1493
6. Carefully pull the motor assembly away from the printer to remove it.
7. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
a. Before installing the motor assembly, slide the bushing (callout 1) off of the shaft.
c. Position the bushing over the shaft, and then install the motor assembly.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1495
NOTE: HP recommends responsible disposal of the defective part.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the booklet finisher front cover.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1497
Post service test
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
1 4
2
3
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1499
Booklet finisher
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the booklet finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-492 Remove six screws and the right top cover
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1501
Figure 7-493 Remove six screws
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1503
2. Remove one screw cap and four machine screws (callout 1) Remove the rear cover.
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
Figure 7-498 Slide the booklet finisher away from the finisher
2
3. Release the metal bracket through the opening in the sheet metal.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1505
4. Remove one star-washer screw (callout 1), and then release the alignment pin (callout 2) on the right side
of the booklet finisher.
1 2
7. Lift the booklet finisher up on the left side while squeezing the right rail away from the finisher slightly to
clear the sheet metal. Remove the booklet finisher.
8. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1507
Figure 7-505 Position the hooks
9. When installed correctly, the arrow on the front of the booklet finisher aligns with the arrow on the finisher
rail.
11. Extend the right rail away from the finisher and position it in the booklet finisher slot.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1509
NOTE: HP recommends responsible disposal of the defective part.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the booklet finisher PCA.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1511
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-509 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1513
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
Figure 7-515 Slide the booklet finisher away from the finisher
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1515
2. At the Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then remove one screw (callout 2).
2
3. Release the metal bracket through the opening in the sheet metal.
1 2
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1517
6. Remove one star-washer screw (callout 1) on the left side of the booklet finisher.
7. Lift the booklet finisher up on the left side while squeezing the right rail away from the finisher slightly to
clear the sheet metal. Remove the booklet finisher.
8. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
9. When installed correctly, the arrow on the front of the booklet finisher aligns with the arrow on the finisher
rail.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1519
10. When installed correctly, the arrow on the back of the booklet finisher aligns with the arrow on the finisher
rail.
11. Extend the right rail away from the finisher and position it in the booklet finisher slot.
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), and then remove the metal cover.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1521
3. Disconnect all of the connectors, remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the booklet finisher PCA.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the booklet finisher fold stopper unit.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1523
After performing service
○ Connect the cable from the finisher to the printer.
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-529 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1525
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
1 4
2
3
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1527
Step 5: Remove the booklet finisher lower right shield
1. Remove two screws at the front of the booklet finisher (callout 1).
2. Remove two screws at the back of the booklet finisher (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1529
2. Raise the jam access cover.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1531
6. Release the tab (callout 1) on the guide arm, and then slide the guide off of the shaft (callout 2) to remove
it.
9. Lift the right lower corner (callout 1) to clear the cable guide, and then slide the assembly to the right
(callout 2) to remove it.
10. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1533
Figure 7-548 Adjust the alignment gauge
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the booklet feed entrance motor on the booklet
finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1535
Post service test
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
1 4
2
3
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1537
TE presser motor (M14)
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the TE presser motor on the booklet finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
1 4
2
3
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1539
Figure 7-552 Remove the TE presser motor
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the stopper moving motor on the booklet
finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1541
○ Connect the printer power cable.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
1 4
2
3
2. Remove two screws at the back of the booklet finisher (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1543
3. Slide the booklet finisher out of the finisher (callout 1), and then rotate the top of the lower right shield
(callout 2) away from the booklet finisher to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1545
Separate pawl motor (M17)
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the separate pawl motor on the booklet finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
1 4
2
3
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1547
Figure 7-559 Remove the separate pawl motor
1
2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the folding roller motor on the booklet finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1549
○ Connect the printer power cable.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
Reinstallation tip: The lower screws are shorter in length than the upper screws.
Figure 7-560 Remove six screws and the right top cover
2. Remove three self-tapping screws at the top of the front cover (callout 1), and then remove two machine
screws (callout 2) at the top of the right side.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1551
3. Lift the cover up slightly. Disconnect one in-line connector (callout 1), and then release one retainer
(callout 2).
NOTE: Make sure to thread the power cable (callout 2) through the opening in the cover.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1553
Step 5: Unpack the replacement assembly
1. Dispose of the defective part.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the blade motor on the booklet finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1555
○ Connect the printer power cable.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
1 4
2
3
2. Remove two screws at the back of the booklet finisher (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1557
3. Slide the booklet finisher out of the finisher (callout 1), and then rotate the top of the lower right shield
(callout 2) away from the booklet finisher to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1559
C fold motor (M20)
● Introduction
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove and replace the C fold motor on the booklet finisher.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the power off and wait until the printer shuts down before
removing the power cable.
○ Disconnect the printer power cable after the printer has completely shut down (the control-panel display is
blank).
○ Release the finisher from the printer by pulling out on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 JIS screwdriver with a magnetic tip
○ Attach the finisher to the printer, and then push in on the release latch inside the finisher door.
Process a job through the finisher and verify that the finisher works correctly.
1 4
2
3
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1561
Figure 7-573 Check arrow alignment
4. Remove one e-clip (callout 1) on top of the white gear. Remove the white gear (callout 2) and release the
belt (callout 3).
1 2
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1563
5. Remove the bracket and motor from the booklet finisher.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the shaft (callout 1) while removing the bracket and motor. The shaft might
become dislodged at the other end. If the shaft becomes dislodged, remove the booklet finisher PCA shield
and PCA bracket to reinstall the shaft.
6. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the C fold motor.
7. Reverse the removal steps to install the assembly. Also use the following special installation instructions.
NOTE: Continue to reverse the removal steps to finish installing the assembly.
a. When installing the motor, install one screw (callout 1) to hold the bracket in place while installing the
gear and belt.
b. Check the position of the alignment arrows on the upper white gear and the lower motor (callout 1).
ENWW Removal and replacement procedures (stapler/stacker and booklet finishers) 1565
c. If the arrows are not aligned, slightly pull up on the belt to create some slack around the gear
(callout 1), and then rotate the gear (callout 2) until the arrows align.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Always perform service work at
an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal
chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive
assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on the roller or pad
can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves when
handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or pads.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed from
the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
Finisher system consists of the FINISHER PCA, BOOKLET MAKER PCA, SWITCH PCA, and HOLE PUNCH PCA.
PCA function
● FINISHER PCA
This PCA controls the finisher modules and consists of the micro-controller and driver ICs.
● SWITCH PCA
This PCA shows the manual stapling condition and accepts the button input for manual staple operation.
This PCA controls the booklet maker module and consists of the micro-controller and driver ICs.
This PCA controls the hole punch module and consists of the micro-controller and driver ICs.
● Precautions
● Service approach
● Problem solving
● Block Diagram
ENWW 1571
Precautions
Caution for safety
Electric shock and fire safety precautions
Failure to follow these instructions could result in electric shock or cause a fire.
1. Use the correct voltage. Failure to do so could damage the printer and cause fire or electric shock.
2. Use the power cable supplied with the printer. Use of an incorrectly specified cable could cause overheating
and fire.
3. Do not overload the power socket. This could lead to overheating of the cables inside the wall and cause
fire.
4. Keep water and other liquids, paper clips, pins, and other foreign objects away from the printer. Contact
with liquids or these objects might cause electric shock or fire.
5. Do not touch the plugs on the ends of the power cable with wet hands. When servicing the printer, remove
the power plug from the wall socket.
7. Take care of the power cable. Do not allow the power cable to become twisted or sharply bent around
corners as this will cause damage. Do not place objects on top of the power cable. Damage to the power
cable might cause overheating and fire. Exposed cables might cause electric shock. Replace damaged
power cable immediately. Do not reuse or repair a damaged power cable. Certain chemicals can damage
the coating on the power cable, weakening the coating or exposing cables which might cause electric shock
or fire.
8. Make sure that the power outlet and plugs are not cracked or broken. Repair these defects as soon as
possible. Be careful to not cut or damage the power cable or plugs when moving the printer.
10. Do not place the printer in damp or dusty areas. Install the printer in a clean, well-ventilated location. Do
not position the printer near a humidifier or in front of an air conditioner. Moisture and dust build up inside
the printer can lead to overheating and cause fire or rust.
11. Do not place the printer in direct sunlight. Direct sunlight can cause the temperature inside the printer to
rise causing failure to work properly, and in extreme conditions, might lead to fire.
12. Do not insert metal objects into the printer through the ventilator fan or other parts of the casing. Doing so
could lead to the metal object making contact with the high voltage conductor inside the printer, causing
electric shock.
13. Wait 5 minutes after unplugging the power cable before replacing the LVPS board to avoid electric shock.
Handling precautions
The following instructions are for the user’s personal safety, to avoid injury, and to avoid damage to the printer.
1. Make sure the printer is placed on a level surface capable of supporting the weight of the printer. Failure to
do so could cause the printer to tip or fall.
2. The printer contains rollers, gears, and fans. Make sure to not catch fingers, hair, or clothing in any these
rotating devices.
3. Do not place any small metal objects, or containers of water, chemicals, or other liquids close to the printer.
If spilled, these objects or liquids could get into the printer and cause damage, or cause electric shock or
fire.
4. Do not place the printer in damp or dusty areas, near an open window, or close to a humidifier or heater.
These conditions can cause damage to the printer.
6. Make sure that the printer is installed and operated in an area that meets temperature and humidity
specifications.
– The printer cannot be used immediately after being stored at below zero Celsius for long periods of
time. Doing so could cause malfunction. Place the printer in an area where it can reach room
temperature before operation.
2. Make sure that the power cable is disconnected before servicing or replacing any electrical parts.
4. Use approved replacement parts. Make sure that the part number, printer name, voltage, and current or
temperature ratings are correct.
5. Do not excessive force to remove or refit parts, especially when fitting screws into plastic.
6. Make sure not to drop any small parts into the printer.
– The OPC Drum can be permanently damaged if exposed to light. Be careful not to expose the OPC
Drum to direct sunlight, fluorescent light, or incandescent room lighting. Exposure for as little as 5
minutes can damage the surface of the photoconductive properties and will result in print quality
degradation. Be careful when servicing the printer. Remove the OPC Drum and store it in a black bag
or other lightproof container. Be careful when working with the printer if the covers, especially the top
cover, are open, as light is admitted to the OPC area and can damage the OPC Drum.
– Make sure not to scratch the green surface of the OPC Drum Unit. If the green surface of the Drum
Cartridge is scratched or touched, the print quality will be compromised.
The fuser unit operates at high temperatures. Wait for the fuser unit to cool down before disassembly.
To avoid injury, do not put fingers, hair, or clothes near moving parts such as the paper feeding entrance,
motor, and fan.
The printer is heavy. To avoid injury, use the lifting handles located on each side of the printer and lift
carefully.
Make sure the printer is placed on a level surface that is capable of supporting the weight of the printer.
Failure to do so could cause the printer to tip or fall, possibly causing personal injury or damage to the
printer.
5. Do not install the printer on a sloping or unstable surface. After installation, make sure that the printer is
stable.
ESD precautions
CAUTION: Some parts are sensitive to electrostatic discharge (ESD). Look for the ESD reminder when
removing printer parts. Always perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD
workstation or mat is not available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an
ESD-sensitive assembly.
Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when they are out of the printer.
Media Sizes ● Main: 148 - 320 mm x 140-457.2 mm (58.3-126 inch x 55.1-180 inch)
Tray1 Finishing Mode Stapling (Left, Right, Center)/Punch (2/3, 2/4, Swedish)
2H 3H 2H 4H 4H
2H 3H 2H 4H 4H
L 140-1200 L 5.5-47
Bond O O O O
LetterHead O O O O
Pre-Punched O O O X
Thick Cardstock O O O X
(170-216 g/m2)
Heavy Cardstock O O O X
(217-256 g/m2)
Tab O X X O
Item Description
M2 JC31-00009C EJECTOR_1_Motor
M3 Mabuchi EJECTOR_2_Motor
M4 JC31-00149A Tamper_Motor_Front
M5 JC31-00149A Tamper_Motor_Rear
No. Connection
4 CN8 : Debug
8 CN9 : Solenoid
● Do not make unauthorized changes or additions to the printer. Unauthorized changes might cause the
printer to malfunction and create electric shock or fire hazards.
● Use caution when dismantling the unit. Take note of the location of each screw or other part. This printer
contains 19 different screws. Using the wrong screw might lead to system failure, short circuit or electric
shock.
● Do not disassemble the laser scanner assembly. Once the laser scanner assembly is disassembled, dust
might enter the mirror chamber and will seriously degrade print quality. There are no serviceable parts
inside the laser scanner assembly.
● Regularly check the condition of the power cable, plug and socket. Bad contacts might lead to overheating
and fire. Damaged cables might lead to electric shock or unit malfunction.
– Do not touch any soldered connections, connector terminals, or other electronic parts when handling
insulated parts.
– Touch a grounded area of the printer chassis to discharge static electric charge before touching a PCA.
– Do not touch a PCA with bare hands or metal objects. Doing so might create a short circuit or cause
electric shock. Use caution when handling a PCA with moving parts such as sensors, motors, or
lamps, as they might become very hot.
– Place the product on an ESD workstation or mat, or use an ESD strap (if one is available). If an ESD
workstation, mat, or strap is not available, ground yourself by touching the sheet-metal chassis
before touching an ESD-sensitive part.
● Place the product on an ESD workstation or mat, or use an ESD strap (if one is available). If an ESD
workstation, mat, or strap is not available, ground yourself by touching the sheet-metal chassis before
touching an ESD-sensitive part.
● Verify the functions of the printer that might have been impacted by service procedures. Make sure the
printer is in complete working order.
Post-service test
Perform the following tests to verify that the repair or replacement was successful:
3. Attach the power cord and interface cable or interface cables, and then turn on the product.
5. Print a print quality page, and then verify that there are no lines, streaks, banding, or other print quality
defects.
6. Send a print job from the host computer, and then verify that the output meets expectations.
or
partsurfer.hp.com
Order through service or support providers Contact an HP-authorized service or support provider.
Order using the HP Embedded Web Server (EWS) To access, in a supported Web browser on your computer, enter the printer IP
address or host name in the address/URL field. The EWS contains a link to the HP
SureSupply Web site, which provides options for purchasing Original HP supplies.
Orderable parts
Not all of the parts shown in the diagrams in this chapter can be ordered. Refer to the table following the
diagram or the parts lists at the end of this chapter to determine if a part is orderable.
● Entrance motor
● Exit sensor
● Exit motor
● Stapler
● Traverse Motor
● Stacker Motor
● Main Paddle
● Ejector assembly
● Door Switch
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Entrance sensor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
2. On the right, back-side of the printer remove the e-ring, and then remove the shaft-side plate. Unplug the
connector.
4. Remove the e-ring and washer, and then remove the punch dummy.
6. Remove one screw, unplug the connector, and then remove the sensor bracket.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Entrance motor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub-cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub-cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub-cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
3. Release two tabs that engage with the frame, and then remove the guide middle lower.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Exit sensor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub-cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub-cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub-cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Exit motor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Exit motor
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Sub Paddle Shaft Sub assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Front Jogger Motor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the printer when reassembling.
NOTE: Position the first wheel into the channel on both sides while holding the arms. Let the second
wheel rest on the channel on both sides simultaneously. Gently squeeze the wheels into channel. The rack
and pinion may need to be engaged several times to level the assembly.
7. Remove two screws and then remove the lower PBA cover.
9. Remove one screw, and then remove the cable guide. Unplug the connector, and then remove the main
paddle home sensor sub assembly.
NOTE: Move cable out of the wiring guide to access the third screw.
11. Remove the wire harness from the harness guide, remove three screws, and then remove the guide-
harness front.
NOTE: The wire harness will hang loosely after the harness guide is removed.
13. Open the cover top tray sub assembly, and then remove one screw securing the guide-exit lower.
15. Remove the e-ring, and then remove the pulley and timing belt.
17. Lift up and remove the sub paddle shaft sub assembly.
Reinstallation tip: The cam must be installed with the same orientation as the cam on the opposite side.
Reinstallation tip: The actuator home cam paddle is installed hollow side out
NOTE: Note the orientation of paddles and use caution to not break the plastic locator pin on the paddle.
Reinstallation tip: Position the upper left-corner of the sub tamper, and then carefully rotate it counter-
clockwise into position.
23. Remove two screws, unplug the connector, and then remove the motor.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Front Jogger Home Sensor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the printer when reassembling.
NOTE: Position the first wheel into the channel on both sides while holding the arms. Let the second
wheel rest on the channel on both sides simultaneously. Gently squeeze the wheels into channel. The rack
and pinion may need to be engaged several times to level the assembly.
9. Remove one screw and then remove the cable guide. Unplug the connector, and then remove the main
paddle home sensor sub assembly.
NOTE: Move cable out of the wiring guide to access the third screw.
11. Remove the wire harness from the harness guide, remove three screws, and then remove the guide-
harness front.
NOTE: The wire harness will hang loosely after the harness guide is removed.
13. Open the cover top tray sub assembly, and then remove one screw securing the guide-exit lower.
15. Remove the e-ring, and then remove the pulley and timing belt.
17. Lift up and remove the sub paddle shaft sub assembly.
Reinstallation tip: The cam must be installed with the same orientation as the cam on the opposite side.
Reinstallation tip: The actuator home cam paddle is installed hollow side out
Figure 8-73 Remove the front jogger home sensor (10 of 15)
Figure 8-74 Remove the front jogger home sensor (11 of 15)
NOTE: Note the orientation of paddles and use caution to not break the plastic locator pin on the paddle.
Figure 8-75 Remove the front jogger home sensor (12 of 15)
Figure 8-76 Remove the front jogger home sensor (13 of 15)
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Rear Jogger Motor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the printer when reassembling.
NOTE: Position the first wheel into the channel on both sides while holding the arms. Let the second
wheel rest on the channel on both sides simultaneously. Gently squeeze the wheels into channel. The rack
and pinion may need to be engaged several times to level the assembly.
9. Remove one screw and then remove the cable guide. Unplug the connector, and then remove the main
paddle home sensor sub assembly.
13. Remove two screws, unplug the connector, and then remove the rear jogger motor.
15. Unplug two connectors, and then remove the finisher sub-tamper rear.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Rear Jogger Home Sensor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub-cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub-cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub-cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the printer when reassembling.
NOTE: Position the first wheel into the channel on both sides while holding the arms. Let the second
wheel rest on the channel on both sides simultaneously. Gently squeeze the wheels into channel. The rack
and pinion may need to be engaged several times to level the assembly.
9. Remove one screw and then remove the cable guide. Unplug the connector, and then remove the main
paddle home sensor sub assembly.
Figure 8-101 Remove the front jogger home sensor (10 of 11)
11. Unplug the connector, and then remove the rear jogger home sensor.
Figure 8-102 Remove the rear jogger home sensor (11 of 11)
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the stapler assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
NOTE: Ensure the tab on the back of the stapler unit clears the chassis while removing.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Stapler position sensor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub-cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub-cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub-cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
6. Unplug four photo-sensor connectors. Open the six cable restraints, and then unplug the FFC cable.
NOTE: The FFC is glued to the support bracket. However, the sensors can be replaced without removal of
the FFC.
Reinstallation tip: Connect the sensors, lock the cable restraints, and then connect the FCC.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Traverse Motor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub-cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub-cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub-cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
a. Apply tension to the spring by pushing toward the center of the printer, and then tighten the screw.
Tightening the screw puts maximum slack in the belt.
b. Lower the motor while placing the belt on the motor pulley.
d. Release the spring tension screw to allow the spring to apply tension to the belt.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Stacker Motor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the printer when reassembling.
NOTE: Position the first wheel into the channel on both sides while holding the arms. Let the second
wheel rest on the channel on both sides simultaneously. Gently squeeze the wheels into channel. The rack
and pinion may need to be engaged several times to level the assembly.
9. Remove one screw and then remove the cable guide. Unplug the connector, and then remove the main
paddle home sensor sub assembly.
NOTE: Move cable out of the wiring guide to access the third screw.
11. Remove the wire harness from the harness guide, remove three screws, and then remove the guide-
harness front.
NOTE: The wire harness will hang loosely after the harness guide is removed.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Stacker Encoder Sensor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the printer when reassembling.
NOTE: Position the first wheel into the channel on both sides while holding the arms. Let the second
wheel rest on the channel on both sides simultaneously. Gently squeeze the wheels into channel. The rack
and pinion may need to be engaged several times to level the assembly.
9. Remove one screw and then remove the cable guide. Unplug the connector, and then remove the main
paddle home sensor sub assembly.
NOTE: Move cable out of the wiring guide to access the third screw.
11. Remove the wire harness from the harness guide, remove three screws, and then remove the guide-
harness front.
NOTE: The wire harness will hang loosely after the harness guide is removed.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Stacker Lower Limit Switch assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the printer when reassembling.
NOTE: Position the first wheel into the channel on both sides while holding the arms. Let the second
wheel rest on the channel on both sides simultaneously. Gently squeeze the wheels into channel. The rack
and pinion may need to be engaged several times to level the assembly.
9. Remove one screw and then remove the cable guide. Unplug the connector, and then remove the main
paddle home sensor sub assembly.
NOTE: Move cable out of the wiring guide to access the third screw.
11. Remove the wire harness from the harness guide, remove three screws, and then remove the guide-
harness front.
NOTE: The wire harness will hang loosely after the harness guide is removed.
13. Open three clamps, unplug the connector, and then remove the sensor.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Stack Beam Sensor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the printer when reassembling.
NOTE: Position the first wheel into the channel on both sides while holding the arms. Let the second
wheel rest on the channel on both sides simultaneously. Gently squeeze the wheels into channel. The rack
and pinion may need to be engaged several times to level the assembly.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Stack Position Sensor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub-cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub-cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub-cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the device while assembling.
Hold the arms, and then drop the first wheel into the channel (on both sides). Simultaneously let the
second wheel rest on the channel (on both sides). Gently squeeze wheels into the channel. The rack and
pinion might need to be engaged several times to achieve a level assembly.
NOTE: Also, remove two screws, and then remove the lower PBA cover (not shown).
6. Remove one screw, disconnect the connector, release the cable guide, and then remove the main paddle
home sensor sub assembly.
Figure 8-182 Remove the main paddle home sensor sub assembly
NOTE: Move the wire harness out of the guide to access one screw.
8. Remove three screws, release the wire harness from the guide, and then remove the guide harness front.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Paper Holding Lever Solenoid assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the printer when reassembling.
NOTE: Position the first wheel into the channel on both sides while holding the arms. Let the second
wheel rest on the channel on both sides simultaneously. Gently squeeze the wheels into channel. The rack
and pinion may need to be engaged several times to level the assembly.
9. Remove one screw and then remove the cable guide. Unplug the connector, and then remove the main
paddle home sensor sub assembly.
NOTE: Move cable out of the wiring guide to access the third screw.
11. Remove the wire harness from the harness guide, remove three screws, and then remove the guide-
harness front.
NOTE: The wire harness will hang loosely after the harness guide is removed.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Paper Support Motor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the device while assembling.
Hold the arms, and then drop the first wheel into the channel (on both sides). Simultaneously let the
second wheel rest on the channel (on both sides). Gently squeeze wheels into the channel. The rack and
pinion might need to be engaged several times to achieve a level assembly.
NOTE: Also, remove two screws, and then remove the lower PBA cover (not shown).
6. Remove one screw, disconnect the connector, release the cable guide, and then remove the main paddle
home sensor sub assembly.
Figure 8-208 Remove the main paddle home sensor sub assembly
NOTE: Move the wire harness out of the guide to access one screw.
8. Remove three screws, release the wire harness from the guide, and then remove the guide harness front.
3. Remove the cables from their restraints at the front of the ejector.
NOTE: The black paddle is inside the chrome bracket at rear of ejector
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Paper Support Home Sensor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub-cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub-cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub-cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the device while assembling.
Hold the arms, and then drop the first wheel into the channel (on both sides). Simultaneously let the
second wheel rest on the channel (on both sides). Gently squeeze wheels into the channel. The rack and
pinion might need to be engaged several times to achieve a level assembly.
NOTE: Also, remove two screws, and then remove the lower PBA cover (not shown).
6. Remove one screw, disconnect the connector, release the cable guide, and then remove the main paddle
home sensor sub assembly.
Figure 8-225 Remove the main paddle home sensor sub assembly
NOTE: Move the wire harness out of the guide to access one screw.
8. Remove three screws, release the wire harness from the guide, and then remove the guide harness front.
3. Remove the shaft while pulling the bushing in the direction of the arrow.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Ejector Motor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub-cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub-cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub-cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the device while assembling.
Hold the arms, and then drop the first wheel into the channel (on both sides). Simultaneously let the
second wheel rest on the channel (on both sides). Gently squeeze wheels into the channel. The rack and
pinion might need to be engaged several times to achieve a level assembly.
NOTE: Also, remove two screws, and then remove the lower PBA cover (not shown).
6. Remove one screw, disconnect the connector, release the cable guide, and then remove the main paddle
home sensor sub assembly.
Figure 8-246 Remove the main paddle home sensor sub assembly
NOTE: Move the wire harness out of the guide to access one screw.
8. Remove three screws, release the wire harness from the guide, and then remove the guide harness front.
3. Remove the shaft while pulling the bushing in the direction of the arrow.
Reinstallation tip: When reassembling the drive shaft, ensure the paper supports are in the full down
position (against the stops).
7. Remove the clip, remove the belt-timing gear, and then remove one screw.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Main Paddle Motor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
2. Remove three screws, unplug the connector, and then remove the motor assembly.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Main Paddle Home Sensor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
2. Remove one screw. Open the clamp, and then remove the bracket-paddle sensor.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Main Paddle assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Ejector assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the device while assembling.
Hold the arms, and then drop the first wheel into the channel (on both sides). Simultaneously let the
second wheel rest on the channel (on both sides). Gently squeeze wheels into the channel. The rack and
pinion might need to be engaged several times to achieve a level assembly.
NOTE: Also, remove two screws, and then remove the lower PBA cover (not shown).
6. Remove one screw, disconnect the connector, release the cable guide, and then remove the main paddle
home sensor sub assembly.
Figure 8-271 Remove the main paddle home sensor sub assembly
NOTE: Move the wire harness out of the guide to access one screw.
8. Remove three screws, release the wire harness from the guide, and then remove the guide harness front.
3. Remove the shaft while pulling the bushing in the direction of the arrow.
Reinstallation tip: When reassembling the drive shaft, ensure the paper supports are in the full down
position (against the stops).
7. Remove the clip, remove the belt-timing gear, and then remove one screw.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Punch Dust Full Sensor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub-cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub-cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub-cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
2. Remove one screw, and then remove the punch dust full sensor.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Door Switch assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
2. On the right, back-side of the printer remove the e-ring, and then remove the shaft-side plate and unplug
the connector.
4. Remove the e-ring and washer, and then remove the punch dummy.
6. Remove two screws, unplug the connector, and then remove the door switch.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the Top Door Switch assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
a. Remove two screws in the front and one screw in the top-right of the finisher sub cover front.
c. From the right side of the finisher sub cover front, carefully lift and pry toward the top-left corner to
remove the finisher sub cover front.
2. Remove two shoulder screws at the rear of the printer, and then remove the finisher sub-cover middle and
finisher sub-cover compile by lifting off the hinge pins at the front.
Figure 8-302 Remove the finisher sub-cover middle and finisher sub-cover compile
Reinstallation tip: Push the paper stopper arms into the printer when reassembling.
NOTE: Position the first wheel into the channel on both sides while holding the arms. Let the second
wheel rest on the channel on both sides simultaneously. Gently squeeze the wheels into channel. The rack
and pinion may need to be engaged several times to level the assembly.
Introduction
This document provides the procedures to remove the End Fence Home Sensor assembly.
IMPORTANT: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end of the
removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special installation
instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove the
power cable before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Copy, scan, or print a document. Verify the document copies, scans, or prints correctly.
● Printer dimensions
● Certificate of Volatility
ENWW 1787
Printer dimensions
CAUTION: Power requirements are based on the country/region where the printer is sold. Do not convert
operating voltages. This will damage the printer and void the printer warranty.
802.11
802.11 is a set of standards for wireless local area network (WLAN) communication, developed by the IEEE LAN/MAN
Standards Committee (IEEE 802).
802.11b/g/n
802.11b/g/n can share same hardware and use the 2.4 GHz band. 802.11b supports bandwidth up to 11 Mbps, 802.11n
supports bandwidth up to 150 Mbps. 802.11b/g/n devices may occasionally suffer interference from microwave ovens,
cordless telephones, and Bluetooth devices.
Access point
Access Point or Wireless Access Point (AP or WAP) is a device that connects wireless communication devices together on
wireless local area networks (WLAN), and acts as a central transmitter and receiver of WLAN radio signals.
ADF
An document feeder is a scanning unit that will automatically feed an original sheet of paper so that the printer can scan
some amount of the paper at once.
BIT Depth
A computer graphics term describing the number of bits used to represent the color of a single pixel in a bitmapped image.
Higher color depth gives a broader range of distinct colors. As the number of bits increases, the number of possible colors
becomes impractically large for a color map. 1-bit color is commonly called as monochrome or black and white.
BMP
A bitmapped graphics format used internally by the Microsoft Windows graphics subsystem (GDI), and used commonly as a
simple graphics file format on that platform.
BOOTP
Bootstrap Protocol. A network protocol used by a network client to obtain its IP address automatically. This is usually done
in the bootstrap process of computers or operating systems running on them. The BOOTP servers assign the IP address
from a pool of addresses to each client. BOOTP enables 'diskless workstation' computers to obtain an IP address prior to
loading any advanced operating system.
CCD
Charge Coupled Device (CCD) is a hardware which enables the scan job. CCD Locking mechanism is also used to hold the CCD
module to prevent any damage when you move the printer.
Collation
Collation is a process of printing a multiple-copy job in sets. When collation is selected, the device prints an entire set before
printing additional copies.
Control Panel
A control panel is a flat, typically vertical, area where control or monitoring instruments are displayed. They are typically
found in front of the printer.
CSV
Comma Separated Values (CSV). A type of file format, CSV is used to exchange data between disparate applications. The file
format, as it is used in Microsoft Excel, has become a de facto standard throughout the industry, even among non-Microsoft
platforms.
Default
The value or setting that is in effect when taking a printer out of its box state, reset, or initialized.
DHCP
A Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) is a client-server networking protocol. A DHCP server provides configuration
parameters specific to the DHCP client host requesting, generally, information required by the client host to participate on
an IP network. DHCP also provides a mechanism for allocation of IP addresses to client hosts.
DIMM
Dual Inline Memory Module (DIMM), a small circuit board that holds memory. DIMM stores all the data within the printer like
printing data, received fax data.
DLNA
The Digital Living Network Alliance (DLNA) is a standard that allows devices on a home network to share information with
each other across the network.
DNS
The Domain Name Server (DNS) is a system that stores information associated with domain names in a distributed database
on networks, such as the Internet.
DPI
Dots Per Inch (DPI) is a measurement of resolution that is used for scanning and printing. Generally, higher DPI results in a
higher resolution, more visible detail in the image, and a larger file size.
DRPD
Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection. Distinctive Ring is a telephone company service which enables a user to use a single
telephone line to answer several different telephone numbers.
Duplex
A mechanism that will automatically turn over a sheet of paper so that the printer can print (or scan) on both sides of the
paper. A printer equipped with a Duplex unit can print on both sides of paper during one print cycle.
Duty Cycle
Duty cycle is the page quantity which does not affect printer performance for a month. Generally the printer has the lifespan
limitation such as pages per year. The lifespan means the average capacity of print-outs, usually within the warranty period.
For example, if the duty cycle is 48,000 pages per month assuming 20 working days, a printer limits 2,400 pages a day.
ECM
Error Correction Mode (ECM) is an optional transmission mode built into Class 1 fax machines or fax modems. It
automatically detects and corrects errors in the fax transmission process that are sometimes caused by telephone line
noise.
Ethernet
Ethernet is a frame-based computer networking technology for local area networks (LANs). It defines wiring and signaling
for the physical layer, and frame formats and protocols for the media access control (MAC)/data link layer of the OSI model.
Ethernet is mostly standardized as IEEE 802.3. It has become the most widespread LAN technology in use during the 1990s
to the present.
EtherTalk
A suite of protocols developed by Apple Computer for computer networking. It was included in the original Mac (1984) and is
now deprecated by Apple in favor of TCP/IP networking.
FDI
Foreign Device Interface (FDI) is a card installed inside the printer to allow a third party device such as a coin operated device
or a card reader. Those devices allow the pay-for-print service on your printer.
FTP
A File Transfer Protocol (FTP) is a commonly used protocol for exchanging files over any network that supports the TCP/IP
protocol (such as the Internet or an intranet).
Fuser Unit
The part of a laser printer that fuses the toner onto the print media. It consists of a heat roller and a pressure roller. After
toner is transferred onto the paper, the fuser unit applies heat and pressure to ensure that the toner stays on the paper
permanently, which is why paper is warm when it comes out of a laser printer.
Gateway
A connection between computer networks, or between a computer network and a telephone line. It is very popular, as it is a
computer or a network that allows access to another computer or network.
Grayscal
A shade of gray that represents light and dark portions of an image when color images are converted to grayscale; colors
are represented by various shades of gray.
Halftone
An image type that simulates grayscale by varying the number of dots. Highly colored areas consist of a large number of
dots, while lighter areas consist of a smaller number of dots.
IEEE
The Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE) is an international non-profit, professional organization for the
advancement of technology related to electricity.
IEEE 1284
The 1284 parallel port standard was developed by the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE). The term
"1284-B" refers to a specific connector type on the end of the parallel cable that attaches to the peripheral (for example, a
printer).
Intranet
A private network that uses Internet Protocols, network connectivity, and possibly the public telecommunication system to
securely share part of an organization's information or operations with its employees. Sometimes the term refers only to
the most visible service, the internal website.
IP address
An Internet Protocol (IP) address is a unique number that devices use in order to identify and communicate with each other
on a network utilizing the Internet Protocol standard.
IPP
The Internet Printing Protocol (IPP) defines a standard protocol for printing as well as managing print jobs, media size,
resolution, and so forth. IPP can be used locally or over the Internet to hundreds of printers, and also supports access
control, authentication, and encryption, making it a much more capable and secure printing solution than older ones.
IPX/SPX
IPX/SPX stands for Internet Packet Exchange/Sequenced Packet Exchange. It is a networking protocol used by the Novell
NetWare operating systems. IPX and SPX both provide connection services similar to TCP/IP, with the IPX protocol having
similarities to IP, and SPX having similarities to TCP. IPX/SPX was primarily designed for local area networks (LANs), and is a
very efficient protocol for this purpose (typically its performance exceeds that of TCP/IP on a LAN).
ISO
The International Organization for Standardization (ISO) is an international standard-setting body composed of
representatives from national standards bodies. It produces world-wide industrial and commercial standards.
ITU-T
The International Telecommunication Union is an international organization established to standardize and regulate
international radio and telecommunications. Its main tasks include standardization, allocation of the radio spectrum, and
organizing interconnection arrangements between different countries to allow international phone calls. A -T out of ITU-T
indicates telecommunication.
JBIG
Joint Bi-level Image Experts Group (JBIG) is an image compression standard with no loss of accuracy or quality, which was
designed for compression of binary images, particularly for faxes, but can also be used on other images.
JPEG
Joint Photographic Experts Group (JPEG) is a most commonly used standard method of lossy compression for photographic
images. It is the format used for storing and transmitting photographs on the World Wide Web.
LDAP
The Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) is a networking protocol for querying and modifying directory services
running over TCP/IP.
LED
A Light-Emitting Diode (LED) is a semiconductor device that indicates the status of a printer.
MAC address
Media Access Control (MAC) address is a unique identifier associated with a network adapter. MAC address is a unique 48-bit
identifier usually written as 12 hexadecimal characters grouped in pairs (e. g., 00-00-0c-34-11-4e). This address is usually
hard-coded into a Network Interface Card (NIC) by its manufacturer, and used as an aid for routers trying to locate machines
on large networks.
MFP
Multi Function Peripheral (MFP) is an office printer that includes the following functionality in one physical body, so as to
have a printer, a copier, a fax, a scanner and etc.
MMR
Modified Modified READ (MMR) is a compression method recommended by ITUT T.6.
Modem
A device that modulates a carrier signal to encode digital information, and also demodulates such a carrier signal to decode
transmitted information.
MR
Modified Read (MR) is a compression method recommended by ITU-T T.4. MR encodes the first scanned line using MH. The
next line is compared to the first, the differences determined, and then the differences are encoded and transmitted.
NetWare
A network operating system developed by Novell, Inc. It initially used cooperative multitasking to run various services on a
PC, and the network protocols were based on the archetypal Xerox XNS stack. Today NetWare supports TCP/IP as well as
IPX/SPX.
OPC
Organic Photo Conductor (OPC) is a mechanism that makes a virtual image for print using a laser beam emitted from a laser
printer, and it is usually green or rust colored and has a cylinder shape.
An imaging unit containing a drum slowly wears the drum surface by its usage in the printer, and it should be replaced
appropriately since it gets worn from contact with the cartridge development brush, cleaning mechanism, and paper.
OPE unit
Originals
The first example of something, such as a document, photograph or text, etc, which is copied, reproduced or translated to
produce others, but which is not itself copied or derived from something else.
OSI
Open Systems Interconnection (OSI) is a model developed by the International Organization for Standardization (ISO) for
communications. OSI offers a standard, modular approach to network design that divides the required set of complex
functions into manageable, self-contained, functional layers. The layers are, from top to bottom, Application, Presentation,
Session, Transport, Network, Data Link and Physical.
PABX
A private automatic branch exchange (PABX) is an automatic telephone switching system within a private enterprise.
PCL
Printer Command Language (PCL) is a Page Description Language (PDL) developed by HP as a printer protocol and has
become an industry standard. Originally developed for early inkjet printers, PCL has been released in varying levels for
thermal, dot matrix printer, and laser printers.
PDF
Portable Document Format (PDF) is a proprietary file format developed by Adobe Systems for representing two dimensional
documents in a device independent and resolution independent format.
PostScript
PostScript (PS) is a page description language and programming language used primarily in the electronic and desktop
publishing areas. - that is run in an interpreter to generate an image.
Print Media
The media like paper, labels, and transparencies which can be used in a printer, a scanner, a fax or, a copier.
Printer Driver
A program used to send commands and transfer data from the computer to the printer.
PRN file
An interface for a device driver, this allows software to interact with the device driver using standard input/output system
calls, which simplifies many tasks.
Protocol
A convention or standard that controls or enables the connection, communication, and data transfer between two
computing endpoints.
PS
See PostScript.
PSTN
The Public-Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) is the network of the world's public circuit-switched telephone networks
which, on industrial premises, is usually routed through the switchboard.
RADIUS
Remote Authentication Dial In User Service (RADIUS) is a protocol for remote user authentication and accounting. RADIUS
enables centralized management of authentication data such as usernames and passwords using an AAA (authentication,
authorization, and accounting) concept to manage network access.
Resolution
The sharpness of an image, measured in Dots Per Inch (DPI). The higher the dpi, the greater the resolution.
SMB
Server Message Block (SMB) is a network protocol mainly applied to share files, printers, serial ports, and miscellaneous
communications between nodes on a network. It also provides an authenticated Inter-process communication mechanism.
SMTP
Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP) is the standard for e-mail transmissions across the Internet. SMTP is a relatively
simple, text-based protocol, where one or more recipients of a message are specified, and then the message text is
transferred. It is a client-server protocol, where the client transmits an email message to the server.
SSID
Service Set Identifier (SSID) is a name of a wireless local area network (WLAN). All wireless devices in a WLAN use the same
SSID in order to communicate with each other. The SSIDs are case-sensitive and have a maximum length of 32 characters.
Subnet Mask
The subnet mask is used in conjunction with the network address to determine which part of the address is the network
address and which part is the host address.
TCP/IP
The Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) and the Internet Protocol (IP); the set of communications protocols that implement
the protocol stack on which the Internet and most commercial networks run.
TCR
The Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) and the Internet Protocol (IP); the set of communications protocols that implement
the protocol stack on which the Internet and most commercial networks run.
Toner Cartridge
A kind of bottle or container used in a printer like a printer which contains toner. Toner is a powder used in laser printers and
photocopiers, which forms the text and images on the printed paper. Toner can be fused by a combination of heat/pressure
from the fuser, causing it to bind to the fibers in the paper.
TWAIN
An industry standard for scanners and software. By using a TWAIN-compliant scanner with a TWAIN-compliant program, a
scan can be initiated from within the program. It is an image capture API for Microsoft Windows and Apple Mac operating
systems.
UNC Path
Uniform Naming Convention (UNC) is a standard way to access network shares in Window NT and other Microsoft products.
The format of a UNC path is: \\<servername>\<sharename>\<Additional directory>
URL
>: Uniform Resource Locator (URL) is the global address of documents and resources on the Internet. The first part of the
address indicates what protocol to use, the second part specifies the IP address or the domain name where the resource is
located.
USB
Universal Serial Bus (USB) is a standard that was developed by the USB Implementers Forum, Inc., to connect computers
and peripherals. Unlike the parallel port, USB is designed to concurrently connect a single computer USB port to multiple
peripherals.
Watermark
A watermark is a recognizable image or pattern in paper that appears lighter when viewed by transmitted light. Watermarks
were first introduced in Bologna, Italy in 1282; they have been used by papermakers to identify their product, and also on
postage stamps, currency, and other government documents to discourage counterfeiting.
WEP
Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP) is a security protocol specified in IEEE 802.11 to provide the same level of security as that of
a wired LAN. WEP provides security by encrypting data over radio so that it is protected as it is transmitted from one end
point to another.
WIA
Windows Imaging Architecture (WIA) is an imaging architecture that is originally introduced in Windows Me and Windows XP.
A scan can be initiated from within these operating systems by using a WIA-compliant scanner.
WPA
Wi-Fi Protected Access (WPA) is a class of systems to secure wireless (Wi-Fi) computer networks, which was created to
improve upon the security features of WEP.
WPA-PSK
WPA-PSK (WPA Pre-Shared Key) is special mode of WPA for small business or home users. A shared key, or password, is
configured in the wireless access point (WAP) and any wireless laptop or desktop devices. WPA-PSK generates a unique key
for each session between a wireless client and the associated WAP for more advanced security.
WPS
The Wi-Fi Protected Setup (WPS) is a standard for establishing a wireless home network. If your wireless access point
supports WPS, you can configure the wireless network connection easily without a computer.
T W
TE presser motor (M14) warnings iii
removing and replacing 1538 WLED IF PCA 113
tests WLED PCA 113
post-service 135, 1197, 1587 working table
print-quality 135, 1197, 1587 card reader 151
tips iii NFC kit 151
toner cartridge 56 WTB diagram 1174
toner collection unit 157
toner collection unit (TCU) sensors
420
toner supply drive unit 311
top cover (finisher)
removing and replacing 1205
top jam access cover
removing and replacing 1298
top lower feed assembly
removing and replacing 1309
top output bin
removing and replacing 1200
top right cover 234
touchscreen blank, white, or dim (no
image) 979